]> git.ipfire.org Git - thirdparty/gcc.git/blame - gcc/doc/tm.texi.in
In libobjc/: 2010-10-15 Nicola Pero <nicola.pero@meta-innovation.com>
[thirdparty/gcc.git] / gcc / doc / tm.texi.in
CommitLineData
38f8b050
JR
1@c Copyright (C) 1988,1989,1992,1993,1994,1995,1996,1997,1998,1999,2000,2001,
2@c 2002, 2003, 2004, 2005, 2006, 2007, 2008, 2009, 2010
3@c Free Software Foundation, Inc.
4@c This is part of the GCC manual.
5@c For copying conditions, see the file gcc.texi.
6
7@node Target Macros
8@chapter Target Description Macros and Functions
9@cindex machine description macros
10@cindex target description macros
11@cindex macros, target description
12@cindex @file{tm.h} macros
13
14In addition to the file @file{@var{machine}.md}, a machine description
15includes a C header file conventionally given the name
16@file{@var{machine}.h} and a C source file named @file{@var{machine}.c}.
17The header file defines numerous macros that convey the information
18about the target machine that does not fit into the scheme of the
19@file{.md} file. The file @file{tm.h} should be a link to
20@file{@var{machine}.h}. The header file @file{config.h} includes
21@file{tm.h} and most compiler source files include @file{config.h}. The
22source file defines a variable @code{targetm}, which is a structure
23containing pointers to functions and data relating to the target
24machine. @file{@var{machine}.c} should also contain their definitions,
25if they are not defined elsewhere in GCC, and other functions called
26through the macros defined in the @file{.h} file.
27
28@menu
29* Target Structure:: The @code{targetm} variable.
30* Driver:: Controlling how the driver runs the compilation passes.
31* Run-time Target:: Defining @samp{-m} options like @option{-m68000} and @option{-m68020}.
32* Per-Function Data:: Defining data structures for per-function information.
33* Storage Layout:: Defining sizes and alignments of data.
34* Type Layout:: Defining sizes and properties of basic user data types.
35* Registers:: Naming and describing the hardware registers.
36* Register Classes:: Defining the classes of hardware registers.
37* Old Constraints:: The old way to define machine-specific constraints.
38* Stack and Calling:: Defining which way the stack grows and by how much.
39* Varargs:: Defining the varargs macros.
40* Trampolines:: Code set up at run time to enter a nested function.
41* Library Calls:: Controlling how library routines are implicitly called.
42* Addressing Modes:: Defining addressing modes valid for memory operands.
43* Anchored Addresses:: Defining how @option{-fsection-anchors} should work.
44* Condition Code:: Defining how insns update the condition code.
45* Costs:: Defining relative costs of different operations.
46* Scheduling:: Adjusting the behavior of the instruction scheduler.
47* Sections:: Dividing storage into text, data, and other sections.
48* PIC:: Macros for position independent code.
49* Assembler Format:: Defining how to write insns and pseudo-ops to output.
50* Debugging Info:: Defining the format of debugging output.
51* Floating Point:: Handling floating point for cross-compilers.
52* Mode Switching:: Insertion of mode-switching instructions.
53* Target Attributes:: Defining target-specific uses of @code{__attribute__}.
54* Emulated TLS:: Emulated TLS support.
55* MIPS Coprocessors:: MIPS coprocessor support and how to customize it.
56* PCH Target:: Validity checking for precompiled headers.
57* C++ ABI:: Controlling C++ ABI changes.
58* Named Address Spaces:: Adding support for named address spaces
59* Misc:: Everything else.
60@end menu
61
62@node Target Structure
63@section The Global @code{targetm} Variable
64@cindex target hooks
65@cindex target functions
66
67@deftypevar {struct gcc_target} targetm
68The target @file{.c} file must define the global @code{targetm} variable
69which contains pointers to functions and data relating to the target
70machine. The variable is declared in @file{target.h};
71@file{target-def.h} defines the macro @code{TARGET_INITIALIZER} which is
72used to initialize the variable, and macros for the default initializers
73for elements of the structure. The @file{.c} file should override those
74macros for which the default definition is inappropriate. For example:
75@smallexample
76#include "target.h"
77#include "target-def.h"
78
79/* @r{Initialize the GCC target structure.} */
80
81#undef TARGET_COMP_TYPE_ATTRIBUTES
82#define TARGET_COMP_TYPE_ATTRIBUTES @var{machine}_comp_type_attributes
83
84struct gcc_target targetm = TARGET_INITIALIZER;
85@end smallexample
86@end deftypevar
87
88Where a macro should be defined in the @file{.c} file in this manner to
89form part of the @code{targetm} structure, it is documented below as a
90``Target Hook'' with a prototype. Many macros will change in future
91from being defined in the @file{.h} file to being part of the
92@code{targetm} structure.
93
94@node Driver
95@section Controlling the Compilation Driver, @file{gcc}
96@cindex driver
97@cindex controlling the compilation driver
98
99@c prevent bad page break with this line
100You can control the compilation driver.
101
102@defmac SWITCH_TAKES_ARG (@var{char})
103A C expression which determines whether the option @option{-@var{char}}
104takes arguments. The value should be the number of arguments that
105option takes--zero, for many options.
106
107By default, this macro is defined as
108@code{DEFAULT_SWITCH_TAKES_ARG}, which handles the standard options
109properly. You need not define @code{SWITCH_TAKES_ARG} unless you
110wish to add additional options which take arguments. Any redefinition
111should call @code{DEFAULT_SWITCH_TAKES_ARG} and then check for
112additional options.
113@end defmac
114
115@defmac WORD_SWITCH_TAKES_ARG (@var{name})
116A C expression which determines whether the option @option{-@var{name}}
117takes arguments. The value should be the number of arguments that
118option takes--zero, for many options. This macro rather than
119@code{SWITCH_TAKES_ARG} is used for multi-character option names.
120
121By default, this macro is defined as
122@code{DEFAULT_WORD_SWITCH_TAKES_ARG}, which handles the standard options
123properly. You need not define @code{WORD_SWITCH_TAKES_ARG} unless you
124wish to add additional options which take arguments. Any redefinition
125should call @code{DEFAULT_WORD_SWITCH_TAKES_ARG} and then check for
126additional options.
127@end defmac
128
129@defmac SWITCH_CURTAILS_COMPILATION (@var{char})
130A C expression which determines whether the option @option{-@var{char}}
131stops compilation before the generation of an executable. The value is
132boolean, nonzero if the option does stop an executable from being
133generated, zero otherwise.
134
135By default, this macro is defined as
136@code{DEFAULT_SWITCH_CURTAILS_COMPILATION}, which handles the standard
137options properly. You need not define
138@code{SWITCH_CURTAILS_COMPILATION} unless you wish to add additional
139options which affect the generation of an executable. Any redefinition
140should call @code{DEFAULT_SWITCH_CURTAILS_COMPILATION} and then check
141for additional options.
142@end defmac
143
144@defmac TARGET_OPTION_TRANSLATE_TABLE
145If defined, a list of pairs of strings, the first of which is a
146potential command line target to the @file{gcc} driver program, and the
147second of which is a space-separated (tabs and other whitespace are not
148supported) list of options with which to replace the first option. The
149target defining this list is responsible for assuring that the results
150are valid. Replacement options may not be the @code{--opt} style, they
151must be the @code{-opt} style. It is the intention of this macro to
152provide a mechanism for substitution that affects the multilibs chosen,
153such as one option that enables many options, some of which select
154multilibs. Example nonsensical definition, where @option{-malt-abi},
155@option{-EB}, and @option{-mspoo} cause different multilibs to be chosen:
156
157@smallexample
158#define TARGET_OPTION_TRANSLATE_TABLE \
159@{ "-fast", "-march=fast-foo -malt-abi -I/usr/fast-foo" @}, \
160@{ "-compat", "-EB -malign=4 -mspoo" @}
161@end smallexample
162@end defmac
163
164@defmac DRIVER_SELF_SPECS
165A list of specs for the driver itself. It should be a suitable
166initializer for an array of strings, with no surrounding braces.
167
168The driver applies these specs to its own command line between loading
169default @file{specs} files (but not command-line specified ones) and
170choosing the multilib directory or running any subcommands. It
171applies them in the order given, so each spec can depend on the
172options added by earlier ones. It is also possible to remove options
173using @samp{%<@var{option}} in the usual way.
174
175This macro can be useful when a port has several interdependent target
176options. It provides a way of standardizing the command line so
177that the other specs are easier to write.
178
179Do not define this macro if it does not need to do anything.
180@end defmac
181
182@defmac OPTION_DEFAULT_SPECS
183A list of specs used to support configure-time default options (i.e.@:
184@option{--with} options) in the driver. It should be a suitable initializer
185for an array of structures, each containing two strings, without the
186outermost pair of surrounding braces.
187
188The first item in the pair is the name of the default. This must match
189the code in @file{config.gcc} for the target. The second item is a spec
190to apply if a default with this name was specified. The string
191@samp{%(VALUE)} in the spec will be replaced by the value of the default
192everywhere it occurs.
193
194The driver will apply these specs to its own command line between loading
195default @file{specs} files and processing @code{DRIVER_SELF_SPECS}, using
196the same mechanism as @code{DRIVER_SELF_SPECS}.
197
198Do not define this macro if it does not need to do anything.
199@end defmac
200
201@defmac CPP_SPEC
202A C string constant that tells the GCC driver program options to
203pass to CPP@. It can also specify how to translate options you
204give to GCC into options for GCC to pass to the CPP@.
205
206Do not define this macro if it does not need to do anything.
207@end defmac
208
209@defmac CPLUSPLUS_CPP_SPEC
210This macro is just like @code{CPP_SPEC}, but is used for C++, rather
211than C@. If you do not define this macro, then the value of
212@code{CPP_SPEC} (if any) will be used instead.
213@end defmac
214
215@defmac CC1_SPEC
216A C string constant that tells the GCC driver program options to
217pass to @code{cc1}, @code{cc1plus}, @code{f771}, and the other language
218front ends.
219It can also specify how to translate options you give to GCC into options
220for GCC to pass to front ends.
221
222Do not define this macro if it does not need to do anything.
223@end defmac
224
225@defmac CC1PLUS_SPEC
226A C string constant that tells the GCC driver program options to
227pass to @code{cc1plus}. It can also specify how to translate options you
228give to GCC into options for GCC to pass to the @code{cc1plus}.
229
230Do not define this macro if it does not need to do anything.
231Note that everything defined in CC1_SPEC is already passed to
232@code{cc1plus} so there is no need to duplicate the contents of
233CC1_SPEC in CC1PLUS_SPEC@.
234@end defmac
235
236@defmac ASM_SPEC
237A C string constant that tells the GCC driver program options to
238pass to the assembler. It can also specify how to translate options
239you give to GCC into options for GCC to pass to the assembler.
240See the file @file{sun3.h} for an example of this.
241
242Do not define this macro if it does not need to do anything.
243@end defmac
244
245@defmac ASM_FINAL_SPEC
246A C string constant that tells the GCC driver program how to
247run any programs which cleanup after the normal assembler.
248Normally, this is not needed. See the file @file{mips.h} for
249an example of this.
250
251Do not define this macro if it does not need to do anything.
252@end defmac
253
254@defmac AS_NEEDS_DASH_FOR_PIPED_INPUT
255Define this macro, with no value, if the driver should give the assembler
256an argument consisting of a single dash, @option{-}, to instruct it to
257read from its standard input (which will be a pipe connected to the
258output of the compiler proper). This argument is given after any
259@option{-o} option specifying the name of the output file.
260
261If you do not define this macro, the assembler is assumed to read its
262standard input if given no non-option arguments. If your assembler
263cannot read standard input at all, use a @samp{%@{pipe:%e@}} construct;
264see @file{mips.h} for instance.
265@end defmac
266
267@defmac LINK_SPEC
268A C string constant that tells the GCC driver program options to
269pass to the linker. It can also specify how to translate options you
270give to GCC into options for GCC to pass to the linker.
271
272Do not define this macro if it does not need to do anything.
273@end defmac
274
275@defmac LIB_SPEC
276Another C string constant used much like @code{LINK_SPEC}. The difference
277between the two is that @code{LIB_SPEC} is used at the end of the
278command given to the linker.
279
280If this macro is not defined, a default is provided that
281loads the standard C library from the usual place. See @file{gcc.c}.
282@end defmac
283
284@defmac LIBGCC_SPEC
285Another C string constant that tells the GCC driver program
286how and when to place a reference to @file{libgcc.a} into the
287linker command line. This constant is placed both before and after
288the value of @code{LIB_SPEC}.
289
290If this macro is not defined, the GCC driver provides a default that
291passes the string @option{-lgcc} to the linker.
292@end defmac
293
294@defmac REAL_LIBGCC_SPEC
295By default, if @code{ENABLE_SHARED_LIBGCC} is defined, the
296@code{LIBGCC_SPEC} is not directly used by the driver program but is
297instead modified to refer to different versions of @file{libgcc.a}
298depending on the values of the command line flags @option{-static},
299@option{-shared}, @option{-static-libgcc}, and @option{-shared-libgcc}. On
300targets where these modifications are inappropriate, define
301@code{REAL_LIBGCC_SPEC} instead. @code{REAL_LIBGCC_SPEC} tells the
302driver how to place a reference to @file{libgcc} on the link command
303line, but, unlike @code{LIBGCC_SPEC}, it is used unmodified.
304@end defmac
305
306@defmac USE_LD_AS_NEEDED
307A macro that controls the modifications to @code{LIBGCC_SPEC}
308mentioned in @code{REAL_LIBGCC_SPEC}. If nonzero, a spec will be
309generated that uses --as-needed and the shared libgcc in place of the
310static exception handler library, when linking without any of
311@code{-static}, @code{-static-libgcc}, or @code{-shared-libgcc}.
312@end defmac
313
314@defmac LINK_EH_SPEC
315If defined, this C string constant is added to @code{LINK_SPEC}.
316When @code{USE_LD_AS_NEEDED} is zero or undefined, it also affects
317the modifications to @code{LIBGCC_SPEC} mentioned in
318@code{REAL_LIBGCC_SPEC}.
319@end defmac
320
321@defmac STARTFILE_SPEC
322Another C string constant used much like @code{LINK_SPEC}. The
323difference between the two is that @code{STARTFILE_SPEC} is used at
324the very beginning of the command given to the linker.
325
326If this macro is not defined, a default is provided that loads the
327standard C startup file from the usual place. See @file{gcc.c}.
328@end defmac
329
330@defmac ENDFILE_SPEC
331Another C string constant used much like @code{LINK_SPEC}. The
332difference between the two is that @code{ENDFILE_SPEC} is used at
333the very end of the command given to the linker.
334
335Do not define this macro if it does not need to do anything.
336@end defmac
337
338@defmac THREAD_MODEL_SPEC
339GCC @code{-v} will print the thread model GCC was configured to use.
340However, this doesn't work on platforms that are multilibbed on thread
341models, such as AIX 4.3. On such platforms, define
342@code{THREAD_MODEL_SPEC} such that it evaluates to a string without
343blanks that names one of the recognized thread models. @code{%*}, the
344default value of this macro, will expand to the value of
345@code{thread_file} set in @file{config.gcc}.
346@end defmac
347
348@defmac SYSROOT_SUFFIX_SPEC
349Define this macro to add a suffix to the target sysroot when GCC is
350configured with a sysroot. This will cause GCC to search for usr/lib,
351et al, within sysroot+suffix.
352@end defmac
353
354@defmac SYSROOT_HEADERS_SUFFIX_SPEC
355Define this macro to add a headers_suffix to the target sysroot when
356GCC is configured with a sysroot. This will cause GCC to pass the
357updated sysroot+headers_suffix to CPP, causing it to search for
358usr/include, et al, within sysroot+headers_suffix.
359@end defmac
360
361@defmac EXTRA_SPECS
362Define this macro to provide additional specifications to put in the
363@file{specs} file that can be used in various specifications like
364@code{CC1_SPEC}.
365
366The definition should be an initializer for an array of structures,
367containing a string constant, that defines the specification name, and a
368string constant that provides the specification.
369
370Do not define this macro if it does not need to do anything.
371
372@code{EXTRA_SPECS} is useful when an architecture contains several
373related targets, which have various @code{@dots{}_SPECS} which are similar
374to each other, and the maintainer would like one central place to keep
375these definitions.
376
377For example, the PowerPC System V.4 targets use @code{EXTRA_SPECS} to
378define either @code{_CALL_SYSV} when the System V calling sequence is
379used or @code{_CALL_AIX} when the older AIX-based calling sequence is
380used.
381
382The @file{config/rs6000/rs6000.h} target file defines:
383
384@smallexample
385#define EXTRA_SPECS \
386 @{ "cpp_sysv_default", CPP_SYSV_DEFAULT @},
387
388#define CPP_SYS_DEFAULT ""
389@end smallexample
390
391The @file{config/rs6000/sysv.h} target file defines:
392@smallexample
393#undef CPP_SPEC
394#define CPP_SPEC \
395"%@{posix: -D_POSIX_SOURCE @} \
396%@{mcall-sysv: -D_CALL_SYSV @} \
397%@{!mcall-sysv: %(cpp_sysv_default) @} \
398%@{msoft-float: -D_SOFT_FLOAT@} %@{mcpu=403: -D_SOFT_FLOAT@}"
399
400#undef CPP_SYSV_DEFAULT
401#define CPP_SYSV_DEFAULT "-D_CALL_SYSV"
402@end smallexample
403
404while the @file{config/rs6000/eabiaix.h} target file defines
405@code{CPP_SYSV_DEFAULT} as:
406
407@smallexample
408#undef CPP_SYSV_DEFAULT
409#define CPP_SYSV_DEFAULT "-D_CALL_AIX"
410@end smallexample
411@end defmac
412
413@defmac LINK_LIBGCC_SPECIAL_1
414Define this macro if the driver program should find the library
415@file{libgcc.a}. If you do not define this macro, the driver program will pass
416the argument @option{-lgcc} to tell the linker to do the search.
417@end defmac
418
419@defmac LINK_GCC_C_SEQUENCE_SPEC
420The sequence in which libgcc and libc are specified to the linker.
421By default this is @code{%G %L %G}.
422@end defmac
423
424@defmac LINK_COMMAND_SPEC
425A C string constant giving the complete command line need to execute the
426linker. When you do this, you will need to update your port each time a
427change is made to the link command line within @file{gcc.c}. Therefore,
428define this macro only if you need to completely redefine the command
429line for invoking the linker and there is no other way to accomplish
430the effect you need. Overriding this macro may be avoidable by overriding
431@code{LINK_GCC_C_SEQUENCE_SPEC} instead.
432@end defmac
433
434@defmac LINK_ELIMINATE_DUPLICATE_LDIRECTORIES
435A nonzero value causes @command{collect2} to remove duplicate @option{-L@var{directory}} search
436directories from linking commands. Do not give it a nonzero value if
437removing duplicate search directories changes the linker's semantics.
438@end defmac
439
440@defmac MULTILIB_DEFAULTS
441Define this macro as a C expression for the initializer of an array of
442string to tell the driver program which options are defaults for this
443target and thus do not need to be handled specially when using
444@code{MULTILIB_OPTIONS}.
445
446Do not define this macro if @code{MULTILIB_OPTIONS} is not defined in
447the target makefile fragment or if none of the options listed in
448@code{MULTILIB_OPTIONS} are set by default.
449@xref{Target Fragment}.
450@end defmac
451
452@defmac RELATIVE_PREFIX_NOT_LINKDIR
453Define this macro to tell @command{gcc} that it should only translate
454a @option{-B} prefix into a @option{-L} linker option if the prefix
455indicates an absolute file name.
456@end defmac
457
458@defmac MD_EXEC_PREFIX
459If defined, this macro is an additional prefix to try after
460@code{STANDARD_EXEC_PREFIX}. @code{MD_EXEC_PREFIX} is not searched
461when the compiler is built as a cross
462compiler. If you define @code{MD_EXEC_PREFIX}, then be sure to add it
463to the list of directories used to find the assembler in @file{configure.in}.
464@end defmac
465
466@defmac STANDARD_STARTFILE_PREFIX
467Define this macro as a C string constant if you wish to override the
468standard choice of @code{libdir} as the default prefix to
469try when searching for startup files such as @file{crt0.o}.
470@code{STANDARD_STARTFILE_PREFIX} is not searched when the compiler
471is built as a cross compiler.
472@end defmac
473
474@defmac STANDARD_STARTFILE_PREFIX_1
475Define this macro as a C string constant if you wish to override the
476standard choice of @code{/lib} as a prefix to try after the default prefix
477when searching for startup files such as @file{crt0.o}.
478@code{STANDARD_STARTFILE_PREFIX_1} is not searched when the compiler
479is built as a cross compiler.
480@end defmac
481
482@defmac STANDARD_STARTFILE_PREFIX_2
483Define this macro as a C string constant if you wish to override the
484standard choice of @code{/lib} as yet another prefix to try after the
485default prefix when searching for startup files such as @file{crt0.o}.
486@code{STANDARD_STARTFILE_PREFIX_2} is not searched when the compiler
487is built as a cross compiler.
488@end defmac
489
490@defmac MD_STARTFILE_PREFIX
491If defined, this macro supplies an additional prefix to try after the
492standard prefixes. @code{MD_EXEC_PREFIX} is not searched when the
493compiler is built as a cross compiler.
494@end defmac
495
496@defmac MD_STARTFILE_PREFIX_1
497If defined, this macro supplies yet another prefix to try after the
498standard prefixes. It is not searched when the compiler is built as a
499cross compiler.
500@end defmac
501
502@defmac INIT_ENVIRONMENT
503Define this macro as a C string constant if you wish to set environment
504variables for programs called by the driver, such as the assembler and
505loader. The driver passes the value of this macro to @code{putenv} to
506initialize the necessary environment variables.
507@end defmac
508
509@defmac LOCAL_INCLUDE_DIR
510Define this macro as a C string constant if you wish to override the
511standard choice of @file{/usr/local/include} as the default prefix to
512try when searching for local header files. @code{LOCAL_INCLUDE_DIR}
513comes before @code{SYSTEM_INCLUDE_DIR} in the search order.
514
515Cross compilers do not search either @file{/usr/local/include} or its
516replacement.
517@end defmac
518
519@defmac SYSTEM_INCLUDE_DIR
520Define this macro as a C string constant if you wish to specify a
521system-specific directory to search for header files before the standard
522directory. @code{SYSTEM_INCLUDE_DIR} comes before
523@code{STANDARD_INCLUDE_DIR} in the search order.
524
525Cross compilers do not use this macro and do not search the directory
526specified.
527@end defmac
528
529@defmac STANDARD_INCLUDE_DIR
530Define this macro as a C string constant if you wish to override the
531standard choice of @file{/usr/include} as the default prefix to
532try when searching for header files.
533
534Cross compilers ignore this macro and do not search either
535@file{/usr/include} or its replacement.
536@end defmac
537
538@defmac STANDARD_INCLUDE_COMPONENT
539The ``component'' corresponding to @code{STANDARD_INCLUDE_DIR}.
540See @code{INCLUDE_DEFAULTS}, below, for the description of components.
541If you do not define this macro, no component is used.
542@end defmac
543
544@defmac INCLUDE_DEFAULTS
545Define this macro if you wish to override the entire default search path
546for include files. For a native compiler, the default search path
547usually consists of @code{GCC_INCLUDE_DIR}, @code{LOCAL_INCLUDE_DIR},
548@code{SYSTEM_INCLUDE_DIR}, @code{GPLUSPLUS_INCLUDE_DIR}, and
549@code{STANDARD_INCLUDE_DIR}. In addition, @code{GPLUSPLUS_INCLUDE_DIR}
550and @code{GCC_INCLUDE_DIR} are defined automatically by @file{Makefile},
551and specify private search areas for GCC@. The directory
552@code{GPLUSPLUS_INCLUDE_DIR} is used only for C++ programs.
553
554The definition should be an initializer for an array of structures.
555Each array element should have four elements: the directory name (a
556string constant), the component name (also a string constant), a flag
557for C++-only directories,
558and a flag showing that the includes in the directory don't need to be
559wrapped in @code{extern @samp{C}} when compiling C++. Mark the end of
560the array with a null element.
561
562The component name denotes what GNU package the include file is part of,
563if any, in all uppercase letters. For example, it might be @samp{GCC}
564or @samp{BINUTILS}. If the package is part of a vendor-supplied
565operating system, code the component name as @samp{0}.
566
567For example, here is the definition used for VAX/VMS:
568
569@smallexample
570#define INCLUDE_DEFAULTS \
571@{ \
572 @{ "GNU_GXX_INCLUDE:", "G++", 1, 1@}, \
573 @{ "GNU_CC_INCLUDE:", "GCC", 0, 0@}, \
574 @{ "SYS$SYSROOT:[SYSLIB.]", 0, 0, 0@}, \
575 @{ ".", 0, 0, 0@}, \
576 @{ 0, 0, 0, 0@} \
577@}
578@end smallexample
579@end defmac
580
581Here is the order of prefixes tried for exec files:
582
583@enumerate
584@item
585Any prefixes specified by the user with @option{-B}.
586
587@item
588The environment variable @code{GCC_EXEC_PREFIX} or, if @code{GCC_EXEC_PREFIX}
589is not set and the compiler has not been installed in the configure-time
590@var{prefix}, the location in which the compiler has actually been installed.
591
592@item
593The directories specified by the environment variable @code{COMPILER_PATH}.
594
595@item
596The macro @code{STANDARD_EXEC_PREFIX}, if the compiler has been installed
597in the configured-time @var{prefix}.
598
599@item
600The location @file{/usr/libexec/gcc/}, but only if this is a native compiler.
601
602@item
603The location @file{/usr/lib/gcc/}, but only if this is a native compiler.
604
605@item
606The macro @code{MD_EXEC_PREFIX}, if defined, but only if this is a native
607compiler.
608@end enumerate
609
610Here is the order of prefixes tried for startfiles:
611
612@enumerate
613@item
614Any prefixes specified by the user with @option{-B}.
615
616@item
617The environment variable @code{GCC_EXEC_PREFIX} or its automatically determined
618value based on the installed toolchain location.
619
620@item
621The directories specified by the environment variable @code{LIBRARY_PATH}
622(or port-specific name; native only, cross compilers do not use this).
623
624@item
625The macro @code{STANDARD_EXEC_PREFIX}, but only if the toolchain is installed
626in the configured @var{prefix} or this is a native compiler.
627
628@item
629The location @file{/usr/lib/gcc/}, but only if this is a native compiler.
630
631@item
632The macro @code{MD_EXEC_PREFIX}, if defined, but only if this is a native
633compiler.
634
635@item
636The macro @code{MD_STARTFILE_PREFIX}, if defined, but only if this is a
637native compiler, or we have a target system root.
638
639@item
640The macro @code{MD_STARTFILE_PREFIX_1}, if defined, but only if this is a
641native compiler, or we have a target system root.
642
643@item
644The macro @code{STANDARD_STARTFILE_PREFIX}, with any sysroot modifications.
645If this path is relative it will be prefixed by @code{GCC_EXEC_PREFIX} and
646the machine suffix or @code{STANDARD_EXEC_PREFIX} and the machine suffix.
647
648@item
649The macro @code{STANDARD_STARTFILE_PREFIX_1}, but only if this is a native
650compiler, or we have a target system root. The default for this macro is
651@file{/lib/}.
652
653@item
654The macro @code{STANDARD_STARTFILE_PREFIX_2}, but only if this is a native
655compiler, or we have a target system root. The default for this macro is
656@file{/usr/lib/}.
657@end enumerate
658
659@node Run-time Target
660@section Run-time Target Specification
661@cindex run-time target specification
662@cindex predefined macros
663@cindex target specifications
664
665@c prevent bad page break with this line
666Here are run-time target specifications.
667
668@defmac TARGET_CPU_CPP_BUILTINS ()
669This function-like macro expands to a block of code that defines
670built-in preprocessor macros and assertions for the target CPU, using
671the functions @code{builtin_define}, @code{builtin_define_std} and
672@code{builtin_assert}. When the front end
673calls this macro it provides a trailing semicolon, and since it has
674finished command line option processing your code can use those
675results freely.
676
677@code{builtin_assert} takes a string in the form you pass to the
678command-line option @option{-A}, such as @code{cpu=mips}, and creates
679the assertion. @code{builtin_define} takes a string in the form
680accepted by option @option{-D} and unconditionally defines the macro.
681
682@code{builtin_define_std} takes a string representing the name of an
683object-like macro. If it doesn't lie in the user's namespace,
684@code{builtin_define_std} defines it unconditionally. Otherwise, it
685defines a version with two leading underscores, and another version
686with two leading and trailing underscores, and defines the original
687only if an ISO standard was not requested on the command line. For
688example, passing @code{unix} defines @code{__unix}, @code{__unix__}
689and possibly @code{unix}; passing @code{_mips} defines @code{__mips},
690@code{__mips__} and possibly @code{_mips}, and passing @code{_ABI64}
691defines only @code{_ABI64}.
692
693You can also test for the C dialect being compiled. The variable
694@code{c_language} is set to one of @code{clk_c}, @code{clk_cplusplus}
695or @code{clk_objective_c}. Note that if we are preprocessing
696assembler, this variable will be @code{clk_c} but the function-like
697macro @code{preprocessing_asm_p()} will return true, so you might want
698to check for that first. If you need to check for strict ANSI, the
699variable @code{flag_iso} can be used. The function-like macro
700@code{preprocessing_trad_p()} can be used to check for traditional
701preprocessing.
702@end defmac
703
704@defmac TARGET_OS_CPP_BUILTINS ()
705Similarly to @code{TARGET_CPU_CPP_BUILTINS} but this macro is optional
706and is used for the target operating system instead.
707@end defmac
708
709@defmac TARGET_OBJFMT_CPP_BUILTINS ()
710Similarly to @code{TARGET_CPU_CPP_BUILTINS} but this macro is optional
711and is used for the target object format. @file{elfos.h} uses this
712macro to define @code{__ELF__}, so you probably do not need to define
713it yourself.
714@end defmac
715
716@deftypevar {extern int} target_flags
717This variable is declared in @file{options.h}, which is included before
718any target-specific headers.
719@end deftypevar
720
721@hook TARGET_DEFAULT_TARGET_FLAGS
722This variable specifies the initial value of @code{target_flags}.
723Its default setting is 0.
724@end deftypevr
725
726@cindex optional hardware or system features
727@cindex features, optional, in system conventions
728
729@hook TARGET_HANDLE_OPTION
730This hook is called whenever the user specifies one of the
731target-specific options described by the @file{.opt} definition files
732(@pxref{Options}). It has the opportunity to do some option-specific
733processing and should return true if the option is valid. The default
734definition does nothing but return true.
735
736@var{code} specifies the @code{OPT_@var{name}} enumeration value
737associated with the selected option; @var{name} is just a rendering of
738the option name in which non-alphanumeric characters are replaced by
739underscores. @var{arg} specifies the string argument and is null if
740no argument was given. If the option is flagged as a @code{UInteger}
741(@pxref{Option properties}), @var{value} is the numeric value of the
742argument. Otherwise @var{value} is 1 if the positive form of the
743option was used and 0 if the ``no-'' form was.
744@end deftypefn
745
746@hook TARGET_HANDLE_C_OPTION
747This target hook is called whenever the user specifies one of the
748target-specific C language family options described by the @file{.opt}
749definition files(@pxref{Options}). It has the opportunity to do some
750option-specific processing and should return true if the option is
751valid. The arguments are like for @code{TARGET_HANDLE_OPTION}. The
752default definition does nothing but return false.
753
754In general, you should use @code{TARGET_HANDLE_OPTION} to handle
755options. However, if processing an option requires routines that are
756only available in the C (and related language) front ends, then you
757should use @code{TARGET_HANDLE_C_OPTION} instead.
758@end deftypefn
759
760@defmac TARGET_VERSION
761This macro is a C statement to print on @code{stderr} a string
762describing the particular machine description choice. Every machine
763description should define @code{TARGET_VERSION}. For example:
764
765@smallexample
766#ifdef MOTOROLA
767#define TARGET_VERSION \
768 fprintf (stderr, " (68k, Motorola syntax)");
769#else
770#define TARGET_VERSION \
771 fprintf (stderr, " (68k, MIT syntax)");
772#endif
773@end smallexample
774@end defmac
775
38f8b050
JR
776@hook TARGET_OVERRIDE_OPTIONS_AFTER_CHANGE
777This target function is similar to the hook @code{TARGET_OPTION_OVERRIDE}
778but is called when the optimize level is changed via an attribute or
779pragma or when it is reset at the end of the code affected by the
780attribute or pragma. It is not called at the beginning of compilation
781when @code{TARGET_OPTION_OVERRIDE} is called so if you want to perform these
782actions then, you should have @code{TARGET_OPTION_OVERRIDE} call
783@code{TARGET_OVERRIDE_OPTIONS_AFTER_CHANGE}.
784@end deftypefn
785
786@defmac C_COMMON_OVERRIDE_OPTIONS
c5387660
JM
787This is similar to the @code{TARGET_OPTION_OVERRIDE} hook
788but is only used in the C
38f8b050
JR
789language frontends (C, Objective-C, C++, Objective-C++) and so can be
790used to alter option flag variables which only exist in those
791frontends.
792@end defmac
793
fac0f722 794@hook TARGET_OPTION_OPTIMIZATION
38f8b050 795Some machines may desire to change what optimizations are performed for
fac0f722 796various optimization levels. This hook, if defined, is executed once
38f8b050
JR
797just after the optimization level is determined and before the remainder
798of the command options have been parsed. Values set in this macro are
799used as the default values for the other command line options.
800
801@var{level} is the optimization level specified; 2 if @option{-O2} is
802specified, 1 if @option{-O} is specified, and 0 if neither is specified.
803
804@var{size} is nonzero if @option{-Os} is specified and zero otherwise.
805
806This macro is run once at program startup and when the optimization
807options are changed via @code{#pragma GCC optimize} or by using the
808@code{optimize} attribute.
809
810@strong{Do not examine @code{write_symbols} in
fac0f722 811this hook!} The debugging options are not supposed to alter the
38f8b050 812generated code.
fac0f722 813@end deftypefn
38f8b050 814
128dc8e2
JM
815@hook TARGET_OPTION_DEFAULT_PARAMS
816
38f8b050
JR
817@hook TARGET_HELP
818This hook is called in response to the user invoking
819@option{--target-help} on the command line. It gives the target a
820chance to display extra information on the target specific command
821line options found in its @file{.opt} file.
822@end deftypefn
823
824@defmac CAN_DEBUG_WITHOUT_FP
825Define this macro if debugging can be performed even without a frame
826pointer. If this macro is defined, GCC will turn on the
827@option{-fomit-frame-pointer} option whenever @option{-O} is specified.
828@end defmac
829
3bd36029
RS
830@defmac SWITCHABLE_TARGET
831Some targets need to switch between substantially different subtargets
832during compilation. For example, the MIPS target has one subtarget for
833the traditional MIPS architecture and another for MIPS16. Source code
834can switch between these two subarchitectures using the @code{mips16}
835and @code{nomips16} attributes.
836
837Such subtargets can differ in things like the set of available
838registers, the set of available instructions, the costs of various
839operations, and so on. GCC caches a lot of this type of information
840in global variables, and recomputing them for each subtarget takes a
841significant amount of time. The compiler therefore provides a facility
842for maintaining several versions of the global variables and quickly
843switching between them; see @file{target-globals.h} for details.
844
845Define this macro to 1 if your target needs this facility. The default
846is 0.
847@end defmac
848
38f8b050
JR
849@node Per-Function Data
850@section Defining data structures for per-function information.
851@cindex per-function data
852@cindex data structures
853
854If the target needs to store information on a per-function basis, GCC
855provides a macro and a couple of variables to allow this. Note, just
856using statics to store the information is a bad idea, since GCC supports
857nested functions, so you can be halfway through encoding one function
858when another one comes along.
859
860GCC defines a data structure called @code{struct function} which
861contains all of the data specific to an individual function. This
862structure contains a field called @code{machine} whose type is
863@code{struct machine_function *}, which can be used by targets to point
864to their own specific data.
865
866If a target needs per-function specific data it should define the type
867@code{struct machine_function} and also the macro @code{INIT_EXPANDERS}.
868This macro should be used to initialize the function pointer
869@code{init_machine_status}. This pointer is explained below.
870
871One typical use of per-function, target specific data is to create an
872RTX to hold the register containing the function's return address. This
873RTX can then be used to implement the @code{__builtin_return_address}
874function, for level 0.
875
876Note---earlier implementations of GCC used a single data area to hold
877all of the per-function information. Thus when processing of a nested
878function began the old per-function data had to be pushed onto a
879stack, and when the processing was finished, it had to be popped off the
880stack. GCC used to provide function pointers called
881@code{save_machine_status} and @code{restore_machine_status} to handle
882the saving and restoring of the target specific information. Since the
883single data area approach is no longer used, these pointers are no
884longer supported.
885
886@defmac INIT_EXPANDERS
887Macro called to initialize any target specific information. This macro
888is called once per function, before generation of any RTL has begun.
889The intention of this macro is to allow the initialization of the
890function pointer @code{init_machine_status}.
891@end defmac
892
893@deftypevar {void (*)(struct function *)} init_machine_status
894If this function pointer is non-@code{NULL} it will be called once per
895function, before function compilation starts, in order to allow the
896target to perform any target specific initialization of the
897@code{struct function} structure. It is intended that this would be
898used to initialize the @code{machine} of that structure.
899
900@code{struct machine_function} structures are expected to be freed by GC@.
901Generally, any memory that they reference must be allocated by using
902GC allocation, including the structure itself.
903@end deftypevar
904
905@node Storage Layout
906@section Storage Layout
907@cindex storage layout
908
909Note that the definitions of the macros in this table which are sizes or
910alignments measured in bits do not need to be constant. They can be C
911expressions that refer to static variables, such as the @code{target_flags}.
912@xref{Run-time Target}.
913
914@defmac BITS_BIG_ENDIAN
915Define this macro to have the value 1 if the most significant bit in a
916byte has the lowest number; otherwise define it to have the value zero.
917This means that bit-field instructions count from the most significant
918bit. If the machine has no bit-field instructions, then this must still
919be defined, but it doesn't matter which value it is defined to. This
920macro need not be a constant.
921
922This macro does not affect the way structure fields are packed into
923bytes or words; that is controlled by @code{BYTES_BIG_ENDIAN}.
924@end defmac
925
926@defmac BYTES_BIG_ENDIAN
927Define this macro to have the value 1 if the most significant byte in a
928word has the lowest number. This macro need not be a constant.
929@end defmac
930
931@defmac WORDS_BIG_ENDIAN
932Define this macro to have the value 1 if, in a multiword object, the
933most significant word has the lowest number. This applies to both
934memory locations and registers; GCC fundamentally assumes that the
935order of words in memory is the same as the order in registers. This
936macro need not be a constant.
937@end defmac
938
939@defmac LIBGCC2_WORDS_BIG_ENDIAN
940Define this macro if @code{WORDS_BIG_ENDIAN} is not constant. This must be a
941constant value with the same meaning as @code{WORDS_BIG_ENDIAN}, which will be
942used only when compiling @file{libgcc2.c}. Typically the value will be set
943based on preprocessor defines.
944@end defmac
945
946@defmac FLOAT_WORDS_BIG_ENDIAN
947Define this macro to have the value 1 if @code{DFmode}, @code{XFmode} or
948@code{TFmode} floating point numbers are stored in memory with the word
949containing the sign bit at the lowest address; otherwise define it to
950have the value 0. This macro need not be a constant.
951
952You need not define this macro if the ordering is the same as for
953multi-word integers.
954@end defmac
955
956@defmac BITS_PER_UNIT
957Define this macro to be the number of bits in an addressable storage
958unit (byte). If you do not define this macro the default is 8.
959@end defmac
960
961@defmac BITS_PER_WORD
962Number of bits in a word. If you do not define this macro, the default
963is @code{BITS_PER_UNIT * UNITS_PER_WORD}.
964@end defmac
965
966@defmac MAX_BITS_PER_WORD
967Maximum number of bits in a word. If this is undefined, the default is
968@code{BITS_PER_WORD}. Otherwise, it is the constant value that is the
969largest value that @code{BITS_PER_WORD} can have at run-time.
970@end defmac
971
972@defmac UNITS_PER_WORD
973Number of storage units in a word; normally the size of a general-purpose
974register, a power of two from 1 or 8.
975@end defmac
976
977@defmac MIN_UNITS_PER_WORD
978Minimum number of units in a word. If this is undefined, the default is
979@code{UNITS_PER_WORD}. Otherwise, it is the constant value that is the
980smallest value that @code{UNITS_PER_WORD} can have at run-time.
981@end defmac
982
38f8b050
JR
983@defmac POINTER_SIZE
984Width of a pointer, in bits. You must specify a value no wider than the
985width of @code{Pmode}. If it is not equal to the width of @code{Pmode},
986you must define @code{POINTERS_EXTEND_UNSIGNED}. If you do not specify
987a value the default is @code{BITS_PER_WORD}.
988@end defmac
989
990@defmac POINTERS_EXTEND_UNSIGNED
991A C expression that determines how pointers should be extended from
992@code{ptr_mode} to either @code{Pmode} or @code{word_mode}. It is
993greater than zero if pointers should be zero-extended, zero if they
994should be sign-extended, and negative if some other sort of conversion
995is needed. In the last case, the extension is done by the target's
996@code{ptr_extend} instruction.
997
998You need not define this macro if the @code{ptr_mode}, @code{Pmode}
999and @code{word_mode} are all the same width.
1000@end defmac
1001
1002@defmac PROMOTE_MODE (@var{m}, @var{unsignedp}, @var{type})
1003A macro to update @var{m} and @var{unsignedp} when an object whose type
1004is @var{type} and which has the specified mode and signedness is to be
1005stored in a register. This macro is only called when @var{type} is a
1006scalar type.
1007
1008On most RISC machines, which only have operations that operate on a full
1009register, define this macro to set @var{m} to @code{word_mode} if
1010@var{m} is an integer mode narrower than @code{BITS_PER_WORD}. In most
1011cases, only integer modes should be widened because wider-precision
1012floating-point operations are usually more expensive than their narrower
1013counterparts.
1014
1015For most machines, the macro definition does not change @var{unsignedp}.
1016However, some machines, have instructions that preferentially handle
1017either signed or unsigned quantities of certain modes. For example, on
1018the DEC Alpha, 32-bit loads from memory and 32-bit add instructions
1019sign-extend the result to 64 bits. On such machines, set
1020@var{unsignedp} according to which kind of extension is more efficient.
1021
1022Do not define this macro if it would never modify @var{m}.
1023@end defmac
1024
1025@hook TARGET_PROMOTE_FUNCTION_MODE
1026Like @code{PROMOTE_MODE}, but it is applied to outgoing function arguments or
1027function return values. The target hook should return the new mode
1028and possibly change @code{*@var{punsignedp}} if the promotion should
1029change signedness. This function is called only for scalar @emph{or
1030pointer} types.
1031
1032@var{for_return} allows to distinguish the promotion of arguments and
1033return values. If it is @code{1}, a return value is being promoted and
1034@code{TARGET_FUNCTION_VALUE} must perform the same promotions done here.
1035If it is @code{2}, the returned mode should be that of the register in
1036which an incoming parameter is copied, or the outgoing result is computed;
1037then the hook should return the same mode as @code{promote_mode}, though
1038the signedness may be different.
1039
1040The default is to not promote arguments and return values. You can
1041also define the hook to @code{default_promote_function_mode_always_promote}
1042if you would like to apply the same rules given by @code{PROMOTE_MODE}.
1043@end deftypefn
1044
1045@defmac PARM_BOUNDARY
1046Normal alignment required for function parameters on the stack, in
1047bits. All stack parameters receive at least this much alignment
1048regardless of data type. On most machines, this is the same as the
1049size of an integer.
1050@end defmac
1051
1052@defmac STACK_BOUNDARY
1053Define this macro to the minimum alignment enforced by hardware for the
1054stack pointer on this machine. The definition is a C expression for the
1055desired alignment (measured in bits). This value is used as a default
1056if @code{PREFERRED_STACK_BOUNDARY} is not defined. On most machines,
1057this should be the same as @code{PARM_BOUNDARY}.
1058@end defmac
1059
1060@defmac PREFERRED_STACK_BOUNDARY
1061Define this macro if you wish to preserve a certain alignment for the
1062stack pointer, greater than what the hardware enforces. The definition
1063is a C expression for the desired alignment (measured in bits). This
1064macro must evaluate to a value equal to or larger than
1065@code{STACK_BOUNDARY}.
1066@end defmac
1067
1068@defmac INCOMING_STACK_BOUNDARY
1069Define this macro if the incoming stack boundary may be different
1070from @code{PREFERRED_STACK_BOUNDARY}. This macro must evaluate
1071to a value equal to or larger than @code{STACK_BOUNDARY}.
1072@end defmac
1073
1074@defmac FUNCTION_BOUNDARY
1075Alignment required for a function entry point, in bits.
1076@end defmac
1077
1078@defmac BIGGEST_ALIGNMENT
1079Biggest alignment that any data type can require on this machine, in
1080bits. Note that this is not the biggest alignment that is supported,
1081just the biggest alignment that, when violated, may cause a fault.
1082@end defmac
1083
1084@defmac MALLOC_ABI_ALIGNMENT
1085Alignment, in bits, a C conformant malloc implementation has to
1086provide. If not defined, the default value is @code{BITS_PER_WORD}.
1087@end defmac
1088
1089@defmac ATTRIBUTE_ALIGNED_VALUE
1090Alignment used by the @code{__attribute__ ((aligned))} construct. If
1091not defined, the default value is @code{BIGGEST_ALIGNMENT}.
1092@end defmac
1093
1094@defmac MINIMUM_ATOMIC_ALIGNMENT
1095If defined, the smallest alignment, in bits, that can be given to an
1096object that can be referenced in one operation, without disturbing any
1097nearby object. Normally, this is @code{BITS_PER_UNIT}, but may be larger
1098on machines that don't have byte or half-word store operations.
1099@end defmac
1100
1101@defmac BIGGEST_FIELD_ALIGNMENT
1102Biggest alignment that any structure or union field can require on this
1103machine, in bits. If defined, this overrides @code{BIGGEST_ALIGNMENT} for
1104structure and union fields only, unless the field alignment has been set
1105by the @code{__attribute__ ((aligned (@var{n})))} construct.
1106@end defmac
1107
1108@defmac ADJUST_FIELD_ALIGN (@var{field}, @var{computed})
1109An expression for the alignment of a structure field @var{field} if the
1110alignment computed in the usual way (including applying of
1111@code{BIGGEST_ALIGNMENT} and @code{BIGGEST_FIELD_ALIGNMENT} to the
1112alignment) is @var{computed}. It overrides alignment only if the
1113field alignment has not been set by the
1114@code{__attribute__ ((aligned (@var{n})))} construct.
1115@end defmac
1116
1117@defmac MAX_STACK_ALIGNMENT
1118Biggest stack alignment guaranteed by the backend. Use this macro
1119to specify the maximum alignment of a variable on stack.
1120
1121If not defined, the default value is @code{STACK_BOUNDARY}.
1122
1123@c FIXME: The default should be @code{PREFERRED_STACK_BOUNDARY}.
1124@c But the fix for PR 32893 indicates that we can only guarantee
1125@c maximum stack alignment on stack up to @code{STACK_BOUNDARY}, not
1126@c @code{PREFERRED_STACK_BOUNDARY}, if stack alignment isn't supported.
1127@end defmac
1128
1129@defmac MAX_OFILE_ALIGNMENT
1130Biggest alignment supported by the object file format of this machine.
1131Use this macro to limit the alignment which can be specified using the
1132@code{__attribute__ ((aligned (@var{n})))} construct. If not defined,
1133the default value is @code{BIGGEST_ALIGNMENT}.
1134
1135On systems that use ELF, the default (in @file{config/elfos.h}) is
1136the largest supported 32-bit ELF section alignment representable on
1137a 32-bit host e.g. @samp{(((unsigned HOST_WIDEST_INT) 1 << 28) * 8)}.
1138On 32-bit ELF the largest supported section alignment in bits is
1139@samp{(0x80000000 * 8)}, but this is not representable on 32-bit hosts.
1140@end defmac
1141
1142@defmac DATA_ALIGNMENT (@var{type}, @var{basic-align})
1143If defined, a C expression to compute the alignment for a variable in
1144the static store. @var{type} is the data type, and @var{basic-align} is
1145the alignment that the object would ordinarily have. The value of this
1146macro is used instead of that alignment to align the object.
1147
1148If this macro is not defined, then @var{basic-align} is used.
1149
1150@findex strcpy
1151One use of this macro is to increase alignment of medium-size data to
1152make it all fit in fewer cache lines. Another is to cause character
1153arrays to be word-aligned so that @code{strcpy} calls that copy
1154constants to character arrays can be done inline.
1155@end defmac
1156
1157@defmac CONSTANT_ALIGNMENT (@var{constant}, @var{basic-align})
1158If defined, a C expression to compute the alignment given to a constant
1159that is being placed in memory. @var{constant} is the constant and
1160@var{basic-align} is the alignment that the object would ordinarily
1161have. The value of this macro is used instead of that alignment to
1162align the object.
1163
1164If this macro is not defined, then @var{basic-align} is used.
1165
1166The typical use of this macro is to increase alignment for string
1167constants to be word aligned so that @code{strcpy} calls that copy
1168constants can be done inline.
1169@end defmac
1170
1171@defmac LOCAL_ALIGNMENT (@var{type}, @var{basic-align})
1172If defined, a C expression to compute the alignment for a variable in
1173the local store. @var{type} is the data type, and @var{basic-align} is
1174the alignment that the object would ordinarily have. The value of this
1175macro is used instead of that alignment to align the object.
1176
1177If this macro is not defined, then @var{basic-align} is used.
1178
1179One use of this macro is to increase alignment of medium-size data to
1180make it all fit in fewer cache lines.
1181@end defmac
1182
1183@defmac STACK_SLOT_ALIGNMENT (@var{type}, @var{mode}, @var{basic-align})
1184If defined, a C expression to compute the alignment for stack slot.
1185@var{type} is the data type, @var{mode} is the widest mode available,
1186and @var{basic-align} is the alignment that the slot would ordinarily
1187have. The value of this macro is used instead of that alignment to
1188align the slot.
1189
1190If this macro is not defined, then @var{basic-align} is used when
1191@var{type} is @code{NULL}. Otherwise, @code{LOCAL_ALIGNMENT} will
1192be used.
1193
1194This macro is to set alignment of stack slot to the maximum alignment
1195of all possible modes which the slot may have.
1196@end defmac
1197
1198@defmac LOCAL_DECL_ALIGNMENT (@var{decl})
1199If defined, a C expression to compute the alignment for a local
1200variable @var{decl}.
1201
1202If this macro is not defined, then
1203@code{LOCAL_ALIGNMENT (TREE_TYPE (@var{decl}), DECL_ALIGN (@var{decl}))}
1204is used.
1205
1206One use of this macro is to increase alignment of medium-size data to
1207make it all fit in fewer cache lines.
1208@end defmac
1209
1210@defmac MINIMUM_ALIGNMENT (@var{exp}, @var{mode}, @var{align})
1211If defined, a C expression to compute the minimum required alignment
1212for dynamic stack realignment purposes for @var{exp} (a type or decl),
1213@var{mode}, assuming normal alignment @var{align}.
1214
1215If this macro is not defined, then @var{align} will be used.
1216@end defmac
1217
1218@defmac EMPTY_FIELD_BOUNDARY
1219Alignment in bits to be given to a structure bit-field that follows an
1220empty field such as @code{int : 0;}.
1221
1222If @code{PCC_BITFIELD_TYPE_MATTERS} is true, it overrides this macro.
1223@end defmac
1224
1225@defmac STRUCTURE_SIZE_BOUNDARY
1226Number of bits which any structure or union's size must be a multiple of.
1227Each structure or union's size is rounded up to a multiple of this.
1228
1229If you do not define this macro, the default is the same as
1230@code{BITS_PER_UNIT}.
1231@end defmac
1232
1233@defmac STRICT_ALIGNMENT
1234Define this macro to be the value 1 if instructions will fail to work
1235if given data not on the nominal alignment. If instructions will merely
1236go slower in that case, define this macro as 0.
1237@end defmac
1238
1239@defmac PCC_BITFIELD_TYPE_MATTERS
1240Define this if you wish to imitate the way many other C compilers handle
1241alignment of bit-fields and the structures that contain them.
1242
1243The behavior is that the type written for a named bit-field (@code{int},
1244@code{short}, or other integer type) imposes an alignment for the entire
1245structure, as if the structure really did contain an ordinary field of
1246that type. In addition, the bit-field is placed within the structure so
1247that it would fit within such a field, not crossing a boundary for it.
1248
1249Thus, on most machines, a named bit-field whose type is written as
1250@code{int} would not cross a four-byte boundary, and would force
1251four-byte alignment for the whole structure. (The alignment used may
1252not be four bytes; it is controlled by the other alignment parameters.)
1253
1254An unnamed bit-field will not affect the alignment of the containing
1255structure.
1256
1257If the macro is defined, its definition should be a C expression;
1258a nonzero value for the expression enables this behavior.
1259
1260Note that if this macro is not defined, or its value is zero, some
1261bit-fields may cross more than one alignment boundary. The compiler can
1262support such references if there are @samp{insv}, @samp{extv}, and
1263@samp{extzv} insns that can directly reference memory.
1264
1265The other known way of making bit-fields work is to define
1266@code{STRUCTURE_SIZE_BOUNDARY} as large as @code{BIGGEST_ALIGNMENT}.
1267Then every structure can be accessed with fullwords.
1268
1269Unless the machine has bit-field instructions or you define
1270@code{STRUCTURE_SIZE_BOUNDARY} that way, you must define
1271@code{PCC_BITFIELD_TYPE_MATTERS} to have a nonzero value.
1272
1273If your aim is to make GCC use the same conventions for laying out
1274bit-fields as are used by another compiler, here is how to investigate
1275what the other compiler does. Compile and run this program:
1276
1277@smallexample
1278struct foo1
1279@{
1280 char x;
1281 char :0;
1282 char y;
1283@};
1284
1285struct foo2
1286@{
1287 char x;
1288 int :0;
1289 char y;
1290@};
1291
1292main ()
1293@{
1294 printf ("Size of foo1 is %d\n",
1295 sizeof (struct foo1));
1296 printf ("Size of foo2 is %d\n",
1297 sizeof (struct foo2));
1298 exit (0);
1299@}
1300@end smallexample
1301
1302If this prints 2 and 5, then the compiler's behavior is what you would
1303get from @code{PCC_BITFIELD_TYPE_MATTERS}.
1304@end defmac
1305
1306@defmac BITFIELD_NBYTES_LIMITED
1307Like @code{PCC_BITFIELD_TYPE_MATTERS} except that its effect is limited
1308to aligning a bit-field within the structure.
1309@end defmac
1310
1311@hook TARGET_ALIGN_ANON_BITFIELD
1312When @code{PCC_BITFIELD_TYPE_MATTERS} is true this hook will determine
1313whether unnamed bitfields affect the alignment of the containing
1314structure. The hook should return true if the structure should inherit
1315the alignment requirements of an unnamed bitfield's type.
1316@end deftypefn
1317
1318@hook TARGET_NARROW_VOLATILE_BITFIELD
1319This target hook should return @code{true} if accesses to volatile bitfields
1320should use the narrowest mode possible. It should return @code{false} if
1321these accesses should use the bitfield container type.
1322
1323The default is @code{!TARGET_STRICT_ALIGN}.
1324@end deftypefn
1325
1326@defmac MEMBER_TYPE_FORCES_BLK (@var{field}, @var{mode})
1327Return 1 if a structure or array containing @var{field} should be accessed using
1328@code{BLKMODE}.
1329
1330If @var{field} is the only field in the structure, @var{mode} is its
1331mode, otherwise @var{mode} is VOIDmode. @var{mode} is provided in the
1332case where structures of one field would require the structure's mode to
1333retain the field's mode.
1334
1335Normally, this is not needed.
1336@end defmac
1337
1338@defmac ROUND_TYPE_ALIGN (@var{type}, @var{computed}, @var{specified})
1339Define this macro as an expression for the alignment of a type (given
1340by @var{type} as a tree node) if the alignment computed in the usual
1341way is @var{computed} and the alignment explicitly specified was
1342@var{specified}.
1343
1344The default is to use @var{specified} if it is larger; otherwise, use
1345the smaller of @var{computed} and @code{BIGGEST_ALIGNMENT}
1346@end defmac
1347
1348@defmac MAX_FIXED_MODE_SIZE
1349An integer expression for the size in bits of the largest integer
1350machine mode that should actually be used. All integer machine modes of
1351this size or smaller can be used for structures and unions with the
1352appropriate sizes. If this macro is undefined, @code{GET_MODE_BITSIZE
1353(DImode)} is assumed.
1354@end defmac
1355
1356@defmac STACK_SAVEAREA_MODE (@var{save_level})
1357If defined, an expression of type @code{enum machine_mode} that
1358specifies the mode of the save area operand of a
1359@code{save_stack_@var{level}} named pattern (@pxref{Standard Names}).
1360@var{save_level} is one of @code{SAVE_BLOCK}, @code{SAVE_FUNCTION}, or
1361@code{SAVE_NONLOCAL} and selects which of the three named patterns is
1362having its mode specified.
1363
1364You need not define this macro if it always returns @code{Pmode}. You
1365would most commonly define this macro if the
1366@code{save_stack_@var{level}} patterns need to support both a 32- and a
136764-bit mode.
1368@end defmac
1369
1370@defmac STACK_SIZE_MODE
1371If defined, an expression of type @code{enum machine_mode} that
1372specifies the mode of the size increment operand of an
1373@code{allocate_stack} named pattern (@pxref{Standard Names}).
1374
1375You need not define this macro if it always returns @code{word_mode}.
1376You would most commonly define this macro if the @code{allocate_stack}
1377pattern needs to support both a 32- and a 64-bit mode.
1378@end defmac
1379
1380@hook TARGET_LIBGCC_CMP_RETURN_MODE
1381This target hook should return the mode to be used for the return value
1382of compare instructions expanded to libgcc calls. If not defined
1383@code{word_mode} is returned which is the right choice for a majority of
1384targets.
1385@end deftypefn
1386
1387@hook TARGET_LIBGCC_SHIFT_COUNT_MODE
1388This target hook should return the mode to be used for the shift count operand
1389of shift instructions expanded to libgcc calls. If not defined
1390@code{word_mode} is returned which is the right choice for a majority of
1391targets.
1392@end deftypefn
1393
1394@hook TARGET_UNWIND_WORD_MODE
1395Return machine mode to be used for @code{_Unwind_Word} type.
1396The default is to use @code{word_mode}.
1397@end deftypefn
1398
1399@defmac ROUND_TOWARDS_ZERO
1400If defined, this macro should be true if the prevailing rounding
1401mode is towards zero.
1402
1403Defining this macro only affects the way @file{libgcc.a} emulates
1404floating-point arithmetic.
1405
1406Not defining this macro is equivalent to returning zero.
1407@end defmac
1408
1409@defmac LARGEST_EXPONENT_IS_NORMAL (@var{size})
1410This macro should return true if floats with @var{size}
1411bits do not have a NaN or infinity representation, but use the largest
1412exponent for normal numbers instead.
1413
1414Defining this macro only affects the way @file{libgcc.a} emulates
1415floating-point arithmetic.
1416
1417The default definition of this macro returns false for all sizes.
1418@end defmac
1419
1420@hook TARGET_MS_BITFIELD_LAYOUT_P
1421This target hook returns @code{true} if bit-fields in the given
1422@var{record_type} are to be laid out following the rules of Microsoft
1423Visual C/C++, namely: (i) a bit-field won't share the same storage
1424unit with the previous bit-field if their underlying types have
1425different sizes, and the bit-field will be aligned to the highest
1426alignment of the underlying types of itself and of the previous
1427bit-field; (ii) a zero-sized bit-field will affect the alignment of
1428the whole enclosing structure, even if it is unnamed; except that
1429(iii) a zero-sized bit-field will be disregarded unless it follows
1430another bit-field of nonzero size. If this hook returns @code{true},
1431other macros that control bit-field layout are ignored.
1432
1433When a bit-field is inserted into a packed record, the whole size
1434of the underlying type is used by one or more same-size adjacent
1435bit-fields (that is, if its long:3, 32 bits is used in the record,
1436and any additional adjacent long bit-fields are packed into the same
1437chunk of 32 bits. However, if the size changes, a new field of that
1438size is allocated). In an unpacked record, this is the same as using
1439alignment, but not equivalent when packing.
1440
1441If both MS bit-fields and @samp{__attribute__((packed))} are used,
1442the latter will take precedence. If @samp{__attribute__((packed))} is
1443used on a single field when MS bit-fields are in use, it will take
1444precedence for that field, but the alignment of the rest of the structure
1445may affect its placement.
1446@end deftypefn
1447
1448@hook TARGET_DECIMAL_FLOAT_SUPPORTED_P
1449Returns true if the target supports decimal floating point.
1450@end deftypefn
1451
1452@hook TARGET_FIXED_POINT_SUPPORTED_P
1453Returns true if the target supports fixed-point arithmetic.
1454@end deftypefn
1455
1456@hook TARGET_EXPAND_TO_RTL_HOOK
1457This hook is called just before expansion into rtl, allowing the target
1458to perform additional initializations or analysis before the expansion.
1459For example, the rs6000 port uses it to allocate a scratch stack slot
1460for use in copying SDmode values between memory and floating point
1461registers whenever the function being expanded has any SDmode
1462usage.
1463@end deftypefn
1464
1465@hook TARGET_INSTANTIATE_DECLS
1466This hook allows the backend to perform additional instantiations on rtl
1467that are not actually in any insns yet, but will be later.
1468@end deftypefn
1469
1470@hook TARGET_MANGLE_TYPE
1471If your target defines any fundamental types, or any types your target
1472uses should be mangled differently from the default, define this hook
1473to return the appropriate encoding for these types as part of a C++
1474mangled name. The @var{type} argument is the tree structure representing
1475the type to be mangled. The hook may be applied to trees which are
1476not target-specific fundamental types; it should return @code{NULL}
1477for all such types, as well as arguments it does not recognize. If the
1478return value is not @code{NULL}, it must point to a statically-allocated
1479string constant.
1480
1481Target-specific fundamental types might be new fundamental types or
1482qualified versions of ordinary fundamental types. Encode new
1483fundamental types as @samp{@w{u @var{n} @var{name}}}, where @var{name}
1484is the name used for the type in source code, and @var{n} is the
1485length of @var{name} in decimal. Encode qualified versions of
1486ordinary types as @samp{@w{U @var{n} @var{name} @var{code}}}, where
1487@var{name} is the name used for the type qualifier in source code,
1488@var{n} is the length of @var{name} as above, and @var{code} is the
1489code used to represent the unqualified version of this type. (See
1490@code{write_builtin_type} in @file{cp/mangle.c} for the list of
1491codes.) In both cases the spaces are for clarity; do not include any
1492spaces in your string.
1493
1494This hook is applied to types prior to typedef resolution. If the mangled
1495name for a particular type depends only on that type's main variant, you
1496can perform typedef resolution yourself using @code{TYPE_MAIN_VARIANT}
1497before mangling.
1498
1499The default version of this hook always returns @code{NULL}, which is
1500appropriate for a target that does not define any new fundamental
1501types.
1502@end deftypefn
1503
1504@node Type Layout
1505@section Layout of Source Language Data Types
1506
1507These macros define the sizes and other characteristics of the standard
1508basic data types used in programs being compiled. Unlike the macros in
1509the previous section, these apply to specific features of C and related
1510languages, rather than to fundamental aspects of storage layout.
1511
1512@defmac INT_TYPE_SIZE
1513A C expression for the size in bits of the type @code{int} on the
1514target machine. If you don't define this, the default is one word.
1515@end defmac
1516
1517@defmac SHORT_TYPE_SIZE
1518A C expression for the size in bits of the type @code{short} on the
1519target machine. If you don't define this, the default is half a word.
1520(If this would be less than one storage unit, it is rounded up to one
1521unit.)
1522@end defmac
1523
1524@defmac LONG_TYPE_SIZE
1525A C expression for the size in bits of the type @code{long} on the
1526target machine. If you don't define this, the default is one word.
1527@end defmac
1528
1529@defmac ADA_LONG_TYPE_SIZE
1530On some machines, the size used for the Ada equivalent of the type
1531@code{long} by a native Ada compiler differs from that used by C@. In
1532that situation, define this macro to be a C expression to be used for
1533the size of that type. If you don't define this, the default is the
1534value of @code{LONG_TYPE_SIZE}.
1535@end defmac
1536
1537@defmac LONG_LONG_TYPE_SIZE
1538A C expression for the size in bits of the type @code{long long} on the
1539target machine. If you don't define this, the default is two
1540words. If you want to support GNU Ada on your machine, the value of this
1541macro must be at least 64.
1542@end defmac
1543
1544@defmac CHAR_TYPE_SIZE
1545A C expression for the size in bits of the type @code{char} on the
1546target machine. If you don't define this, the default is
1547@code{BITS_PER_UNIT}.
1548@end defmac
1549
1550@defmac BOOL_TYPE_SIZE
1551A C expression for the size in bits of the C++ type @code{bool} and
1552C99 type @code{_Bool} on the target machine. If you don't define
1553this, and you probably shouldn't, the default is @code{CHAR_TYPE_SIZE}.
1554@end defmac
1555
1556@defmac FLOAT_TYPE_SIZE
1557A C expression for the size in bits of the type @code{float} on the
1558target machine. If you don't define this, the default is one word.
1559@end defmac
1560
1561@defmac DOUBLE_TYPE_SIZE
1562A C expression for the size in bits of the type @code{double} on the
1563target machine. If you don't define this, the default is two
1564words.
1565@end defmac
1566
1567@defmac LONG_DOUBLE_TYPE_SIZE
1568A C expression for the size in bits of the type @code{long double} on
1569the target machine. If you don't define this, the default is two
1570words.
1571@end defmac
1572
1573@defmac SHORT_FRACT_TYPE_SIZE
1574A C expression for the size in bits of the type @code{short _Fract} on
1575the target machine. If you don't define this, the default is
1576@code{BITS_PER_UNIT}.
1577@end defmac
1578
1579@defmac FRACT_TYPE_SIZE
1580A C expression for the size in bits of the type @code{_Fract} on
1581the target machine. If you don't define this, the default is
1582@code{BITS_PER_UNIT * 2}.
1583@end defmac
1584
1585@defmac LONG_FRACT_TYPE_SIZE
1586A C expression for the size in bits of the type @code{long _Fract} on
1587the target machine. If you don't define this, the default is
1588@code{BITS_PER_UNIT * 4}.
1589@end defmac
1590
1591@defmac LONG_LONG_FRACT_TYPE_SIZE
1592A C expression for the size in bits of the type @code{long long _Fract} on
1593the target machine. If you don't define this, the default is
1594@code{BITS_PER_UNIT * 8}.
1595@end defmac
1596
1597@defmac SHORT_ACCUM_TYPE_SIZE
1598A C expression for the size in bits of the type @code{short _Accum} on
1599the target machine. If you don't define this, the default is
1600@code{BITS_PER_UNIT * 2}.
1601@end defmac
1602
1603@defmac ACCUM_TYPE_SIZE
1604A C expression for the size in bits of the type @code{_Accum} on
1605the target machine. If you don't define this, the default is
1606@code{BITS_PER_UNIT * 4}.
1607@end defmac
1608
1609@defmac LONG_ACCUM_TYPE_SIZE
1610A C expression for the size in bits of the type @code{long _Accum} on
1611the target machine. If you don't define this, the default is
1612@code{BITS_PER_UNIT * 8}.
1613@end defmac
1614
1615@defmac LONG_LONG_ACCUM_TYPE_SIZE
1616A C expression for the size in bits of the type @code{long long _Accum} on
1617the target machine. If you don't define this, the default is
1618@code{BITS_PER_UNIT * 16}.
1619@end defmac
1620
1621@defmac LIBGCC2_LONG_DOUBLE_TYPE_SIZE
1622Define this macro if @code{LONG_DOUBLE_TYPE_SIZE} is not constant or
1623if you want routines in @file{libgcc2.a} for a size other than
1624@code{LONG_DOUBLE_TYPE_SIZE}. If you don't define this, the
1625default is @code{LONG_DOUBLE_TYPE_SIZE}.
1626@end defmac
1627
1628@defmac LIBGCC2_HAS_DF_MODE
a18bdccd 1629Define this macro if neither @code{DOUBLE_TYPE_SIZE} nor
38f8b050
JR
1630@code{LIBGCC2_LONG_DOUBLE_TYPE_SIZE} is
1631@code{DFmode} but you want @code{DFmode} routines in @file{libgcc2.a}
a18bdccd 1632anyway. If you don't define this and either @code{DOUBLE_TYPE_SIZE}
38f8b050
JR
1633or @code{LIBGCC2_LONG_DOUBLE_TYPE_SIZE} is 64 then the default is 1,
1634otherwise it is 0.
1635@end defmac
1636
1637@defmac LIBGCC2_HAS_XF_MODE
1638Define this macro if @code{LIBGCC2_LONG_DOUBLE_TYPE_SIZE} is not
1639@code{XFmode} but you want @code{XFmode} routines in @file{libgcc2.a}
1640anyway. If you don't define this and @code{LIBGCC2_LONG_DOUBLE_TYPE_SIZE}
1641is 80 then the default is 1, otherwise it is 0.
1642@end defmac
1643
1644@defmac LIBGCC2_HAS_TF_MODE
1645Define this macro if @code{LIBGCC2_LONG_DOUBLE_TYPE_SIZE} is not
1646@code{TFmode} but you want @code{TFmode} routines in @file{libgcc2.a}
1647anyway. If you don't define this and @code{LIBGCC2_LONG_DOUBLE_TYPE_SIZE}
1648is 128 then the default is 1, otherwise it is 0.
1649@end defmac
1650
1651@defmac SF_SIZE
1652@defmacx DF_SIZE
1653@defmacx XF_SIZE
1654@defmacx TF_SIZE
1655Define these macros to be the size in bits of the mantissa of
1656@code{SFmode}, @code{DFmode}, @code{XFmode} and @code{TFmode} values,
1657if the defaults in @file{libgcc2.h} are inappropriate. By default,
1658@code{FLT_MANT_DIG} is used for @code{SF_SIZE}, @code{LDBL_MANT_DIG}
1659for @code{XF_SIZE} and @code{TF_SIZE}, and @code{DBL_MANT_DIG} or
1660@code{LDBL_MANT_DIG} for @code{DF_SIZE} according to whether
a18bdccd 1661@code{DOUBLE_TYPE_SIZE} or
38f8b050
JR
1662@code{LIBGCC2_LONG_DOUBLE_TYPE_SIZE} is 64.
1663@end defmac
1664
1665@defmac TARGET_FLT_EVAL_METHOD
1666A C expression for the value for @code{FLT_EVAL_METHOD} in @file{float.h},
1667assuming, if applicable, that the floating-point control word is in its
1668default state. If you do not define this macro the value of
1669@code{FLT_EVAL_METHOD} will be zero.
1670@end defmac
1671
1672@defmac WIDEST_HARDWARE_FP_SIZE
1673A C expression for the size in bits of the widest floating-point format
1674supported by the hardware. If you define this macro, you must specify a
1675value less than or equal to the value of @code{LONG_DOUBLE_TYPE_SIZE}.
1676If you do not define this macro, the value of @code{LONG_DOUBLE_TYPE_SIZE}
1677is the default.
1678@end defmac
1679
1680@defmac DEFAULT_SIGNED_CHAR
1681An expression whose value is 1 or 0, according to whether the type
1682@code{char} should be signed or unsigned by default. The user can
1683always override this default with the options @option{-fsigned-char}
1684and @option{-funsigned-char}.
1685@end defmac
1686
1687@hook TARGET_DEFAULT_SHORT_ENUMS
1688This target hook should return true if the compiler should give an
1689@code{enum} type only as many bytes as it takes to represent the range
1690of possible values of that type. It should return false if all
1691@code{enum} types should be allocated like @code{int}.
1692
1693The default is to return false.
1694@end deftypefn
1695
1696@defmac SIZE_TYPE
1697A C expression for a string describing the name of the data type to use
1698for size values. The typedef name @code{size_t} is defined using the
1699contents of the string.
1700
1701The string can contain more than one keyword. If so, separate them with
1702spaces, and write first any length keyword, then @code{unsigned} if
1703appropriate, and finally @code{int}. The string must exactly match one
1704of the data type names defined in the function
1705@code{init_decl_processing} in the file @file{c-decl.c}. You may not
1706omit @code{int} or change the order---that would cause the compiler to
1707crash on startup.
1708
1709If you don't define this macro, the default is @code{"long unsigned
1710int"}.
1711@end defmac
1712
1713@defmac PTRDIFF_TYPE
1714A C expression for a string describing the name of the data type to use
1715for the result of subtracting two pointers. The typedef name
1716@code{ptrdiff_t} is defined using the contents of the string. See
1717@code{SIZE_TYPE} above for more information.
1718
1719If you don't define this macro, the default is @code{"long int"}.
1720@end defmac
1721
1722@defmac WCHAR_TYPE
1723A C expression for a string describing the name of the data type to use
1724for wide characters. The typedef name @code{wchar_t} is defined using
1725the contents of the string. See @code{SIZE_TYPE} above for more
1726information.
1727
1728If you don't define this macro, the default is @code{"int"}.
1729@end defmac
1730
1731@defmac WCHAR_TYPE_SIZE
1732A C expression for the size in bits of the data type for wide
1733characters. This is used in @code{cpp}, which cannot make use of
1734@code{WCHAR_TYPE}.
1735@end defmac
1736
1737@defmac WINT_TYPE
1738A C expression for a string describing the name of the data type to
1739use for wide characters passed to @code{printf} and returned from
1740@code{getwc}. The typedef name @code{wint_t} is defined using the
1741contents of the string. See @code{SIZE_TYPE} above for more
1742information.
1743
1744If you don't define this macro, the default is @code{"unsigned int"}.
1745@end defmac
1746
1747@defmac INTMAX_TYPE
1748A C expression for a string describing the name of the data type that
1749can represent any value of any standard or extended signed integer type.
1750The typedef name @code{intmax_t} is defined using the contents of the
1751string. See @code{SIZE_TYPE} above for more information.
1752
1753If you don't define this macro, the default is the first of
1754@code{"int"}, @code{"long int"}, or @code{"long long int"} that has as
1755much precision as @code{long long int}.
1756@end defmac
1757
1758@defmac UINTMAX_TYPE
1759A C expression for a string describing the name of the data type that
1760can represent any value of any standard or extended unsigned integer
1761type. The typedef name @code{uintmax_t} is defined using the contents
1762of the string. See @code{SIZE_TYPE} above for more information.
1763
1764If you don't define this macro, the default is the first of
1765@code{"unsigned int"}, @code{"long unsigned int"}, or @code{"long long
1766unsigned int"} that has as much precision as @code{long long unsigned
1767int}.
1768@end defmac
1769
1770@defmac SIG_ATOMIC_TYPE
1771@defmacx INT8_TYPE
1772@defmacx INT16_TYPE
1773@defmacx INT32_TYPE
1774@defmacx INT64_TYPE
1775@defmacx UINT8_TYPE
1776@defmacx UINT16_TYPE
1777@defmacx UINT32_TYPE
1778@defmacx UINT64_TYPE
1779@defmacx INT_LEAST8_TYPE
1780@defmacx INT_LEAST16_TYPE
1781@defmacx INT_LEAST32_TYPE
1782@defmacx INT_LEAST64_TYPE
1783@defmacx UINT_LEAST8_TYPE
1784@defmacx UINT_LEAST16_TYPE
1785@defmacx UINT_LEAST32_TYPE
1786@defmacx UINT_LEAST64_TYPE
1787@defmacx INT_FAST8_TYPE
1788@defmacx INT_FAST16_TYPE
1789@defmacx INT_FAST32_TYPE
1790@defmacx INT_FAST64_TYPE
1791@defmacx UINT_FAST8_TYPE
1792@defmacx UINT_FAST16_TYPE
1793@defmacx UINT_FAST32_TYPE
1794@defmacx UINT_FAST64_TYPE
1795@defmacx INTPTR_TYPE
1796@defmacx UINTPTR_TYPE
1797C expressions for the standard types @code{sig_atomic_t},
1798@code{int8_t}, @code{int16_t}, @code{int32_t}, @code{int64_t},
1799@code{uint8_t}, @code{uint16_t}, @code{uint32_t}, @code{uint64_t},
1800@code{int_least8_t}, @code{int_least16_t}, @code{int_least32_t},
1801@code{int_least64_t}, @code{uint_least8_t}, @code{uint_least16_t},
1802@code{uint_least32_t}, @code{uint_least64_t}, @code{int_fast8_t},
1803@code{int_fast16_t}, @code{int_fast32_t}, @code{int_fast64_t},
1804@code{uint_fast8_t}, @code{uint_fast16_t}, @code{uint_fast32_t},
1805@code{uint_fast64_t}, @code{intptr_t}, and @code{uintptr_t}. See
1806@code{SIZE_TYPE} above for more information.
1807
1808If any of these macros evaluates to a null pointer, the corresponding
1809type is not supported; if GCC is configured to provide
1810@code{<stdint.h>} in such a case, the header provided may not conform
1811to C99, depending on the type in question. The defaults for all of
1812these macros are null pointers.
1813@end defmac
1814
1815@defmac TARGET_PTRMEMFUNC_VBIT_LOCATION
1816The C++ compiler represents a pointer-to-member-function with a struct
1817that looks like:
1818
1819@smallexample
1820 struct @{
1821 union @{
1822 void (*fn)();
1823 ptrdiff_t vtable_index;
1824 @};
1825 ptrdiff_t delta;
1826 @};
1827@end smallexample
1828
1829@noindent
1830The C++ compiler must use one bit to indicate whether the function that
1831will be called through a pointer-to-member-function is virtual.
1832Normally, we assume that the low-order bit of a function pointer must
1833always be zero. Then, by ensuring that the vtable_index is odd, we can
1834distinguish which variant of the union is in use. But, on some
1835platforms function pointers can be odd, and so this doesn't work. In
1836that case, we use the low-order bit of the @code{delta} field, and shift
1837the remainder of the @code{delta} field to the left.
1838
1839GCC will automatically make the right selection about where to store
1840this bit using the @code{FUNCTION_BOUNDARY} setting for your platform.
1841However, some platforms such as ARM/Thumb have @code{FUNCTION_BOUNDARY}
1842set such that functions always start at even addresses, but the lowest
1843bit of pointers to functions indicate whether the function at that
1844address is in ARM or Thumb mode. If this is the case of your
1845architecture, you should define this macro to
1846@code{ptrmemfunc_vbit_in_delta}.
1847
1848In general, you should not have to define this macro. On architectures
1849in which function addresses are always even, according to
1850@code{FUNCTION_BOUNDARY}, GCC will automatically define this macro to
1851@code{ptrmemfunc_vbit_in_pfn}.
1852@end defmac
1853
1854@defmac TARGET_VTABLE_USES_DESCRIPTORS
1855Normally, the C++ compiler uses function pointers in vtables. This
1856macro allows the target to change to use ``function descriptors''
1857instead. Function descriptors are found on targets for whom a
1858function pointer is actually a small data structure. Normally the
1859data structure consists of the actual code address plus a data
1860pointer to which the function's data is relative.
1861
1862If vtables are used, the value of this macro should be the number
1863of words that the function descriptor occupies.
1864@end defmac
1865
1866@defmac TARGET_VTABLE_ENTRY_ALIGN
1867By default, the vtable entries are void pointers, the so the alignment
1868is the same as pointer alignment. The value of this macro specifies
1869the alignment of the vtable entry in bits. It should be defined only
1870when special alignment is necessary. */
1871@end defmac
1872
1873@defmac TARGET_VTABLE_DATA_ENTRY_DISTANCE
1874There are a few non-descriptor entries in the vtable at offsets below
1875zero. If these entries must be padded (say, to preserve the alignment
1876specified by @code{TARGET_VTABLE_ENTRY_ALIGN}), set this to the number
1877of words in each data entry.
1878@end defmac
1879
1880@node Registers
1881@section Register Usage
1882@cindex register usage
1883
1884This section explains how to describe what registers the target machine
1885has, and how (in general) they can be used.
1886
1887The description of which registers a specific instruction can use is
1888done with register classes; see @ref{Register Classes}. For information
1889on using registers to access a stack frame, see @ref{Frame Registers}.
1890For passing values in registers, see @ref{Register Arguments}.
1891For returning values in registers, see @ref{Scalar Return}.
1892
1893@menu
1894* Register Basics:: Number and kinds of registers.
1895* Allocation Order:: Order in which registers are allocated.
1896* Values in Registers:: What kinds of values each reg can hold.
1897* Leaf Functions:: Renumbering registers for leaf functions.
1898* Stack Registers:: Handling a register stack such as 80387.
1899@end menu
1900
1901@node Register Basics
1902@subsection Basic Characteristics of Registers
1903
1904@c prevent bad page break with this line
1905Registers have various characteristics.
1906
1907@defmac FIRST_PSEUDO_REGISTER
1908Number of hardware registers known to the compiler. They receive
1909numbers 0 through @code{FIRST_PSEUDO_REGISTER-1}; thus, the first
1910pseudo register's number really is assigned the number
1911@code{FIRST_PSEUDO_REGISTER}.
1912@end defmac
1913
1914@defmac FIXED_REGISTERS
1915@cindex fixed register
1916An initializer that says which registers are used for fixed purposes
1917all throughout the compiled code and are therefore not available for
1918general allocation. These would include the stack pointer, the frame
1919pointer (except on machines where that can be used as a general
1920register when no frame pointer is needed), the program counter on
1921machines where that is considered one of the addressable registers,
1922and any other numbered register with a standard use.
1923
1924This information is expressed as a sequence of numbers, separated by
1925commas and surrounded by braces. The @var{n}th number is 1 if
1926register @var{n} is fixed, 0 otherwise.
1927
1928The table initialized from this macro, and the table initialized by
1929the following one, may be overridden at run time either automatically,
1930by the actions of the macro @code{CONDITIONAL_REGISTER_USAGE}, or by
1931the user with the command options @option{-ffixed-@var{reg}},
1932@option{-fcall-used-@var{reg}} and @option{-fcall-saved-@var{reg}}.
1933@end defmac
1934
1935@defmac CALL_USED_REGISTERS
1936@cindex call-used register
1937@cindex call-clobbered register
1938@cindex call-saved register
1939Like @code{FIXED_REGISTERS} but has 1 for each register that is
1940clobbered (in general) by function calls as well as for fixed
1941registers. This macro therefore identifies the registers that are not
1942available for general allocation of values that must live across
1943function calls.
1944
1945If a register has 0 in @code{CALL_USED_REGISTERS}, the compiler
1946automatically saves it on function entry and restores it on function
1947exit, if the register is used within the function.
1948@end defmac
1949
1950@defmac CALL_REALLY_USED_REGISTERS
1951@cindex call-used register
1952@cindex call-clobbered register
1953@cindex call-saved register
1954Like @code{CALL_USED_REGISTERS} except this macro doesn't require
1955that the entire set of @code{FIXED_REGISTERS} be included.
1956(@code{CALL_USED_REGISTERS} must be a superset of @code{FIXED_REGISTERS}).
1957This macro is optional. If not specified, it defaults to the value
1958of @code{CALL_USED_REGISTERS}.
1959@end defmac
1960
1961@defmac HARD_REGNO_CALL_PART_CLOBBERED (@var{regno}, @var{mode})
1962@cindex call-used register
1963@cindex call-clobbered register
1964@cindex call-saved register
1965A C expression that is nonzero if it is not permissible to store a
1966value of mode @var{mode} in hard register number @var{regno} across a
1967call without some part of it being clobbered. For most machines this
1968macro need not be defined. It is only required for machines that do not
1969preserve the entire contents of a register across a call.
1970@end defmac
1971
1972@findex fixed_regs
1973@findex call_used_regs
1974@findex global_regs
1975@findex reg_names
1976@findex reg_class_contents
1977@defmac CONDITIONAL_REGISTER_USAGE
1978Zero or more C statements that may conditionally modify five variables
1979@code{fixed_regs}, @code{call_used_regs}, @code{global_regs},
1980@code{reg_names}, and @code{reg_class_contents}, to take into account
1981any dependence of these register sets on target flags. The first three
1982of these are of type @code{char []} (interpreted as Boolean vectors).
1983@code{global_regs} is a @code{const char *[]}, and
1984@code{reg_class_contents} is a @code{HARD_REG_SET}. Before the macro is
1985called, @code{fixed_regs}, @code{call_used_regs},
1986@code{reg_class_contents}, and @code{reg_names} have been initialized
1987from @code{FIXED_REGISTERS}, @code{CALL_USED_REGISTERS},
1988@code{REG_CLASS_CONTENTS}, and @code{REGISTER_NAMES}, respectively.
1989@code{global_regs} has been cleared, and any @option{-ffixed-@var{reg}},
1990@option{-fcall-used-@var{reg}} and @option{-fcall-saved-@var{reg}}
1991command options have been applied.
1992
1993You need not define this macro if it has no work to do.
1994
1995@cindex disabling certain registers
1996@cindex controlling register usage
1997If the usage of an entire class of registers depends on the target
1998flags, you may indicate this to GCC by using this macro to modify
1999@code{fixed_regs} and @code{call_used_regs} to 1 for each of the
2000registers in the classes which should not be used by GCC@. Also define
2001the macro @code{REG_CLASS_FROM_LETTER} / @code{REG_CLASS_FROM_CONSTRAINT}
2002to return @code{NO_REGS} if it
2003is called with a letter for a class that shouldn't be used.
2004
2005(However, if this class is not included in @code{GENERAL_REGS} and all
2006of the insn patterns whose constraints permit this class are
2007controlled by target switches, then GCC will automatically avoid using
2008these registers when the target switches are opposed to them.)
2009@end defmac
2010
2011@defmac INCOMING_REGNO (@var{out})
2012Define this macro if the target machine has register windows. This C
2013expression returns the register number as seen by the called function
2014corresponding to the register number @var{out} as seen by the calling
2015function. Return @var{out} if register number @var{out} is not an
2016outbound register.
2017@end defmac
2018
2019@defmac OUTGOING_REGNO (@var{in})
2020Define this macro if the target machine has register windows. This C
2021expression returns the register number as seen by the calling function
2022corresponding to the register number @var{in} as seen by the called
2023function. Return @var{in} if register number @var{in} is not an inbound
2024register.
2025@end defmac
2026
2027@defmac LOCAL_REGNO (@var{regno})
2028Define this macro if the target machine has register windows. This C
2029expression returns true if the register is call-saved but is in the
2030register window. Unlike most call-saved registers, such registers
2031need not be explicitly restored on function exit or during non-local
2032gotos.
2033@end defmac
2034
2035@defmac PC_REGNUM
2036If the program counter has a register number, define this as that
2037register number. Otherwise, do not define it.
2038@end defmac
2039
2040@node Allocation Order
2041@subsection Order of Allocation of Registers
2042@cindex order of register allocation
2043@cindex register allocation order
2044
2045@c prevent bad page break with this line
2046Registers are allocated in order.
2047
2048@defmac REG_ALLOC_ORDER
2049If defined, an initializer for a vector of integers, containing the
2050numbers of hard registers in the order in which GCC should prefer
2051to use them (from most preferred to least).
2052
2053If this macro is not defined, registers are used lowest numbered first
2054(all else being equal).
2055
2056One use of this macro is on machines where the highest numbered
2057registers must always be saved and the save-multiple-registers
2058instruction supports only sequences of consecutive registers. On such
2059machines, define @code{REG_ALLOC_ORDER} to be an initializer that lists
2060the highest numbered allocable register first.
2061@end defmac
2062
2063@defmac ADJUST_REG_ALLOC_ORDER
2064A C statement (sans semicolon) to choose the order in which to allocate
2065hard registers for pseudo-registers local to a basic block.
2066
2067Store the desired register order in the array @code{reg_alloc_order}.
2068Element 0 should be the register to allocate first; element 1, the next
2069register; and so on.
2070
2071The macro body should not assume anything about the contents of
2072@code{reg_alloc_order} before execution of the macro.
2073
2074On most machines, it is not necessary to define this macro.
2075@end defmac
2076
2077@defmac HONOR_REG_ALLOC_ORDER
2078Normally, IRA tries to estimate the costs for saving a register in the
2079prologue and restoring it in the epilogue. This discourages it from
2080using call-saved registers. If a machine wants to ensure that IRA
2081allocates registers in the order given by REG_ALLOC_ORDER even if some
2082call-saved registers appear earlier than call-used ones, this macro
2083should be defined.
2084@end defmac
2085
2086@defmac IRA_HARD_REGNO_ADD_COST_MULTIPLIER (@var{regno})
2087In some case register allocation order is not enough for the
2088Integrated Register Allocator (@acronym{IRA}) to generate a good code.
2089If this macro is defined, it should return a floating point value
2090based on @var{regno}. The cost of using @var{regno} for a pseudo will
2091be increased by approximately the pseudo's usage frequency times the
2092value returned by this macro. Not defining this macro is equivalent
2093to having it always return @code{0.0}.
2094
2095On most machines, it is not necessary to define this macro.
2096@end defmac
2097
2098@node Values in Registers
2099@subsection How Values Fit in Registers
2100
2101This section discusses the macros that describe which kinds of values
2102(specifically, which machine modes) each register can hold, and how many
2103consecutive registers are needed for a given mode.
2104
2105@defmac HARD_REGNO_NREGS (@var{regno}, @var{mode})
2106A C expression for the number of consecutive hard registers, starting
2107at register number @var{regno}, required to hold a value of mode
2108@var{mode}. This macro must never return zero, even if a register
2109cannot hold the requested mode - indicate that with HARD_REGNO_MODE_OK
2110and/or CANNOT_CHANGE_MODE_CLASS instead.
2111
2112On a machine where all registers are exactly one word, a suitable
2113definition of this macro is
2114
2115@smallexample
2116#define HARD_REGNO_NREGS(REGNO, MODE) \
2117 ((GET_MODE_SIZE (MODE) + UNITS_PER_WORD - 1) \
2118 / UNITS_PER_WORD)
2119@end smallexample
2120@end defmac
2121
2122@defmac HARD_REGNO_NREGS_HAS_PADDING (@var{regno}, @var{mode})
2123A C expression that is nonzero if a value of mode @var{mode}, stored
2124in memory, ends with padding that causes it to take up more space than
2125in registers starting at register number @var{regno} (as determined by
2126multiplying GCC's notion of the size of the register when containing
2127this mode by the number of registers returned by
2128@code{HARD_REGNO_NREGS}). By default this is zero.
2129
2130For example, if a floating-point value is stored in three 32-bit
2131registers but takes up 128 bits in memory, then this would be
2132nonzero.
2133
2134This macros only needs to be defined if there are cases where
2135@code{subreg_get_info}
2136would otherwise wrongly determine that a @code{subreg} can be
2137represented by an offset to the register number, when in fact such a
2138@code{subreg} would contain some of the padding not stored in
2139registers and so not be representable.
2140@end defmac
2141
2142@defmac HARD_REGNO_NREGS_WITH_PADDING (@var{regno}, @var{mode})
2143For values of @var{regno} and @var{mode} for which
2144@code{HARD_REGNO_NREGS_HAS_PADDING} returns nonzero, a C expression
2145returning the greater number of registers required to hold the value
2146including any padding. In the example above, the value would be four.
2147@end defmac
2148
2149@defmac REGMODE_NATURAL_SIZE (@var{mode})
2150Define this macro if the natural size of registers that hold values
2151of mode @var{mode} is not the word size. It is a C expression that
2152should give the natural size in bytes for the specified mode. It is
2153used by the register allocator to try to optimize its results. This
2154happens for example on SPARC 64-bit where the natural size of
2155floating-point registers is still 32-bit.
2156@end defmac
2157
2158@defmac HARD_REGNO_MODE_OK (@var{regno}, @var{mode})
2159A C expression that is nonzero if it is permissible to store a value
2160of mode @var{mode} in hard register number @var{regno} (or in several
2161registers starting with that one). For a machine where all registers
2162are equivalent, a suitable definition is
2163
2164@smallexample
2165#define HARD_REGNO_MODE_OK(REGNO, MODE) 1
2166@end smallexample
2167
2168You need not include code to check for the numbers of fixed registers,
2169because the allocation mechanism considers them to be always occupied.
2170
2171@cindex register pairs
2172On some machines, double-precision values must be kept in even/odd
2173register pairs. You can implement that by defining this macro to reject
2174odd register numbers for such modes.
2175
2176The minimum requirement for a mode to be OK in a register is that the
2177@samp{mov@var{mode}} instruction pattern support moves between the
2178register and other hard register in the same class and that moving a
2179value into the register and back out not alter it.
2180
2181Since the same instruction used to move @code{word_mode} will work for
2182all narrower integer modes, it is not necessary on any machine for
2183@code{HARD_REGNO_MODE_OK} to distinguish between these modes, provided
2184you define patterns @samp{movhi}, etc., to take advantage of this. This
2185is useful because of the interaction between @code{HARD_REGNO_MODE_OK}
2186and @code{MODES_TIEABLE_P}; it is very desirable for all integer modes
2187to be tieable.
2188
2189Many machines have special registers for floating point arithmetic.
2190Often people assume that floating point machine modes are allowed only
2191in floating point registers. This is not true. Any registers that
2192can hold integers can safely @emph{hold} a floating point machine
2193mode, whether or not floating arithmetic can be done on it in those
2194registers. Integer move instructions can be used to move the values.
2195
2196On some machines, though, the converse is true: fixed-point machine
2197modes may not go in floating registers. This is true if the floating
2198registers normalize any value stored in them, because storing a
2199non-floating value there would garble it. In this case,
2200@code{HARD_REGNO_MODE_OK} should reject fixed-point machine modes in
2201floating registers. But if the floating registers do not automatically
2202normalize, if you can store any bit pattern in one and retrieve it
2203unchanged without a trap, then any machine mode may go in a floating
2204register, so you can define this macro to say so.
2205
2206The primary significance of special floating registers is rather that
2207they are the registers acceptable in floating point arithmetic
2208instructions. However, this is of no concern to
2209@code{HARD_REGNO_MODE_OK}. You handle it by writing the proper
2210constraints for those instructions.
2211
2212On some machines, the floating registers are especially slow to access,
2213so that it is better to store a value in a stack frame than in such a
2214register if floating point arithmetic is not being done. As long as the
2215floating registers are not in class @code{GENERAL_REGS}, they will not
2216be used unless some pattern's constraint asks for one.
2217@end defmac
2218
2219@defmac HARD_REGNO_RENAME_OK (@var{from}, @var{to})
2220A C expression that is nonzero if it is OK to rename a hard register
2221@var{from} to another hard register @var{to}.
2222
2223One common use of this macro is to prevent renaming of a register to
2224another register that is not saved by a prologue in an interrupt
2225handler.
2226
2227The default is always nonzero.
2228@end defmac
2229
2230@defmac MODES_TIEABLE_P (@var{mode1}, @var{mode2})
2231A C expression that is nonzero if a value of mode
2232@var{mode1} is accessible in mode @var{mode2} without copying.
2233
2234If @code{HARD_REGNO_MODE_OK (@var{r}, @var{mode1})} and
2235@code{HARD_REGNO_MODE_OK (@var{r}, @var{mode2})} are always the same for
2236any @var{r}, then @code{MODES_TIEABLE_P (@var{mode1}, @var{mode2})}
2237should be nonzero. If they differ for any @var{r}, you should define
2238this macro to return zero unless some other mechanism ensures the
2239accessibility of the value in a narrower mode.
2240
2241You should define this macro to return nonzero in as many cases as
2242possible since doing so will allow GCC to perform better register
2243allocation.
2244@end defmac
2245
2246@hook TARGET_HARD_REGNO_SCRATCH_OK
2247This target hook should return @code{true} if it is OK to use a hard register
2248@var{regno} as scratch reg in peephole2.
2249
2250One common use of this macro is to prevent using of a register that
2251is not saved by a prologue in an interrupt handler.
2252
2253The default version of this hook always returns @code{true}.
2254@end deftypefn
2255
2256@defmac AVOID_CCMODE_COPIES
2257Define this macro if the compiler should avoid copies to/from @code{CCmode}
2258registers. You should only define this macro if support for copying to/from
2259@code{CCmode} is incomplete.
2260@end defmac
2261
2262@node Leaf Functions
2263@subsection Handling Leaf Functions
2264
2265@cindex leaf functions
2266@cindex functions, leaf
2267On some machines, a leaf function (i.e., one which makes no calls) can run
2268more efficiently if it does not make its own register window. Often this
2269means it is required to receive its arguments in the registers where they
2270are passed by the caller, instead of the registers where they would
2271normally arrive.
2272
2273The special treatment for leaf functions generally applies only when
2274other conditions are met; for example, often they may use only those
2275registers for its own variables and temporaries. We use the term ``leaf
2276function'' to mean a function that is suitable for this special
2277handling, so that functions with no calls are not necessarily ``leaf
2278functions''.
2279
2280GCC assigns register numbers before it knows whether the function is
2281suitable for leaf function treatment. So it needs to renumber the
2282registers in order to output a leaf function. The following macros
2283accomplish this.
2284
2285@defmac LEAF_REGISTERS
2286Name of a char vector, indexed by hard register number, which
2287contains 1 for a register that is allowable in a candidate for leaf
2288function treatment.
2289
2290If leaf function treatment involves renumbering the registers, then the
2291registers marked here should be the ones before renumbering---those that
2292GCC would ordinarily allocate. The registers which will actually be
2293used in the assembler code, after renumbering, should not be marked with 1
2294in this vector.
2295
2296Define this macro only if the target machine offers a way to optimize
2297the treatment of leaf functions.
2298@end defmac
2299
2300@defmac LEAF_REG_REMAP (@var{regno})
2301A C expression whose value is the register number to which @var{regno}
2302should be renumbered, when a function is treated as a leaf function.
2303
2304If @var{regno} is a register number which should not appear in a leaf
2305function before renumbering, then the expression should yield @minus{}1, which
2306will cause the compiler to abort.
2307
2308Define this macro only if the target machine offers a way to optimize the
2309treatment of leaf functions, and registers need to be renumbered to do
2310this.
2311@end defmac
2312
2313@findex current_function_is_leaf
2314@findex current_function_uses_only_leaf_regs
2315@code{TARGET_ASM_FUNCTION_PROLOGUE} and
2316@code{TARGET_ASM_FUNCTION_EPILOGUE} must usually treat leaf functions
2317specially. They can test the C variable @code{current_function_is_leaf}
2318which is nonzero for leaf functions. @code{current_function_is_leaf} is
2319set prior to local register allocation and is valid for the remaining
2320compiler passes. They can also test the C variable
2321@code{current_function_uses_only_leaf_regs} which is nonzero for leaf
2322functions which only use leaf registers.
2323@code{current_function_uses_only_leaf_regs} is valid after all passes
2324that modify the instructions have been run and is only useful if
2325@code{LEAF_REGISTERS} is defined.
2326@c changed this to fix overfull. ALSO: why the "it" at the beginning
2327@c of the next paragraph?! --mew 2feb93
2328
2329@node Stack Registers
2330@subsection Registers That Form a Stack
2331
2332There are special features to handle computers where some of the
2333``registers'' form a stack. Stack registers are normally written by
2334pushing onto the stack, and are numbered relative to the top of the
2335stack.
2336
2337Currently, GCC can only handle one group of stack-like registers, and
2338they must be consecutively numbered. Furthermore, the existing
2339support for stack-like registers is specific to the 80387 floating
2340point coprocessor. If you have a new architecture that uses
2341stack-like registers, you will need to do substantial work on
2342@file{reg-stack.c} and write your machine description to cooperate
2343with it, as well as defining these macros.
2344
2345@defmac STACK_REGS
2346Define this if the machine has any stack-like registers.
2347@end defmac
2348
2349@defmac STACK_REG_COVER_CLASS
2350This is a cover class containing the stack registers. Define this if
2351the machine has any stack-like registers.
2352@end defmac
2353
2354@defmac FIRST_STACK_REG
2355The number of the first stack-like register. This one is the top
2356of the stack.
2357@end defmac
2358
2359@defmac LAST_STACK_REG
2360The number of the last stack-like register. This one is the bottom of
2361the stack.
2362@end defmac
2363
2364@node Register Classes
2365@section Register Classes
2366@cindex register class definitions
2367@cindex class definitions, register
2368
2369On many machines, the numbered registers are not all equivalent.
2370For example, certain registers may not be allowed for indexed addressing;
2371certain registers may not be allowed in some instructions. These machine
2372restrictions are described to the compiler using @dfn{register classes}.
2373
2374You define a number of register classes, giving each one a name and saying
2375which of the registers belong to it. Then you can specify register classes
2376that are allowed as operands to particular instruction patterns.
2377
2378@findex ALL_REGS
2379@findex NO_REGS
2380In general, each register will belong to several classes. In fact, one
2381class must be named @code{ALL_REGS} and contain all the registers. Another
2382class must be named @code{NO_REGS} and contain no registers. Often the
2383union of two classes will be another class; however, this is not required.
2384
2385@findex GENERAL_REGS
2386One of the classes must be named @code{GENERAL_REGS}. There is nothing
2387terribly special about the name, but the operand constraint letters
2388@samp{r} and @samp{g} specify this class. If @code{GENERAL_REGS} is
2389the same as @code{ALL_REGS}, just define it as a macro which expands
2390to @code{ALL_REGS}.
2391
2392Order the classes so that if class @var{x} is contained in class @var{y}
2393then @var{x} has a lower class number than @var{y}.
2394
2395The way classes other than @code{GENERAL_REGS} are specified in operand
2396constraints is through machine-dependent operand constraint letters.
2397You can define such letters to correspond to various classes, then use
2398them in operand constraints.
2399
2400You should define a class for the union of two classes whenever some
2401instruction allows both classes. For example, if an instruction allows
2402either a floating point (coprocessor) register or a general register for a
2403certain operand, you should define a class @code{FLOAT_OR_GENERAL_REGS}
2404which includes both of them. Otherwise you will get suboptimal code.
2405
2406You must also specify certain redundant information about the register
2407classes: for each class, which classes contain it and which ones are
2408contained in it; for each pair of classes, the largest class contained
2409in their union.
2410
2411When a value occupying several consecutive registers is expected in a
2412certain class, all the registers used must belong to that class.
2413Therefore, register classes cannot be used to enforce a requirement for
2414a register pair to start with an even-numbered register. The way to
2415specify this requirement is with @code{HARD_REGNO_MODE_OK}.
2416
2417Register classes used for input-operands of bitwise-and or shift
2418instructions have a special requirement: each such class must have, for
2419each fixed-point machine mode, a subclass whose registers can transfer that
2420mode to or from memory. For example, on some machines, the operations for
2421single-byte values (@code{QImode}) are limited to certain registers. When
2422this is so, each register class that is used in a bitwise-and or shift
2423instruction must have a subclass consisting of registers from which
2424single-byte values can be loaded or stored. This is so that
2425@code{PREFERRED_RELOAD_CLASS} can always have a possible value to return.
2426
2427@deftp {Data type} {enum reg_class}
2428An enumerated type that must be defined with all the register class names
2429as enumerated values. @code{NO_REGS} must be first. @code{ALL_REGS}
2430must be the last register class, followed by one more enumerated value,
2431@code{LIM_REG_CLASSES}, which is not a register class but rather
2432tells how many classes there are.
2433
2434Each register class has a number, which is the value of casting
2435the class name to type @code{int}. The number serves as an index
2436in many of the tables described below.
2437@end deftp
2438
2439@defmac N_REG_CLASSES
2440The number of distinct register classes, defined as follows:
2441
2442@smallexample
2443#define N_REG_CLASSES (int) LIM_REG_CLASSES
2444@end smallexample
2445@end defmac
2446
2447@defmac REG_CLASS_NAMES
2448An initializer containing the names of the register classes as C string
2449constants. These names are used in writing some of the debugging dumps.
2450@end defmac
2451
2452@defmac REG_CLASS_CONTENTS
2453An initializer containing the contents of the register classes, as integers
2454which are bit masks. The @var{n}th integer specifies the contents of class
2455@var{n}. The way the integer @var{mask} is interpreted is that
2456register @var{r} is in the class if @code{@var{mask} & (1 << @var{r})} is 1.
2457
2458When the machine has more than 32 registers, an integer does not suffice.
2459Then the integers are replaced by sub-initializers, braced groupings containing
2460several integers. Each sub-initializer must be suitable as an initializer
2461for the type @code{HARD_REG_SET} which is defined in @file{hard-reg-set.h}.
2462In this situation, the first integer in each sub-initializer corresponds to
2463registers 0 through 31, the second integer to registers 32 through 63, and
2464so on.
2465@end defmac
2466
2467@defmac REGNO_REG_CLASS (@var{regno})
2468A C expression whose value is a register class containing hard register
2469@var{regno}. In general there is more than one such class; choose a class
2470which is @dfn{minimal}, meaning that no smaller class also contains the
2471register.
2472@end defmac
2473
2474@defmac BASE_REG_CLASS
2475A macro whose definition is the name of the class to which a valid
2476base register must belong. A base register is one used in an address
2477which is the register value plus a displacement.
2478@end defmac
2479
2480@defmac MODE_BASE_REG_CLASS (@var{mode})
2481This is a variation of the @code{BASE_REG_CLASS} macro which allows
2482the selection of a base register in a mode dependent manner. If
2483@var{mode} is VOIDmode then it should return the same value as
2484@code{BASE_REG_CLASS}.
2485@end defmac
2486
2487@defmac MODE_BASE_REG_REG_CLASS (@var{mode})
2488A C expression whose value is the register class to which a valid
2489base register must belong in order to be used in a base plus index
2490register address. You should define this macro if base plus index
2491addresses have different requirements than other base register uses.
2492@end defmac
2493
2494@defmac MODE_CODE_BASE_REG_CLASS (@var{mode}, @var{outer_code}, @var{index_code})
2495A C expression whose value is the register class to which a valid
2496base register must belong. @var{outer_code} and @var{index_code} define the
2497context in which the base register occurs. @var{outer_code} is the code of
2498the immediately enclosing expression (@code{MEM} for the top level of an
2499address, @code{ADDRESS} for something that occurs in an
2500@code{address_operand}). @var{index_code} is the code of the corresponding
2501index expression if @var{outer_code} is @code{PLUS}; @code{SCRATCH} otherwise.
2502@end defmac
2503
2504@defmac INDEX_REG_CLASS
2505A macro whose definition is the name of the class to which a valid
2506index register must belong. An index register is one used in an
2507address where its value is either multiplied by a scale factor or
2508added to another register (as well as added to a displacement).
2509@end defmac
2510
2511@defmac REGNO_OK_FOR_BASE_P (@var{num})
2512A C expression which is nonzero if register number @var{num} is
2513suitable for use as a base register in operand addresses.
2514Like @code{TARGET_LEGITIMATE_ADDRESS_P}, this macro should also
2515define a strict and a non-strict variant. Both variants behave
2516the same for hard register; for pseudos, the strict variant will
2517pass only those that have been allocated to a valid hard registers,
2518while the non-strict variant will pass all pseudos.
2519
2520@findex REG_OK_STRICT
2521Compiler source files that want to use the strict variant of this and
2522other macros define the macro @code{REG_OK_STRICT}. You should use an
2523@code{#ifdef REG_OK_STRICT} conditional to define the strict variant in
2524that case and the non-strict variant otherwise.
2525@end defmac
2526
2527@defmac REGNO_MODE_OK_FOR_BASE_P (@var{num}, @var{mode})
2528A C expression that is just like @code{REGNO_OK_FOR_BASE_P}, except that
2529that expression may examine the mode of the memory reference in
2530@var{mode}. You should define this macro if the mode of the memory
2531reference affects whether a register may be used as a base register. If
2532you define this macro, the compiler will use it instead of
2533@code{REGNO_OK_FOR_BASE_P}. The mode may be @code{VOIDmode} for
2534addresses that appear outside a @code{MEM}, i.e., as an
2535@code{address_operand}.
2536
2537This macro also has strict and non-strict variants.
2538@end defmac
2539
2540@defmac REGNO_MODE_OK_FOR_REG_BASE_P (@var{num}, @var{mode})
2541A C expression which is nonzero if register number @var{num} is suitable for
2542use as a base register in base plus index operand addresses, accessing
2543memory in mode @var{mode}. It may be either a suitable hard register or a
2544pseudo register that has been allocated such a hard register. You should
2545define this macro if base plus index addresses have different requirements
2546than other base register uses.
2547
2548Use of this macro is deprecated; please use the more general
2549@code{REGNO_MODE_CODE_OK_FOR_BASE_P}.
2550
2551This macro also has strict and non-strict variants.
2552@end defmac
2553
2554@defmac REGNO_MODE_CODE_OK_FOR_BASE_P (@var{num}, @var{mode}, @var{outer_code}, @var{index_code})
2555A C expression that is just like @code{REGNO_MODE_OK_FOR_BASE_P}, except
2556that that expression may examine the context in which the register
2557appears in the memory reference. @var{outer_code} is the code of the
2558immediately enclosing expression (@code{MEM} if at the top level of the
2559address, @code{ADDRESS} for something that occurs in an
2560@code{address_operand}). @var{index_code} is the code of the
2561corresponding index expression if @var{outer_code} is @code{PLUS};
2562@code{SCRATCH} otherwise. The mode may be @code{VOIDmode} for addresses
2563that appear outside a @code{MEM}, i.e., as an @code{address_operand}.
2564
2565This macro also has strict and non-strict variants.
2566@end defmac
2567
2568@defmac REGNO_OK_FOR_INDEX_P (@var{num})
2569A C expression which is nonzero if register number @var{num} is
2570suitable for use as an index register in operand addresses. It may be
2571either a suitable hard register or a pseudo register that has been
2572allocated such a hard register.
2573
2574The difference between an index register and a base register is that
2575the index register may be scaled. If an address involves the sum of
2576two registers, neither one of them scaled, then either one may be
2577labeled the ``base'' and the other the ``index''; but whichever
2578labeling is used must fit the machine's constraints of which registers
2579may serve in each capacity. The compiler will try both labelings,
2580looking for one that is valid, and will reload one or both registers
2581only if neither labeling works.
2582
2583This macro also has strict and non-strict variants.
2584@end defmac
2585
fba42e24
AS
2586@hook TARGET_PREFERRED_RELOAD_CLASS
2587A target hook that places additional restrictions on the register class
2588to use when it is necessary to copy value @var{x} into a register in class
2589@var{rclass}. The value is a register class; perhaps @var{rclass}, or perhaps
2590another, smaller class.
2591
2592The default version of this hook always returns value of @code{rclass} argument.
2593
2594Sometimes returning a more restrictive class makes better code. For
2595example, on the 68000, when @var{x} is an integer constant that is in range
2596for a @samp{moveq} instruction, the value of this macro is always
2597@code{DATA_REGS} as long as @var{rclass} includes the data registers.
2598Requiring a data register guarantees that a @samp{moveq} will be used.
2599
2600One case where @code{TARGET_PREFERRED_RELOAD_CLASS} must not return
2601@var{rclass} is if @var{x} is a legitimate constant which cannot be
2602loaded into some register class. By returning @code{NO_REGS} you can
2603force @var{x} into a memory location. For example, rs6000 can load
2604immediate values into general-purpose registers, but does not have an
2605instruction for loading an immediate value into a floating-point
2606register, so @code{TARGET_PREFERRED_RELOAD_CLASS} returns @code{NO_REGS} when
2607@var{x} is a floating-point constant. If the constant can't be loaded
2608into any kind of register, code generation will be better if
2609@code{LEGITIMATE_CONSTANT_P} makes the constant illegitimate instead
2610of using @code{TARGET_PREFERRED_RELOAD_CLASS}.
2611
2612If an insn has pseudos in it after register allocation, reload will go
2613through the alternatives and call repeatedly @code{TARGET_PREFERRED_RELOAD_CLASS}
2614to find the best one. Returning @code{NO_REGS}, in this case, makes
2615reload add a @code{!} in front of the constraint: the x86 back-end uses
2616this feature to discourage usage of 387 registers when math is done in
2617the SSE registers (and vice versa).
2618@end deftypefn
2619
38f8b050
JR
2620@defmac PREFERRED_RELOAD_CLASS (@var{x}, @var{class})
2621A C expression that places additional restrictions on the register class
2622to use when it is necessary to copy value @var{x} into a register in class
2623@var{class}. The value is a register class; perhaps @var{class}, or perhaps
2624another, smaller class. On many machines, the following definition is
2625safe:
2626
2627@smallexample
2628#define PREFERRED_RELOAD_CLASS(X,CLASS) CLASS
2629@end smallexample
2630
2631Sometimes returning a more restrictive class makes better code. For
2632example, on the 68000, when @var{x} is an integer constant that is in range
2633for a @samp{moveq} instruction, the value of this macro is always
2634@code{DATA_REGS} as long as @var{class} includes the data registers.
2635Requiring a data register guarantees that a @samp{moveq} will be used.
2636
2637One case where @code{PREFERRED_RELOAD_CLASS} must not return
2638@var{class} is if @var{x} is a legitimate constant which cannot be
2639loaded into some register class. By returning @code{NO_REGS} you can
2640force @var{x} into a memory location. For example, rs6000 can load
2641immediate values into general-purpose registers, but does not have an
2642instruction for loading an immediate value into a floating-point
2643register, so @code{PREFERRED_RELOAD_CLASS} returns @code{NO_REGS} when
2644@var{x} is a floating-point constant. If the constant can't be loaded
2645into any kind of register, code generation will be better if
2646@code{LEGITIMATE_CONSTANT_P} makes the constant illegitimate instead
2647of using @code{PREFERRED_RELOAD_CLASS}.
2648
2649If an insn has pseudos in it after register allocation, reload will go
2650through the alternatives and call repeatedly @code{PREFERRED_RELOAD_CLASS}
2651to find the best one. Returning @code{NO_REGS}, in this case, makes
2652reload add a @code{!} in front of the constraint: the x86 back-end uses
2653this feature to discourage usage of 387 registers when math is done in
2654the SSE registers (and vice versa).
2655@end defmac
2656
2657@defmac PREFERRED_OUTPUT_RELOAD_CLASS (@var{x}, @var{class})
2658Like @code{PREFERRED_RELOAD_CLASS}, but for output reloads instead of
2659input reloads. If you don't define this macro, the default is to use
2660@var{class}, unchanged.
2661
2662You can also use @code{PREFERRED_OUTPUT_RELOAD_CLASS} to discourage
2663reload from using some alternatives, like @code{PREFERRED_RELOAD_CLASS}.
2664@end defmac
2665
2666@defmac LIMIT_RELOAD_CLASS (@var{mode}, @var{class})
2667A C expression that places additional restrictions on the register class
2668to use when it is necessary to be able to hold a value of mode
2669@var{mode} in a reload register for which class @var{class} would
2670ordinarily be used.
2671
2672Unlike @code{PREFERRED_RELOAD_CLASS}, this macro should be used when
2673there are certain modes that simply can't go in certain reload classes.
2674
2675The value is a register class; perhaps @var{class}, or perhaps another,
2676smaller class.
2677
2678Don't define this macro unless the target machine has limitations which
2679require the macro to do something nontrivial.
2680@end defmac
2681
2682@hook TARGET_SECONDARY_RELOAD
2683Many machines have some registers that cannot be copied directly to or
2684from memory or even from other types of registers. An example is the
2685@samp{MQ} register, which on most machines, can only be copied to or
2686from general registers, but not memory. Below, we shall be using the
2687term 'intermediate register' when a move operation cannot be performed
2688directly, but has to be done by copying the source into the intermediate
2689register first, and then copying the intermediate register to the
2690destination. An intermediate register always has the same mode as
2691source and destination. Since it holds the actual value being copied,
2692reload might apply optimizations to re-use an intermediate register
2693and eliding the copy from the source when it can determine that the
2694intermediate register still holds the required value.
2695
2696Another kind of secondary reload is required on some machines which
2697allow copying all registers to and from memory, but require a scratch
2698register for stores to some memory locations (e.g., those with symbolic
2699address on the RT, and those with certain symbolic address on the SPARC
2700when compiling PIC)@. Scratch registers need not have the same mode
2701as the value being copied, and usually hold a different value than
2702that being copied. Special patterns in the md file are needed to
2703describe how the copy is performed with the help of the scratch register;
2704these patterns also describe the number, register class(es) and mode(s)
2705of the scratch register(s).
2706
2707In some cases, both an intermediate and a scratch register are required.
2708
2709For input reloads, this target hook is called with nonzero @var{in_p},
2710and @var{x} is an rtx that needs to be copied to a register of class
2711@var{reload_class} in @var{reload_mode}. For output reloads, this target
2712hook is called with zero @var{in_p}, and a register of class @var{reload_class}
2713needs to be copied to rtx @var{x} in @var{reload_mode}.
2714
2715If copying a register of @var{reload_class} from/to @var{x} requires
2716an intermediate register, the hook @code{secondary_reload} should
2717return the register class required for this intermediate register.
2718If no intermediate register is required, it should return NO_REGS.
2719If more than one intermediate register is required, describe the one
2720that is closest in the copy chain to the reload register.
2721
2722If scratch registers are needed, you also have to describe how to
2723perform the copy from/to the reload register to/from this
2724closest intermediate register. Or if no intermediate register is
2725required, but still a scratch register is needed, describe the
2726copy from/to the reload register to/from the reload operand @var{x}.
2727
2728You do this by setting @code{sri->icode} to the instruction code of a pattern
2729in the md file which performs the move. Operands 0 and 1 are the output
2730and input of this copy, respectively. Operands from operand 2 onward are
2731for scratch operands. These scratch operands must have a mode, and a
2732single-register-class
2733@c [later: or memory]
2734output constraint.
2735
2736When an intermediate register is used, the @code{secondary_reload}
2737hook will be called again to determine how to copy the intermediate
2738register to/from the reload operand @var{x}, so your hook must also
2739have code to handle the register class of the intermediate operand.
2740
2741@c [For later: maybe we'll allow multi-alternative reload patterns -
2742@c the port maintainer could name a mov<mode> pattern that has clobbers -
2743@c and match the constraints of input and output to determine the required
2744@c alternative. A restriction would be that constraints used to match
2745@c against reloads registers would have to be written as register class
2746@c constraints, or we need a new target macro / hook that tells us if an
2747@c arbitrary constraint can match an unknown register of a given class.
2748@c Such a macro / hook would also be useful in other places.]
2749
2750
2751@var{x} might be a pseudo-register or a @code{subreg} of a
2752pseudo-register, which could either be in a hard register or in memory.
2753Use @code{true_regnum} to find out; it will return @minus{}1 if the pseudo is
2754in memory and the hard register number if it is in a register.
2755
2756Scratch operands in memory (constraint @code{"=m"} / @code{"=&m"}) are
2757currently not supported. For the time being, you will have to continue
2758to use @code{SECONDARY_MEMORY_NEEDED} for that purpose.
2759
2760@code{copy_cost} also uses this target hook to find out how values are
2761copied. If you want it to include some extra cost for the need to allocate
2762(a) scratch register(s), set @code{sri->extra_cost} to the additional cost.
2763Or if two dependent moves are supposed to have a lower cost than the sum
2764of the individual moves due to expected fortuitous scheduling and/or special
2765forwarding logic, you can set @code{sri->extra_cost} to a negative amount.
2766@end deftypefn
2767
2768@defmac SECONDARY_RELOAD_CLASS (@var{class}, @var{mode}, @var{x})
2769@defmacx SECONDARY_INPUT_RELOAD_CLASS (@var{class}, @var{mode}, @var{x})
2770@defmacx SECONDARY_OUTPUT_RELOAD_CLASS (@var{class}, @var{mode}, @var{x})
2771These macros are obsolete, new ports should use the target hook
2772@code{TARGET_SECONDARY_RELOAD} instead.
2773
2774These are obsolete macros, replaced by the @code{TARGET_SECONDARY_RELOAD}
2775target hook. Older ports still define these macros to indicate to the
2776reload phase that it may
2777need to allocate at least one register for a reload in addition to the
2778register to contain the data. Specifically, if copying @var{x} to a
2779register @var{class} in @var{mode} requires an intermediate register,
2780you were supposed to define @code{SECONDARY_INPUT_RELOAD_CLASS} to return the
2781largest register class all of whose registers can be used as
2782intermediate registers or scratch registers.
2783
2784If copying a register @var{class} in @var{mode} to @var{x} requires an
2785intermediate or scratch register, @code{SECONDARY_OUTPUT_RELOAD_CLASS}
2786was supposed to be defined be defined to return the largest register
2787class required. If the
2788requirements for input and output reloads were the same, the macro
2789@code{SECONDARY_RELOAD_CLASS} should have been used instead of defining both
2790macros identically.
2791
2792The values returned by these macros are often @code{GENERAL_REGS}.
2793Return @code{NO_REGS} if no spare register is needed; i.e., if @var{x}
2794can be directly copied to or from a register of @var{class} in
2795@var{mode} without requiring a scratch register. Do not define this
2796macro if it would always return @code{NO_REGS}.
2797
2798If a scratch register is required (either with or without an
2799intermediate register), you were supposed to define patterns for
2800@samp{reload_in@var{m}} or @samp{reload_out@var{m}}, as required
2801(@pxref{Standard Names}. These patterns, which were normally
2802implemented with a @code{define_expand}, should be similar to the
2803@samp{mov@var{m}} patterns, except that operand 2 is the scratch
2804register.
2805
2806These patterns need constraints for the reload register and scratch
2807register that
2808contain a single register class. If the original reload register (whose
2809class is @var{class}) can meet the constraint given in the pattern, the
2810value returned by these macros is used for the class of the scratch
2811register. Otherwise, two additional reload registers are required.
2812Their classes are obtained from the constraints in the insn pattern.
2813
2814@var{x} might be a pseudo-register or a @code{subreg} of a
2815pseudo-register, which could either be in a hard register or in memory.
2816Use @code{true_regnum} to find out; it will return @minus{}1 if the pseudo is
2817in memory and the hard register number if it is in a register.
2818
2819These macros should not be used in the case where a particular class of
2820registers can only be copied to memory and not to another class of
2821registers. In that case, secondary reload registers are not needed and
2822would not be helpful. Instead, a stack location must be used to perform
2823the copy and the @code{mov@var{m}} pattern should use memory as an
2824intermediate storage. This case often occurs between floating-point and
2825general registers.
2826@end defmac
2827
2828@defmac SECONDARY_MEMORY_NEEDED (@var{class1}, @var{class2}, @var{m})
2829Certain machines have the property that some registers cannot be copied
2830to some other registers without using memory. Define this macro on
2831those machines to be a C expression that is nonzero if objects of mode
2832@var{m} in registers of @var{class1} can only be copied to registers of
2833class @var{class2} by storing a register of @var{class1} into memory
2834and loading that memory location into a register of @var{class2}.
2835
2836Do not define this macro if its value would always be zero.
2837@end defmac
2838
2839@defmac SECONDARY_MEMORY_NEEDED_RTX (@var{mode})
2840Normally when @code{SECONDARY_MEMORY_NEEDED} is defined, the compiler
2841allocates a stack slot for a memory location needed for register copies.
2842If this macro is defined, the compiler instead uses the memory location
2843defined by this macro.
2844
2845Do not define this macro if you do not define
2846@code{SECONDARY_MEMORY_NEEDED}.
2847@end defmac
2848
2849@defmac SECONDARY_MEMORY_NEEDED_MODE (@var{mode})
2850When the compiler needs a secondary memory location to copy between two
2851registers of mode @var{mode}, it normally allocates sufficient memory to
2852hold a quantity of @code{BITS_PER_WORD} bits and performs the store and
2853load operations in a mode that many bits wide and whose class is the
2854same as that of @var{mode}.
2855
2856This is right thing to do on most machines because it ensures that all
2857bits of the register are copied and prevents accesses to the registers
2858in a narrower mode, which some machines prohibit for floating-point
2859registers.
2860
2861However, this default behavior is not correct on some machines, such as
2862the DEC Alpha, that store short integers in floating-point registers
2863differently than in integer registers. On those machines, the default
2864widening will not work correctly and you must define this macro to
2865suppress that widening in some cases. See the file @file{alpha.h} for
2866details.
2867
2868Do not define this macro if you do not define
2869@code{SECONDARY_MEMORY_NEEDED} or if widening @var{mode} to a mode that
2870is @code{BITS_PER_WORD} bits wide is correct for your machine.
2871@end defmac
2872
07b8f0a8
AS
2873@hook TARGET_CLASS_LIKELY_SPILLED_P
2874A target hook which returns @code{true} if pseudos that have been assigned
2875to registers of class @var{rclass} would likely be spilled because
2876registers of @var{rclass} are needed for spill registers.
2877
2878The default version of this target hook returns @code{true} if @var{rclass}
2879has exactly one register and @code{false} otherwise. On most machines, this
2880default should be used. Only use this target hook to some other expression
2881if pseudos allocated by @file{local-alloc.c} end up in memory because their
2882hard registers were needed for spill registers. If this target hook returns
2883@code{false} for those classes, those pseudos will only be allocated by
2884@file{global.c}, which knows how to reallocate the pseudo to another
2885register. If there would not be another register available for reallocation,
2886you should not change the implementation of this target hook since
2887the only effect of such implementation would be to slow down register
2888allocation.
2889@end deftypefn
2890
38f8b050
JR
2891@defmac CLASS_MAX_NREGS (@var{class}, @var{mode})
2892A C expression for the maximum number of consecutive registers
2893of class @var{class} needed to hold a value of mode @var{mode}.
2894
2895This is closely related to the macro @code{HARD_REGNO_NREGS}. In fact,
2896the value of the macro @code{CLASS_MAX_NREGS (@var{class}, @var{mode})}
2897should be the maximum value of @code{HARD_REGNO_NREGS (@var{regno},
2898@var{mode})} for all @var{regno} values in the class @var{class}.
2899
2900This macro helps control the handling of multiple-word values
2901in the reload pass.
2902@end defmac
2903
2904@defmac CANNOT_CHANGE_MODE_CLASS (@var{from}, @var{to}, @var{class})
2905If defined, a C expression that returns nonzero for a @var{class} for which
2906a change from mode @var{from} to mode @var{to} is invalid.
2907
2908For the example, loading 32-bit integer or floating-point objects into
2909floating-point registers on the Alpha extends them to 64 bits.
2910Therefore loading a 64-bit object and then storing it as a 32-bit object
2911does not store the low-order 32 bits, as would be the case for a normal
2912register. Therefore, @file{alpha.h} defines @code{CANNOT_CHANGE_MODE_CLASS}
2913as below:
2914
2915@smallexample
2916#define CANNOT_CHANGE_MODE_CLASS(FROM, TO, CLASS) \
2917 (GET_MODE_SIZE (FROM) != GET_MODE_SIZE (TO) \
2918 ? reg_classes_intersect_p (FLOAT_REGS, (CLASS)) : 0)
2919@end smallexample
2920@end defmac
2921
2922@hook TARGET_IRA_COVER_CLASSES
2923Return an array of cover classes for the Integrated Register Allocator
2924(@acronym{IRA}). Cover classes are a set of non-intersecting register
2925classes covering all hard registers used for register allocation
2926purposes. If a move between two registers in the same cover class is
2927possible, it should be cheaper than a load or store of the registers.
2928The array is terminated by a @code{LIM_REG_CLASSES} element.
2929
2930The order of cover classes in the array is important. If two classes
2931have the same cost of usage for a pseudo, the class occurred first in
2932the array is chosen for the pseudo.
2933
2934This hook is called once at compiler startup, after the command-line
2935options have been processed. It is then re-examined by every call to
2936@code{target_reinit}.
2937
2938The default implementation returns @code{IRA_COVER_CLASSES}, if defined,
2939otherwise there is no default implementation. You must define either this
2940macro or @code{IRA_COVER_CLASSES} in order to use the integrated register
2941allocator with Chaitin-Briggs coloring. If the macro is not defined,
2942the only available coloring algorithm is Chow's priority coloring.
2943@end deftypefn
2944
2945@defmac IRA_COVER_CLASSES
2946See the documentation for @code{TARGET_IRA_COVER_CLASSES}.
2947@end defmac
2948
2949@node Old Constraints
2950@section Obsolete Macros for Defining Constraints
2951@cindex defining constraints, obsolete method
2952@cindex constraints, defining, obsolete method
2953
2954Machine-specific constraints can be defined with these macros instead
2955of the machine description constructs described in @ref{Define
2956Constraints}. This mechanism is obsolete. New ports should not use
2957it; old ports should convert to the new mechanism.
2958
2959@defmac CONSTRAINT_LEN (@var{char}, @var{str})
2960For the constraint at the start of @var{str}, which starts with the letter
2961@var{c}, return the length. This allows you to have register class /
2962constant / extra constraints that are longer than a single letter;
2963you don't need to define this macro if you can do with single-letter
2964constraints only. The definition of this macro should use
2965DEFAULT_CONSTRAINT_LEN for all the characters that you don't want
2966to handle specially.
2967There are some sanity checks in genoutput.c that check the constraint lengths
2968for the md file, so you can also use this macro to help you while you are
2969transitioning from a byzantine single-letter-constraint scheme: when you
2970return a negative length for a constraint you want to re-use, genoutput
2971will complain about every instance where it is used in the md file.
2972@end defmac
2973
2974@defmac REG_CLASS_FROM_LETTER (@var{char})
2975A C expression which defines the machine-dependent operand constraint
2976letters for register classes. If @var{char} is such a letter, the
2977value should be the register class corresponding to it. Otherwise,
2978the value should be @code{NO_REGS}. The register letter @samp{r},
2979corresponding to class @code{GENERAL_REGS}, will not be passed
2980to this macro; you do not need to handle it.
2981@end defmac
2982
2983@defmac REG_CLASS_FROM_CONSTRAINT (@var{char}, @var{str})
2984Like @code{REG_CLASS_FROM_LETTER}, but you also get the constraint string
2985passed in @var{str}, so that you can use suffixes to distinguish between
2986different variants.
2987@end defmac
2988
2989@defmac CONST_OK_FOR_LETTER_P (@var{value}, @var{c})
2990A C expression that defines the machine-dependent operand constraint
2991letters (@samp{I}, @samp{J}, @samp{K}, @dots{} @samp{P}) that specify
2992particular ranges of integer values. If @var{c} is one of those
2993letters, the expression should check that @var{value}, an integer, is in
2994the appropriate range and return 1 if so, 0 otherwise. If @var{c} is
2995not one of those letters, the value should be 0 regardless of
2996@var{value}.
2997@end defmac
2998
2999@defmac CONST_OK_FOR_CONSTRAINT_P (@var{value}, @var{c}, @var{str})
3000Like @code{CONST_OK_FOR_LETTER_P}, but you also get the constraint
3001string passed in @var{str}, so that you can use suffixes to distinguish
3002between different variants.
3003@end defmac
3004
3005@defmac CONST_DOUBLE_OK_FOR_LETTER_P (@var{value}, @var{c})
3006A C expression that defines the machine-dependent operand constraint
3007letters that specify particular ranges of @code{const_double} values
3008(@samp{G} or @samp{H}).
3009
3010If @var{c} is one of those letters, the expression should check that
3011@var{value}, an RTX of code @code{const_double}, is in the appropriate
3012range and return 1 if so, 0 otherwise. If @var{c} is not one of those
3013letters, the value should be 0 regardless of @var{value}.
3014
3015@code{const_double} is used for all floating-point constants and for
3016@code{DImode} fixed-point constants. A given letter can accept either
3017or both kinds of values. It can use @code{GET_MODE} to distinguish
3018between these kinds.
3019@end defmac
3020
3021@defmac CONST_DOUBLE_OK_FOR_CONSTRAINT_P (@var{value}, @var{c}, @var{str})
3022Like @code{CONST_DOUBLE_OK_FOR_LETTER_P}, but you also get the constraint
3023string passed in @var{str}, so that you can use suffixes to distinguish
3024between different variants.
3025@end defmac
3026
3027@defmac EXTRA_CONSTRAINT (@var{value}, @var{c})
3028A C expression that defines the optional machine-dependent constraint
3029letters that can be used to segregate specific types of operands, usually
3030memory references, for the target machine. Any letter that is not
3031elsewhere defined and not matched by @code{REG_CLASS_FROM_LETTER} /
3032@code{REG_CLASS_FROM_CONSTRAINT}
3033may be used. Normally this macro will not be defined.
3034
3035If it is required for a particular target machine, it should return 1
3036if @var{value} corresponds to the operand type represented by the
3037constraint letter @var{c}. If @var{c} is not defined as an extra
3038constraint, the value returned should be 0 regardless of @var{value}.
3039
3040For example, on the ROMP, load instructions cannot have their output
3041in r0 if the memory reference contains a symbolic address. Constraint
3042letter @samp{Q} is defined as representing a memory address that does
3043@emph{not} contain a symbolic address. An alternative is specified with
3044a @samp{Q} constraint on the input and @samp{r} on the output. The next
3045alternative specifies @samp{m} on the input and a register class that
3046does not include r0 on the output.
3047@end defmac
3048
3049@defmac EXTRA_CONSTRAINT_STR (@var{value}, @var{c}, @var{str})
3050Like @code{EXTRA_CONSTRAINT}, but you also get the constraint string passed
3051in @var{str}, so that you can use suffixes to distinguish between different
3052variants.
3053@end defmac
3054
3055@defmac EXTRA_MEMORY_CONSTRAINT (@var{c}, @var{str})
3056A C expression that defines the optional machine-dependent constraint
3057letters, amongst those accepted by @code{EXTRA_CONSTRAINT}, that should
3058be treated like memory constraints by the reload pass.
3059
3060It should return 1 if the operand type represented by the constraint
3061at the start of @var{str}, the first letter of which is the letter @var{c},
3062comprises a subset of all memory references including
3063all those whose address is simply a base register. This allows the reload
3064pass to reload an operand, if it does not directly correspond to the operand
3065type of @var{c}, by copying its address into a base register.
3066
3067For example, on the S/390, some instructions do not accept arbitrary
3068memory references, but only those that do not make use of an index
3069register. The constraint letter @samp{Q} is defined via
3070@code{EXTRA_CONSTRAINT} as representing a memory address of this type.
3071If the letter @samp{Q} is marked as @code{EXTRA_MEMORY_CONSTRAINT},
3072a @samp{Q} constraint can handle any memory operand, because the
3073reload pass knows it can be reloaded by copying the memory address
3074into a base register if required. This is analogous to the way
3075an @samp{o} constraint can handle any memory operand.
3076@end defmac
3077
3078@defmac EXTRA_ADDRESS_CONSTRAINT (@var{c}, @var{str})
3079A C expression that defines the optional machine-dependent constraint
3080letters, amongst those accepted by @code{EXTRA_CONSTRAINT} /
3081@code{EXTRA_CONSTRAINT_STR}, that should
3082be treated like address constraints by the reload pass.
3083
3084It should return 1 if the operand type represented by the constraint
3085at the start of @var{str}, which starts with the letter @var{c}, comprises
3086a subset of all memory addresses including
3087all those that consist of just a base register. This allows the reload
3088pass to reload an operand, if it does not directly correspond to the operand
3089type of @var{str}, by copying it into a base register.
3090
3091Any constraint marked as @code{EXTRA_ADDRESS_CONSTRAINT} can only
3092be used with the @code{address_operand} predicate. It is treated
3093analogously to the @samp{p} constraint.
3094@end defmac
3095
3096@node Stack and Calling
3097@section Stack Layout and Calling Conventions
3098@cindex calling conventions
3099
3100@c prevent bad page break with this line
3101This describes the stack layout and calling conventions.
3102
3103@menu
3104* Frame Layout::
3105* Exception Handling::
3106* Stack Checking::
3107* Frame Registers::
3108* Elimination::
3109* Stack Arguments::
3110* Register Arguments::
3111* Scalar Return::
3112* Aggregate Return::
3113* Caller Saves::
3114* Function Entry::
3115* Profiling::
3116* Tail Calls::
3117* Stack Smashing Protection::
3118@end menu
3119
3120@node Frame Layout
3121@subsection Basic Stack Layout
3122@cindex stack frame layout
3123@cindex frame layout
3124
3125@c prevent bad page break with this line
3126Here is the basic stack layout.
3127
3128@defmac STACK_GROWS_DOWNWARD
3129Define this macro if pushing a word onto the stack moves the stack
3130pointer to a smaller address.
3131
3132When we say, ``define this macro if @dots{}'', it means that the
3133compiler checks this macro only with @code{#ifdef} so the precise
3134definition used does not matter.
3135@end defmac
3136
3137@defmac STACK_PUSH_CODE
3138This macro defines the operation used when something is pushed
3139on the stack. In RTL, a push operation will be
3140@code{(set (mem (STACK_PUSH_CODE (reg sp))) @dots{})}
3141
3142The choices are @code{PRE_DEC}, @code{POST_DEC}, @code{PRE_INC},
3143and @code{POST_INC}. Which of these is correct depends on
3144the stack direction and on whether the stack pointer points
3145to the last item on the stack or whether it points to the
3146space for the next item on the stack.
3147
3148The default is @code{PRE_DEC} when @code{STACK_GROWS_DOWNWARD} is
3149defined, which is almost always right, and @code{PRE_INC} otherwise,
3150which is often wrong.
3151@end defmac
3152
3153@defmac FRAME_GROWS_DOWNWARD
3154Define this macro to nonzero value if the addresses of local variable slots
3155are at negative offsets from the frame pointer.
3156@end defmac
3157
3158@defmac ARGS_GROW_DOWNWARD
3159Define this macro if successive arguments to a function occupy decreasing
3160addresses on the stack.
3161@end defmac
3162
3163@defmac STARTING_FRAME_OFFSET
3164Offset from the frame pointer to the first local variable slot to be allocated.
3165
3166If @code{FRAME_GROWS_DOWNWARD}, find the next slot's offset by
3167subtracting the first slot's length from @code{STARTING_FRAME_OFFSET}.
3168Otherwise, it is found by adding the length of the first slot to the
3169value @code{STARTING_FRAME_OFFSET}.
3170@c i'm not sure if the above is still correct.. had to change it to get
3171@c rid of an overfull. --mew 2feb93
3172@end defmac
3173
3174@defmac STACK_ALIGNMENT_NEEDED
3175Define to zero to disable final alignment of the stack during reload.
3176The nonzero default for this macro is suitable for most ports.
3177
3178On ports where @code{STARTING_FRAME_OFFSET} is nonzero or where there
3179is a register save block following the local block that doesn't require
3180alignment to @code{STACK_BOUNDARY}, it may be beneficial to disable
3181stack alignment and do it in the backend.
3182@end defmac
3183
3184@defmac STACK_POINTER_OFFSET
3185Offset from the stack pointer register to the first location at which
3186outgoing arguments are placed. If not specified, the default value of
3187zero is used. This is the proper value for most machines.
3188
3189If @code{ARGS_GROW_DOWNWARD}, this is the offset to the location above
3190the first location at which outgoing arguments are placed.
3191@end defmac
3192
3193@defmac FIRST_PARM_OFFSET (@var{fundecl})
3194Offset from the argument pointer register to the first argument's
3195address. On some machines it may depend on the data type of the
3196function.
3197
3198If @code{ARGS_GROW_DOWNWARD}, this is the offset to the location above
3199the first argument's address.
3200@end defmac
3201
3202@defmac STACK_DYNAMIC_OFFSET (@var{fundecl})
3203Offset from the stack pointer register to an item dynamically allocated
3204on the stack, e.g., by @code{alloca}.
3205
3206The default value for this macro is @code{STACK_POINTER_OFFSET} plus the
3207length of the outgoing arguments. The default is correct for most
3208machines. See @file{function.c} for details.
3209@end defmac
3210
3211@defmac INITIAL_FRAME_ADDRESS_RTX
3212A C expression whose value is RTL representing the address of the initial
3213stack frame. This address is passed to @code{RETURN_ADDR_RTX} and
3214@code{DYNAMIC_CHAIN_ADDRESS}. If you don't define this macro, a reasonable
3215default value will be used. Define this macro in order to make frame pointer
3216elimination work in the presence of @code{__builtin_frame_address (count)} and
3217@code{__builtin_return_address (count)} for @code{count} not equal to zero.
3218@end defmac
3219
3220@defmac DYNAMIC_CHAIN_ADDRESS (@var{frameaddr})
3221A C expression whose value is RTL representing the address in a stack
3222frame where the pointer to the caller's frame is stored. Assume that
3223@var{frameaddr} is an RTL expression for the address of the stack frame
3224itself.
3225
3226If you don't define this macro, the default is to return the value
3227of @var{frameaddr}---that is, the stack frame address is also the
3228address of the stack word that points to the previous frame.
3229@end defmac
3230
3231@defmac SETUP_FRAME_ADDRESSES
3232If defined, a C expression that produces the machine-specific code to
3233setup the stack so that arbitrary frames can be accessed. For example,
3234on the SPARC, we must flush all of the register windows to the stack
3235before we can access arbitrary stack frames. You will seldom need to
3236define this macro.
3237@end defmac
3238
3239@hook TARGET_BUILTIN_SETJMP_FRAME_VALUE
3240This target hook should return an rtx that is used to store
3241the address of the current frame into the built in @code{setjmp} buffer.
3242The default value, @code{virtual_stack_vars_rtx}, is correct for most
3243machines. One reason you may need to define this target hook is if
3244@code{hard_frame_pointer_rtx} is the appropriate value on your machine.
3245@end deftypefn
3246
3247@defmac FRAME_ADDR_RTX (@var{frameaddr})
3248A C expression whose value is RTL representing the value of the frame
3249address for the current frame. @var{frameaddr} is the frame pointer
3250of the current frame. This is used for __builtin_frame_address.
3251You need only define this macro if the frame address is not the same
3252as the frame pointer. Most machines do not need to define it.
3253@end defmac
3254
3255@defmac RETURN_ADDR_RTX (@var{count}, @var{frameaddr})
3256A C expression whose value is RTL representing the value of the return
3257address for the frame @var{count} steps up from the current frame, after
3258the prologue. @var{frameaddr} is the frame pointer of the @var{count}
3259frame, or the frame pointer of the @var{count} @minus{} 1 frame if
3260@code{RETURN_ADDR_IN_PREVIOUS_FRAME} is defined.
3261
3262The value of the expression must always be the correct address when
3263@var{count} is zero, but may be @code{NULL_RTX} if there is no way to
3264determine the return address of other frames.
3265@end defmac
3266
3267@defmac RETURN_ADDR_IN_PREVIOUS_FRAME
3268Define this if the return address of a particular stack frame is accessed
3269from the frame pointer of the previous stack frame.
3270@end defmac
3271
3272@defmac INCOMING_RETURN_ADDR_RTX
3273A C expression whose value is RTL representing the location of the
3274incoming return address at the beginning of any function, before the
3275prologue. This RTL is either a @code{REG}, indicating that the return
3276value is saved in @samp{REG}, or a @code{MEM} representing a location in
3277the stack.
3278
3279You only need to define this macro if you want to support call frame
3280debugging information like that provided by DWARF 2.
3281
3282If this RTL is a @code{REG}, you should also define
3283@code{DWARF_FRAME_RETURN_COLUMN} to @code{DWARF_FRAME_REGNUM (REGNO)}.
3284@end defmac
3285
3286@defmac DWARF_ALT_FRAME_RETURN_COLUMN
3287A C expression whose value is an integer giving a DWARF 2 column
3288number that may be used as an alternative return column. The column
3289must not correspond to any gcc hard register (that is, it must not
3290be in the range of @code{DWARF_FRAME_REGNUM}).
3291
3292This macro can be useful if @code{DWARF_FRAME_RETURN_COLUMN} is set to a
3293general register, but an alternative column needs to be used for signal
3294frames. Some targets have also used different frame return columns
3295over time.
3296@end defmac
3297
3298@defmac DWARF_ZERO_REG
3299A C expression whose value is an integer giving a DWARF 2 register
3300number that is considered to always have the value zero. This should
3301only be defined if the target has an architected zero register, and
3302someone decided it was a good idea to use that register number to
3303terminate the stack backtrace. New ports should avoid this.
3304@end defmac
3305
3306@hook TARGET_DWARF_HANDLE_FRAME_UNSPEC
3307This target hook allows the backend to emit frame-related insns that
3308contain UNSPECs or UNSPEC_VOLATILEs. The DWARF 2 call frame debugging
3309info engine will invoke it on insns of the form
3310@smallexample
3311(set (reg) (unspec [@dots{}] UNSPEC_INDEX))
3312@end smallexample
3313and
3314@smallexample
3315(set (reg) (unspec_volatile [@dots{}] UNSPECV_INDEX)).
3316@end smallexample
3317to let the backend emit the call frame instructions. @var{label} is
3318the CFI label attached to the insn, @var{pattern} is the pattern of
3319the insn and @var{index} is @code{UNSPEC_INDEX} or @code{UNSPECV_INDEX}.
3320@end deftypefn
3321
3322@defmac INCOMING_FRAME_SP_OFFSET
3323A C expression whose value is an integer giving the offset, in bytes,
3324from the value of the stack pointer register to the top of the stack
3325frame at the beginning of any function, before the prologue. The top of
3326the frame is defined to be the value of the stack pointer in the
3327previous frame, just before the call instruction.
3328
3329You only need to define this macro if you want to support call frame
3330debugging information like that provided by DWARF 2.
3331@end defmac
3332
3333@defmac ARG_POINTER_CFA_OFFSET (@var{fundecl})
3334A C expression whose value is an integer giving the offset, in bytes,
3335from the argument pointer to the canonical frame address (cfa). The
3336final value should coincide with that calculated by
3337@code{INCOMING_FRAME_SP_OFFSET}. Which is unfortunately not usable
3338during virtual register instantiation.
3339
3340The default value for this macro is
3341@code{FIRST_PARM_OFFSET (fundecl) + crtl->args.pretend_args_size},
3342which is correct for most machines; in general, the arguments are found
3343immediately before the stack frame. Note that this is not the case on
3344some targets that save registers into the caller's frame, such as SPARC
3345and rs6000, and so such targets need to define this macro.
3346
3347You only need to define this macro if the default is incorrect, and you
3348want to support call frame debugging information like that provided by
3349DWARF 2.
3350@end defmac
3351
3352@defmac FRAME_POINTER_CFA_OFFSET (@var{fundecl})
3353If defined, a C expression whose value is an integer giving the offset
3354in bytes from the frame pointer to the canonical frame address (cfa).
3355The final value should coincide with that calculated by
3356@code{INCOMING_FRAME_SP_OFFSET}.
3357
3358Normally the CFA is calculated as an offset from the argument pointer,
3359via @code{ARG_POINTER_CFA_OFFSET}, but if the argument pointer is
3360variable due to the ABI, this may not be possible. If this macro is
3361defined, it implies that the virtual register instantiation should be
3362based on the frame pointer instead of the argument pointer. Only one
3363of @code{FRAME_POINTER_CFA_OFFSET} and @code{ARG_POINTER_CFA_OFFSET}
3364should be defined.
3365@end defmac
3366
3367@defmac CFA_FRAME_BASE_OFFSET (@var{fundecl})
3368If defined, a C expression whose value is an integer giving the offset
3369in bytes from the canonical frame address (cfa) to the frame base used
3370in DWARF 2 debug information. The default is zero. A different value
3371may reduce the size of debug information on some ports.
3372@end defmac
3373
3374@node Exception Handling
3375@subsection Exception Handling Support
3376@cindex exception handling
3377
3378@defmac EH_RETURN_DATA_REGNO (@var{N})
3379A C expression whose value is the @var{N}th register number used for
3380data by exception handlers, or @code{INVALID_REGNUM} if fewer than
3381@var{N} registers are usable.
3382
3383The exception handling library routines communicate with the exception
3384handlers via a set of agreed upon registers. Ideally these registers
3385should be call-clobbered; it is possible to use call-saved registers,
3386but may negatively impact code size. The target must support at least
33872 data registers, but should define 4 if there are enough free registers.
3388
3389You must define this macro if you want to support call frame exception
3390handling like that provided by DWARF 2.
3391@end defmac
3392
3393@defmac EH_RETURN_STACKADJ_RTX
3394A C expression whose value is RTL representing a location in which
3395to store a stack adjustment to be applied before function return.
3396This is used to unwind the stack to an exception handler's call frame.
3397It will be assigned zero on code paths that return normally.
3398
3399Typically this is a call-clobbered hard register that is otherwise
3400untouched by the epilogue, but could also be a stack slot.
3401
3402Do not define this macro if the stack pointer is saved and restored
3403by the regular prolog and epilog code in the call frame itself; in
3404this case, the exception handling library routines will update the
3405stack location to be restored in place. Otherwise, you must define
3406this macro if you want to support call frame exception handling like
3407that provided by DWARF 2.
3408@end defmac
3409
3410@defmac EH_RETURN_HANDLER_RTX
3411A C expression whose value is RTL representing a location in which
3412to store the address of an exception handler to which we should
3413return. It will not be assigned on code paths that return normally.
3414
3415Typically this is the location in the call frame at which the normal
3416return address is stored. For targets that return by popping an
3417address off the stack, this might be a memory address just below
3418the @emph{target} call frame rather than inside the current call
3419frame. If defined, @code{EH_RETURN_STACKADJ_RTX} will have already
3420been assigned, so it may be used to calculate the location of the
3421target call frame.
3422
3423Some targets have more complex requirements than storing to an
3424address calculable during initial code generation. In that case
3425the @code{eh_return} instruction pattern should be used instead.
3426
3427If you want to support call frame exception handling, you must
3428define either this macro or the @code{eh_return} instruction pattern.
3429@end defmac
3430
3431@defmac RETURN_ADDR_OFFSET
3432If defined, an integer-valued C expression for which rtl will be generated
3433to add it to the exception handler address before it is searched in the
3434exception handling tables, and to subtract it again from the address before
3435using it to return to the exception handler.
3436@end defmac
3437
3438@defmac ASM_PREFERRED_EH_DATA_FORMAT (@var{code}, @var{global})
3439This macro chooses the encoding of pointers embedded in the exception
3440handling sections. If at all possible, this should be defined such
3441that the exception handling section will not require dynamic relocations,
3442and so may be read-only.
3443
3444@var{code} is 0 for data, 1 for code labels, 2 for function pointers.
3445@var{global} is true if the symbol may be affected by dynamic relocations.
3446The macro should return a combination of the @code{DW_EH_PE_*} defines
3447as found in @file{dwarf2.h}.
3448
3449If this macro is not defined, pointers will not be encoded but
3450represented directly.
3451@end defmac
3452
3453@defmac ASM_MAYBE_OUTPUT_ENCODED_ADDR_RTX (@var{file}, @var{encoding}, @var{size}, @var{addr}, @var{done})
3454This macro allows the target to emit whatever special magic is required
3455to represent the encoding chosen by @code{ASM_PREFERRED_EH_DATA_FORMAT}.
3456Generic code takes care of pc-relative and indirect encodings; this must
3457be defined if the target uses text-relative or data-relative encodings.
3458
3459This is a C statement that branches to @var{done} if the format was
3460handled. @var{encoding} is the format chosen, @var{size} is the number
3461of bytes that the format occupies, @var{addr} is the @code{SYMBOL_REF}
3462to be emitted.
3463@end defmac
3464
3465@defmac MD_UNWIND_SUPPORT
3466A string specifying a file to be #include'd in unwind-dw2.c. The file
3467so included typically defines @code{MD_FALLBACK_FRAME_STATE_FOR}.
3468@end defmac
3469
3470@defmac MD_FALLBACK_FRAME_STATE_FOR (@var{context}, @var{fs})
3471This macro allows the target to add CPU and operating system specific
3472code to the call-frame unwinder for use when there is no unwind data
3473available. The most common reason to implement this macro is to unwind
3474through signal frames.
3475
3476This macro is called from @code{uw_frame_state_for} in
3477@file{unwind-dw2.c}, @file{unwind-dw2-xtensa.c} and
3478@file{unwind-ia64.c}. @var{context} is an @code{_Unwind_Context};
3479@var{fs} is an @code{_Unwind_FrameState}. Examine @code{context->ra}
3480for the address of the code being executed and @code{context->cfa} for
3481the stack pointer value. If the frame can be decoded, the register
3482save addresses should be updated in @var{fs} and the macro should
3483evaluate to @code{_URC_NO_REASON}. If the frame cannot be decoded,
3484the macro should evaluate to @code{_URC_END_OF_STACK}.
3485
3486For proper signal handling in Java this macro is accompanied by
3487@code{MAKE_THROW_FRAME}, defined in @file{libjava/include/*-signal.h} headers.
3488@end defmac
3489
3490@defmac MD_HANDLE_UNWABI (@var{context}, @var{fs})
3491This macro allows the target to add operating system specific code to the
3492call-frame unwinder to handle the IA-64 @code{.unwabi} unwinding directive,
3493usually used for signal or interrupt frames.
3494
3495This macro is called from @code{uw_update_context} in @file{unwind-ia64.c}.
3496@var{context} is an @code{_Unwind_Context};
3497@var{fs} is an @code{_Unwind_FrameState}. Examine @code{fs->unwabi}
3498for the abi and context in the @code{.unwabi} directive. If the
3499@code{.unwabi} directive can be handled, the register save addresses should
3500be updated in @var{fs}.
3501@end defmac
3502
3503@defmac TARGET_USES_WEAK_UNWIND_INFO
3504A C expression that evaluates to true if the target requires unwind
3505info to be given comdat linkage. Define it to be @code{1} if comdat
3506linkage is necessary. The default is @code{0}.
3507@end defmac
3508
3509@node Stack Checking
3510@subsection Specifying How Stack Checking is Done
3511
3512GCC will check that stack references are within the boundaries of the
3513stack, if the option @option{-fstack-check} is specified, in one of
3514three ways:
3515
3516@enumerate
3517@item
3518If the value of the @code{STACK_CHECK_BUILTIN} macro is nonzero, GCC
3519will assume that you have arranged for full stack checking to be done
3520at appropriate places in the configuration files. GCC will not do
3521other special processing.
3522
3523@item
3524If @code{STACK_CHECK_BUILTIN} is zero and the value of the
3525@code{STACK_CHECK_STATIC_BUILTIN} macro is nonzero, GCC will assume
3526that you have arranged for static stack checking (checking of the
3527static stack frame of functions) to be done at appropriate places
3528in the configuration files. GCC will only emit code to do dynamic
3529stack checking (checking on dynamic stack allocations) using the third
3530approach below.
3531
3532@item
3533If neither of the above are true, GCC will generate code to periodically
3534``probe'' the stack pointer using the values of the macros defined below.
3535@end enumerate
3536
3537If neither STACK_CHECK_BUILTIN nor STACK_CHECK_STATIC_BUILTIN is defined,
3538GCC will change its allocation strategy for large objects if the option
3539@option{-fstack-check} is specified: they will always be allocated
3540dynamically if their size exceeds @code{STACK_CHECK_MAX_VAR_SIZE} bytes.
3541
3542@defmac STACK_CHECK_BUILTIN
3543A nonzero value if stack checking is done by the configuration files in a
3544machine-dependent manner. You should define this macro if stack checking
3545is required by the ABI of your machine or if you would like to do stack
3546checking in some more efficient way than the generic approach. The default
3547value of this macro is zero.
3548@end defmac
3549
3550@defmac STACK_CHECK_STATIC_BUILTIN
3551A nonzero value if static stack checking is done by the configuration files
3552in a machine-dependent manner. You should define this macro if you would
3553like to do static stack checking in some more efficient way than the generic
3554approach. The default value of this macro is zero.
3555@end defmac
3556
3557@defmac STACK_CHECK_PROBE_INTERVAL_EXP
3558An integer specifying the interval at which GCC must generate stack probe
3559instructions, defined as 2 raised to this integer. You will normally
3560define this macro so that the interval be no larger than the size of
3561the ``guard pages'' at the end of a stack area. The default value
3562of 12 (4096-byte interval) is suitable for most systems.
3563@end defmac
3564
3565@defmac STACK_CHECK_MOVING_SP
3566An integer which is nonzero if GCC should move the stack pointer page by page
3567when doing probes. This can be necessary on systems where the stack pointer
3568contains the bottom address of the memory area accessible to the executing
3569thread at any point in time. In this situation an alternate signal stack
3570is required in order to be able to recover from a stack overflow. The
3571default value of this macro is zero.
3572@end defmac
3573
3574@defmac STACK_CHECK_PROTECT
3575The number of bytes of stack needed to recover from a stack overflow, for
3576languages where such a recovery is supported. The default value of 75 words
3577with the @code{setjmp}/@code{longjmp}-based exception handling mechanism and
35788192 bytes with other exception handling mechanisms should be adequate for
3579most machines.
3580@end defmac
3581
3582The following macros are relevant only if neither STACK_CHECK_BUILTIN
3583nor STACK_CHECK_STATIC_BUILTIN is defined; you can omit them altogether
3584in the opposite case.
3585
3586@defmac STACK_CHECK_MAX_FRAME_SIZE
3587The maximum size of a stack frame, in bytes. GCC will generate probe
3588instructions in non-leaf functions to ensure at least this many bytes of
3589stack are available. If a stack frame is larger than this size, stack
3590checking will not be reliable and GCC will issue a warning. The
3591default is chosen so that GCC only generates one instruction on most
3592systems. You should normally not change the default value of this macro.
3593@end defmac
3594
3595@defmac STACK_CHECK_FIXED_FRAME_SIZE
3596GCC uses this value to generate the above warning message. It
3597represents the amount of fixed frame used by a function, not including
3598space for any callee-saved registers, temporaries and user variables.
3599You need only specify an upper bound for this amount and will normally
3600use the default of four words.
3601@end defmac
3602
3603@defmac STACK_CHECK_MAX_VAR_SIZE
3604The maximum size, in bytes, of an object that GCC will place in the
3605fixed area of the stack frame when the user specifies
3606@option{-fstack-check}.
3607GCC computed the default from the values of the above macros and you will
3608normally not need to override that default.
3609@end defmac
3610
3611@need 2000
3612@node Frame Registers
3613@subsection Registers That Address the Stack Frame
3614
3615@c prevent bad page break with this line
3616This discusses registers that address the stack frame.
3617
3618@defmac STACK_POINTER_REGNUM
3619The register number of the stack pointer register, which must also be a
3620fixed register according to @code{FIXED_REGISTERS}. On most machines,
3621the hardware determines which register this is.
3622@end defmac
3623
3624@defmac FRAME_POINTER_REGNUM
3625The register number of the frame pointer register, which is used to
3626access automatic variables in the stack frame. On some machines, the
3627hardware determines which register this is. On other machines, you can
3628choose any register you wish for this purpose.
3629@end defmac
3630
3631@defmac HARD_FRAME_POINTER_REGNUM
3632On some machines the offset between the frame pointer and starting
3633offset of the automatic variables is not known until after register
3634allocation has been done (for example, because the saved registers are
3635between these two locations). On those machines, define
3636@code{FRAME_POINTER_REGNUM} the number of a special, fixed register to
3637be used internally until the offset is known, and define
3638@code{HARD_FRAME_POINTER_REGNUM} to be the actual hard register number
3639used for the frame pointer.
3640
3641You should define this macro only in the very rare circumstances when it
3642is not possible to calculate the offset between the frame pointer and
3643the automatic variables until after register allocation has been
3644completed. When this macro is defined, you must also indicate in your
3645definition of @code{ELIMINABLE_REGS} how to eliminate
3646@code{FRAME_POINTER_REGNUM} into either @code{HARD_FRAME_POINTER_REGNUM}
3647or @code{STACK_POINTER_REGNUM}.
3648
3649Do not define this macro if it would be the same as
3650@code{FRAME_POINTER_REGNUM}.
3651@end defmac
3652
3653@defmac ARG_POINTER_REGNUM
3654The register number of the arg pointer register, which is used to access
3655the function's argument list. On some machines, this is the same as the
3656frame pointer register. On some machines, the hardware determines which
3657register this is. On other machines, you can choose any register you
3658wish for this purpose. If this is not the same register as the frame
3659pointer register, then you must mark it as a fixed register according to
3660@code{FIXED_REGISTERS}, or arrange to be able to eliminate it
3661(@pxref{Elimination}).
3662@end defmac
3663
e3339d0f
JM
3664@defmac HARD_FRAME_POINTER_IS_FRAME_POINTER
3665Define this to a preprocessor constant that is nonzero if
3666@code{hard_frame_pointer_rtx} and @code{frame_pointer_rtx} should be
3667the same. The default definition is @samp{(HARD_FRAME_POINTER_REGNUM
3668== FRAME_POINTER_REGNUM)}; you only need to define this macro if that
3669definition is not suitable for use in preprocessor conditionals.
3670@end defmac
3671
3672@defmac HARD_FRAME_POINTER_IS_ARG_POINTER
3673Define this to a preprocessor constant that is nonzero if
3674@code{hard_frame_pointer_rtx} and @code{arg_pointer_rtx} should be the
3675same. The default definition is @samp{(HARD_FRAME_POINTER_REGNUM ==
3676ARG_POINTER_REGNUM)}; you only need to define this macro if that
3677definition is not suitable for use in preprocessor conditionals.
3678@end defmac
3679
38f8b050
JR
3680@defmac RETURN_ADDRESS_POINTER_REGNUM
3681The register number of the return address pointer register, which is used to
3682access the current function's return address from the stack. On some
3683machines, the return address is not at a fixed offset from the frame
3684pointer or stack pointer or argument pointer. This register can be defined
3685to point to the return address on the stack, and then be converted by
3686@code{ELIMINABLE_REGS} into either the frame pointer or stack pointer.
3687
3688Do not define this macro unless there is no other way to get the return
3689address from the stack.
3690@end defmac
3691
3692@defmac STATIC_CHAIN_REGNUM
3693@defmacx STATIC_CHAIN_INCOMING_REGNUM
3694Register numbers used for passing a function's static chain pointer. If
3695register windows are used, the register number as seen by the called
3696function is @code{STATIC_CHAIN_INCOMING_REGNUM}, while the register
3697number as seen by the calling function is @code{STATIC_CHAIN_REGNUM}. If
3698these registers are the same, @code{STATIC_CHAIN_INCOMING_REGNUM} need
3699not be defined.
3700
3701The static chain register need not be a fixed register.
3702
3703If the static chain is passed in memory, these macros should not be
3704defined; instead, the @code{TARGET_STATIC_CHAIN} hook should be used.
3705@end defmac
3706
3707@hook TARGET_STATIC_CHAIN
3708This hook replaces the use of @code{STATIC_CHAIN_REGNUM} et al for
3709targets that may use different static chain locations for different
3710nested functions. This may be required if the target has function
3711attributes that affect the calling conventions of the function and
3712those calling conventions use different static chain locations.
3713
3714The default version of this hook uses @code{STATIC_CHAIN_REGNUM} et al.
3715
3716If the static chain is passed in memory, this hook should be used to
3717provide rtx giving @code{mem} expressions that denote where they are stored.
3718Often the @code{mem} expression as seen by the caller will be at an offset
3719from the stack pointer and the @code{mem} expression as seen by the callee
3720will be at an offset from the frame pointer.
3721@findex stack_pointer_rtx
3722@findex frame_pointer_rtx
3723@findex arg_pointer_rtx
3724The variables @code{stack_pointer_rtx}, @code{frame_pointer_rtx}, and
3725@code{arg_pointer_rtx} will have been initialized and should be used
3726to refer to those items.
3727@end deftypefn
3728
3729@defmac DWARF_FRAME_REGISTERS
3730This macro specifies the maximum number of hard registers that can be
3731saved in a call frame. This is used to size data structures used in
3732DWARF2 exception handling.
3733
3734Prior to GCC 3.0, this macro was needed in order to establish a stable
3735exception handling ABI in the face of adding new hard registers for ISA
3736extensions. In GCC 3.0 and later, the EH ABI is insulated from changes
3737in the number of hard registers. Nevertheless, this macro can still be
3738used to reduce the runtime memory requirements of the exception handling
3739routines, which can be substantial if the ISA contains a lot of
3740registers that are not call-saved.
3741
3742If this macro is not defined, it defaults to
3743@code{FIRST_PSEUDO_REGISTER}.
3744@end defmac
3745
3746@defmac PRE_GCC3_DWARF_FRAME_REGISTERS
3747
3748This macro is similar to @code{DWARF_FRAME_REGISTERS}, but is provided
3749for backward compatibility in pre GCC 3.0 compiled code.
3750
3751If this macro is not defined, it defaults to
3752@code{DWARF_FRAME_REGISTERS}.
3753@end defmac
3754
3755@defmac DWARF_REG_TO_UNWIND_COLUMN (@var{regno})
3756
3757Define this macro if the target's representation for dwarf registers
3758is different than the internal representation for unwind column.
3759Given a dwarf register, this macro should return the internal unwind
3760column number to use instead.
3761
3762See the PowerPC's SPE target for an example.
3763@end defmac
3764
3765@defmac DWARF_FRAME_REGNUM (@var{regno})
3766
3767Define this macro if the target's representation for dwarf registers
3768used in .eh_frame or .debug_frame is different from that used in other
3769debug info sections. Given a GCC hard register number, this macro
3770should return the .eh_frame register number. The default is
3771@code{DBX_REGISTER_NUMBER (@var{regno})}.
3772
3773@end defmac
3774
3775@defmac DWARF2_FRAME_REG_OUT (@var{regno}, @var{for_eh})
3776
3777Define this macro to map register numbers held in the call frame info
3778that GCC has collected using @code{DWARF_FRAME_REGNUM} to those that
3779should be output in .debug_frame (@code{@var{for_eh}} is zero) and
3780.eh_frame (@code{@var{for_eh}} is nonzero). The default is to
3781return @code{@var{regno}}.
3782
3783@end defmac
3784
3785@node Elimination
3786@subsection Eliminating Frame Pointer and Arg Pointer
3787
3788@c prevent bad page break with this line
3789This is about eliminating the frame pointer and arg pointer.
3790
3791@hook TARGET_FRAME_POINTER_REQUIRED
3792This target hook should return @code{true} if a function must have and use
3793a frame pointer. This target hook is called in the reload pass. If its return
3794value is @code{true} the function will have a frame pointer.
3795
3796This target hook can in principle examine the current function and decide
3797according to the facts, but on most machines the constant @code{false} or the
3798constant @code{true} suffices. Use @code{false} when the machine allows code
3799to be generated with no frame pointer, and doing so saves some time or space.
3800Use @code{true} when there is no possible advantage to avoiding a frame
3801pointer.
3802
3803In certain cases, the compiler does not know how to produce valid code
3804without a frame pointer. The compiler recognizes those cases and
3805automatically gives the function a frame pointer regardless of what
3806@code{TARGET_FRAME_POINTER_REQUIRED} returns. You don't need to worry about
3807them.
3808
3809In a function that does not require a frame pointer, the frame pointer
3810register can be allocated for ordinary usage, unless you mark it as a
3811fixed register. See @code{FIXED_REGISTERS} for more information.
3812
3813Default return value is @code{false}.
3814@end deftypefn
3815
3816@findex get_frame_size
3817@defmac INITIAL_FRAME_POINTER_OFFSET (@var{depth-var})
3818A C statement to store in the variable @var{depth-var} the difference
3819between the frame pointer and the stack pointer values immediately after
3820the function prologue. The value would be computed from information
3821such as the result of @code{get_frame_size ()} and the tables of
3822registers @code{regs_ever_live} and @code{call_used_regs}.
3823
3824If @code{ELIMINABLE_REGS} is defined, this macro will be not be used and
3825need not be defined. Otherwise, it must be defined even if
3826@code{TARGET_FRAME_POINTER_REQUIRED} always returns true; in that
3827case, you may set @var{depth-var} to anything.
3828@end defmac
3829
3830@defmac ELIMINABLE_REGS
3831If defined, this macro specifies a table of register pairs used to
3832eliminate unneeded registers that point into the stack frame. If it is not
3833defined, the only elimination attempted by the compiler is to replace
3834references to the frame pointer with references to the stack pointer.
3835
3836The definition of this macro is a list of structure initializations, each
3837of which specifies an original and replacement register.
3838
3839On some machines, the position of the argument pointer is not known until
3840the compilation is completed. In such a case, a separate hard register
3841must be used for the argument pointer. This register can be eliminated by
3842replacing it with either the frame pointer or the argument pointer,
3843depending on whether or not the frame pointer has been eliminated.
3844
3845In this case, you might specify:
3846@smallexample
3847#define ELIMINABLE_REGS \
3848@{@{ARG_POINTER_REGNUM, STACK_POINTER_REGNUM@}, \
3849 @{ARG_POINTER_REGNUM, FRAME_POINTER_REGNUM@}, \
3850 @{FRAME_POINTER_REGNUM, STACK_POINTER_REGNUM@}@}
3851@end smallexample
3852
3853Note that the elimination of the argument pointer with the stack pointer is
3854specified first since that is the preferred elimination.
3855@end defmac
3856
3857@hook TARGET_CAN_ELIMINATE
3858This target hook should returns @code{true} if the compiler is allowed to
3859try to replace register number @var{from_reg} with register number
3860@var{to_reg}. This target hook need only be defined if @code{ELIMINABLE_REGS}
3861is defined, and will usually be @code{true}, since most of the cases
3862preventing register elimination are things that the compiler already
3863knows about.
3864
3865Default return value is @code{true}.
3866@end deftypefn
3867
3868@defmac INITIAL_ELIMINATION_OFFSET (@var{from-reg}, @var{to-reg}, @var{offset-var})
3869This macro is similar to @code{INITIAL_FRAME_POINTER_OFFSET}. It
3870specifies the initial difference between the specified pair of
3871registers. This macro must be defined if @code{ELIMINABLE_REGS} is
3872defined.
3873@end defmac
3874
3875@node Stack Arguments
3876@subsection Passing Function Arguments on the Stack
3877@cindex arguments on stack
3878@cindex stack arguments
3879
3880The macros in this section control how arguments are passed
3881on the stack. See the following section for other macros that
3882control passing certain arguments in registers.
3883
3884@hook TARGET_PROMOTE_PROTOTYPES
3885This target hook returns @code{true} if an argument declared in a
3886prototype as an integral type smaller than @code{int} should actually be
3887passed as an @code{int}. In addition to avoiding errors in certain
3888cases of mismatch, it also makes for better code on certain machines.
3889The default is to not promote prototypes.
3890@end deftypefn
3891
3892@defmac PUSH_ARGS
3893A C expression. If nonzero, push insns will be used to pass
3894outgoing arguments.
3895If the target machine does not have a push instruction, set it to zero.
3896That directs GCC to use an alternate strategy: to
3897allocate the entire argument block and then store the arguments into
3898it. When @code{PUSH_ARGS} is nonzero, @code{PUSH_ROUNDING} must be defined too.
3899@end defmac
3900
3901@defmac PUSH_ARGS_REVERSED
3902A C expression. If nonzero, function arguments will be evaluated from
3903last to first, rather than from first to last. If this macro is not
3904defined, it defaults to @code{PUSH_ARGS} on targets where the stack
3905and args grow in opposite directions, and 0 otherwise.
3906@end defmac
3907
3908@defmac PUSH_ROUNDING (@var{npushed})
3909A C expression that is the number of bytes actually pushed onto the
3910stack when an instruction attempts to push @var{npushed} bytes.
3911
3912On some machines, the definition
3913
3914@smallexample
3915#define PUSH_ROUNDING(BYTES) (BYTES)
3916@end smallexample
3917
3918@noindent
3919will suffice. But on other machines, instructions that appear
3920to push one byte actually push two bytes in an attempt to maintain
3921alignment. Then the definition should be
3922
3923@smallexample
3924#define PUSH_ROUNDING(BYTES) (((BYTES) + 1) & ~1)
3925@end smallexample
3926@end defmac
3927
3928@findex current_function_outgoing_args_size
3929@defmac ACCUMULATE_OUTGOING_ARGS
3930A C expression. If nonzero, the maximum amount of space required for outgoing arguments
3931will be computed and placed into the variable
3932@code{current_function_outgoing_args_size}. No space will be pushed
3933onto the stack for each call; instead, the function prologue should
3934increase the stack frame size by this amount.
3935
3936Setting both @code{PUSH_ARGS} and @code{ACCUMULATE_OUTGOING_ARGS}
3937is not proper.
3938@end defmac
3939
3940@defmac REG_PARM_STACK_SPACE (@var{fndecl})
3941Define this macro if functions should assume that stack space has been
3942allocated for arguments even when their values are passed in
3943registers.
3944
3945The value of this macro is the size, in bytes, of the area reserved for
3946arguments passed in registers for the function represented by @var{fndecl},
3947which can be zero if GCC is calling a library function.
3948The argument @var{fndecl} can be the FUNCTION_DECL, or the type itself
3949of the function.
3950
3951This space can be allocated by the caller, or be a part of the
3952machine-dependent stack frame: @code{OUTGOING_REG_PARM_STACK_SPACE} says
3953which.
3954@end defmac
3955@c above is overfull. not sure what to do. --mew 5feb93 did
3956@c something, not sure if it looks good. --mew 10feb93
3957
3958@defmac OUTGOING_REG_PARM_STACK_SPACE (@var{fntype})
3959Define this to a nonzero value if it is the responsibility of the
3960caller to allocate the area reserved for arguments passed in registers
3961when calling a function of @var{fntype}. @var{fntype} may be NULL
3962if the function called is a library function.
3963
3964If @code{ACCUMULATE_OUTGOING_ARGS} is defined, this macro controls
3965whether the space for these arguments counts in the value of
3966@code{current_function_outgoing_args_size}.
3967@end defmac
3968
3969@defmac STACK_PARMS_IN_REG_PARM_AREA
3970Define this macro if @code{REG_PARM_STACK_SPACE} is defined, but the
3971stack parameters don't skip the area specified by it.
3972@c i changed this, makes more sens and it should have taken care of the
3973@c overfull.. not as specific, tho. --mew 5feb93
3974
3975Normally, when a parameter is not passed in registers, it is placed on the
3976stack beyond the @code{REG_PARM_STACK_SPACE} area. Defining this macro
3977suppresses this behavior and causes the parameter to be passed on the
3978stack in its natural location.
3979@end defmac
3980
893d13d5 3981@hook TARGET_RETURN_POPS_ARGS
38f8b050
JR
3982This target hook returns the number of bytes of its own arguments that
3983a function pops on returning, or 0 if the function pops no arguments
3984and the caller must therefore pop them all after the function returns.
3985
3986@var{fundecl} is a C variable whose value is a tree node that describes
3987the function in question. Normally it is a node of type
3988@code{FUNCTION_DECL} that describes the declaration of the function.
3989From this you can obtain the @code{DECL_ATTRIBUTES} of the function.
3990
3991@var{funtype} is a C variable whose value is a tree node that
3992describes the function in question. Normally it is a node of type
3993@code{FUNCTION_TYPE} that describes the data type of the function.
3994From this it is possible to obtain the data types of the value and
3995arguments (if known).
3996
3997When a call to a library function is being considered, @var{fundecl}
3998will contain an identifier node for the library function. Thus, if
3999you need to distinguish among various library functions, you can do so
4000by their names. Note that ``library function'' in this context means
4001a function used to perform arithmetic, whose name is known specially
4002in the compiler and was not mentioned in the C code being compiled.
4003
893d13d5 4004@var{size} is the number of bytes of arguments passed on the
38f8b050
JR
4005stack. If a variable number of bytes is passed, it is zero, and
4006argument popping will always be the responsibility of the calling function.
4007
4008On the VAX, all functions always pop their arguments, so the definition
893d13d5 4009of this macro is @var{size}. On the 68000, using the standard
38f8b050
JR
4010calling convention, no functions pop their arguments, so the value of
4011the macro is always 0 in this case. But an alternative calling
4012convention is available in which functions that take a fixed number of
4013arguments pop them but other functions (such as @code{printf}) pop
4014nothing (the caller pops all). When this convention is in use,
4015@var{funtype} is examined to determine whether a function takes a fixed
4016number of arguments.
4017@end deftypefn
4018
4019@defmac CALL_POPS_ARGS (@var{cum})
4020A C expression that should indicate the number of bytes a call sequence
4021pops off the stack. It is added to the value of @code{RETURN_POPS_ARGS}
4022when compiling a function call.
4023
4024@var{cum} is the variable in which all arguments to the called function
4025have been accumulated.
4026
4027On certain architectures, such as the SH5, a call trampoline is used
4028that pops certain registers off the stack, depending on the arguments
4029that have been passed to the function. Since this is a property of the
4030call site, not of the called function, @code{RETURN_POPS_ARGS} is not
4031appropriate.
4032@end defmac
4033
4034@node Register Arguments
4035@subsection Passing Arguments in Registers
4036@cindex arguments in registers
4037@cindex registers arguments
4038
4039This section describes the macros which let you control how various
4040types of arguments are passed in registers or how they are arranged in
4041the stack.
4042
4043@defmac FUNCTION_ARG (@var{cum}, @var{mode}, @var{type}, @var{named})
4044A C expression that controls whether a function argument is passed
4045in a register, and which register.
4046
4047The arguments are @var{cum}, which summarizes all the previous
4048arguments; @var{mode}, the machine mode of the argument; @var{type},
4049the data type of the argument as a tree node or 0 if that is not known
4050(which happens for C support library functions); and @var{named},
4051which is 1 for an ordinary argument and 0 for nameless arguments that
4052correspond to @samp{@dots{}} in the called function's prototype.
4053@var{type} can be an incomplete type if a syntax error has previously
4054occurred.
4055
4056The value of the expression is usually either a @code{reg} RTX for the
4057hard register in which to pass the argument, or zero to pass the
4058argument on the stack.
4059
4060For machines like the VAX and 68000, where normally all arguments are
4061pushed, zero suffices as a definition.
4062
4063The value of the expression can also be a @code{parallel} RTX@. This is
4064used when an argument is passed in multiple locations. The mode of the
4065@code{parallel} should be the mode of the entire argument. The
4066@code{parallel} holds any number of @code{expr_list} pairs; each one
4067describes where part of the argument is passed. In each
4068@code{expr_list} the first operand must be a @code{reg} RTX for the hard
4069register in which to pass this part of the argument, and the mode of the
4070register RTX indicates how large this part of the argument is. The
4071second operand of the @code{expr_list} is a @code{const_int} which gives
4072the offset in bytes into the entire argument of where this part starts.
4073As a special exception the first @code{expr_list} in the @code{parallel}
4074RTX may have a first operand of zero. This indicates that the entire
4075argument is also stored on the stack.
4076
4077The last time this macro is called, it is called with @code{MODE ==
4078VOIDmode}, and its result is passed to the @code{call} or @code{call_value}
4079pattern as operands 2 and 3 respectively.
4080
4081@cindex @file{stdarg.h} and register arguments
4082The usual way to make the ISO library @file{stdarg.h} work on a machine
4083where some arguments are usually passed in registers, is to cause
4084nameless arguments to be passed on the stack instead. This is done
4085by making @code{FUNCTION_ARG} return 0 whenever @var{named} is 0.
4086
4087@cindex @code{TARGET_MUST_PASS_IN_STACK}, and @code{FUNCTION_ARG}
4088@cindex @code{REG_PARM_STACK_SPACE}, and @code{FUNCTION_ARG}
4089You may use the hook @code{targetm.calls.must_pass_in_stack}
4090in the definition of this macro to determine if this argument is of a
4091type that must be passed in the stack. If @code{REG_PARM_STACK_SPACE}
4092is not defined and @code{FUNCTION_ARG} returns nonzero for such an
4093argument, the compiler will abort. If @code{REG_PARM_STACK_SPACE} is
4094defined, the argument will be computed in the stack and then loaded into
4095a register.
4096@end defmac
4097
4098@hook TARGET_MUST_PASS_IN_STACK
4099This target hook should return @code{true} if we should not pass @var{type}
4100solely in registers. The file @file{expr.h} defines a
4101definition that is usually appropriate, refer to @file{expr.h} for additional
4102documentation.
4103@end deftypefn
4104
4105@defmac FUNCTION_INCOMING_ARG (@var{cum}, @var{mode}, @var{type}, @var{named})
4106Define this macro if the target machine has ``register windows'', so
4107that the register in which a function sees an arguments is not
4108necessarily the same as the one in which the caller passed the
4109argument.
4110
4111For such machines, @code{FUNCTION_ARG} computes the register in which
4112the caller passes the value, and @code{FUNCTION_INCOMING_ARG} should
4113be defined in a similar fashion to tell the function being called
4114where the arguments will arrive.
4115
4116If @code{FUNCTION_INCOMING_ARG} is not defined, @code{FUNCTION_ARG}
4117serves both purposes.
4118@end defmac
4119
4120@hook TARGET_ARG_PARTIAL_BYTES
4121This target hook returns the number of bytes at the beginning of an
4122argument that must be put in registers. The value must be zero for
4123arguments that are passed entirely in registers or that are entirely
4124pushed on the stack.
4125
4126On some machines, certain arguments must be passed partially in
4127registers and partially in memory. On these machines, typically the
4128first few words of arguments are passed in registers, and the rest
4129on the stack. If a multi-word argument (a @code{double} or a
4130structure) crosses that boundary, its first few words must be passed
4131in registers and the rest must be pushed. This macro tells the
4132compiler when this occurs, and how many bytes should go in registers.
4133
4134@code{FUNCTION_ARG} for these arguments should return the first
4135register to be used by the caller for this argument; likewise
4136@code{FUNCTION_INCOMING_ARG}, for the called function.
4137@end deftypefn
4138
ec9f85e5 4139@hook TARGET_PASS_BY_REFERENCE
38f8b050
JR
4140This target hook should return @code{true} if an argument at the
4141position indicated by @var{cum} should be passed by reference. This
4142predicate is queried after target independent reasons for being
4143passed by reference, such as @code{TREE_ADDRESSABLE (type)}.
4144
4145If the hook returns true, a copy of that argument is made in memory and a
4146pointer to the argument is passed instead of the argument itself.
4147The pointer is passed in whatever way is appropriate for passing a pointer
4148to that type.
4149@end deftypefn
4150
4151@hook TARGET_CALLEE_COPIES
4152The function argument described by the parameters to this hook is
4153known to be passed by reference. The hook should return true if the
4154function argument should be copied by the callee instead of copied
4155by the caller.
4156
4157For any argument for which the hook returns true, if it can be
4158determined that the argument is not modified, then a copy need
4159not be generated.
4160
4161The default version of this hook always returns false.
4162@end deftypefn
4163
4164@defmac CUMULATIVE_ARGS
4165A C type for declaring a variable that is used as the first argument of
4166@code{FUNCTION_ARG} and other related values. For some target machines,
4167the type @code{int} suffices and can hold the number of bytes of
4168argument so far.
4169
4170There is no need to record in @code{CUMULATIVE_ARGS} anything about the
4171arguments that have been passed on the stack. The compiler has other
4172variables to keep track of that. For target machines on which all
4173arguments are passed on the stack, there is no need to store anything in
4174@code{CUMULATIVE_ARGS}; however, the data structure must exist and
4175should not be empty, so use @code{int}.
4176@end defmac
4177
4178@defmac OVERRIDE_ABI_FORMAT (@var{fndecl})
4179If defined, this macro is called before generating any code for a
4180function, but after the @var{cfun} descriptor for the function has been
4181created. The back end may use this macro to update @var{cfun} to
4182reflect an ABI other than that which would normally be used by default.
4183If the compiler is generating code for a compiler-generated function,
4184@var{fndecl} may be @code{NULL}.
4185@end defmac
4186
4187@defmac INIT_CUMULATIVE_ARGS (@var{cum}, @var{fntype}, @var{libname}, @var{fndecl}, @var{n_named_args})
4188A C statement (sans semicolon) for initializing the variable
4189@var{cum} for the state at the beginning of the argument list. The
4190variable has type @code{CUMULATIVE_ARGS}. The value of @var{fntype}
4191is the tree node for the data type of the function which will receive
4192the args, or 0 if the args are to a compiler support library function.
4193For direct calls that are not libcalls, @var{fndecl} contain the
4194declaration node of the function. @var{fndecl} is also set when
4195@code{INIT_CUMULATIVE_ARGS} is used to find arguments for the function
4196being compiled. @var{n_named_args} is set to the number of named
4197arguments, including a structure return address if it is passed as a
4198parameter, when making a call. When processing incoming arguments,
4199@var{n_named_args} is set to @minus{}1.
4200
4201When processing a call to a compiler support library function,
4202@var{libname} identifies which one. It is a @code{symbol_ref} rtx which
4203contains the name of the function, as a string. @var{libname} is 0 when
4204an ordinary C function call is being processed. Thus, each time this
4205macro is called, either @var{libname} or @var{fntype} is nonzero, but
4206never both of them at once.
4207@end defmac
4208
4209@defmac INIT_CUMULATIVE_LIBCALL_ARGS (@var{cum}, @var{mode}, @var{libname})
4210Like @code{INIT_CUMULATIVE_ARGS} but only used for outgoing libcalls,
4211it gets a @code{MODE} argument instead of @var{fntype}, that would be
4212@code{NULL}. @var{indirect} would always be zero, too. If this macro
4213is not defined, @code{INIT_CUMULATIVE_ARGS (cum, NULL_RTX, libname,
42140)} is used instead.
4215@end defmac
4216
4217@defmac INIT_CUMULATIVE_INCOMING_ARGS (@var{cum}, @var{fntype}, @var{libname})
4218Like @code{INIT_CUMULATIVE_ARGS} but overrides it for the purposes of
4219finding the arguments for the function being compiled. If this macro is
4220undefined, @code{INIT_CUMULATIVE_ARGS} is used instead.
4221
4222The value passed for @var{libname} is always 0, since library routines
4223with special calling conventions are never compiled with GCC@. The
4224argument @var{libname} exists for symmetry with
4225@code{INIT_CUMULATIVE_ARGS}.
4226@c could use "this macro" in place of @code{INIT_CUMULATIVE_ARGS}, maybe.
4227@c --mew 5feb93 i switched the order of the sentences. --mew 10feb93
4228@end defmac
4229
4230@defmac FUNCTION_ARG_ADVANCE (@var{cum}, @var{mode}, @var{type}, @var{named})
4231A C statement (sans semicolon) to update the summarizer variable
4232@var{cum} to advance past an argument in the argument list. The
4233values @var{mode}, @var{type} and @var{named} describe that argument.
4234Once this is done, the variable @var{cum} is suitable for analyzing
4235the @emph{following} argument with @code{FUNCTION_ARG}, etc.
4236
4237This macro need not do anything if the argument in question was passed
4238on the stack. The compiler knows how to track the amount of stack space
4239used for arguments without any special help.
4240@end defmac
4241
4242@defmac FUNCTION_ARG_OFFSET (@var{mode}, @var{type})
4243If defined, a C expression that is the number of bytes to add to the
4244offset of the argument passed in memory. This is needed for the SPU,
4245which passes @code{char} and @code{short} arguments in the preferred
4246slot that is in the middle of the quad word instead of starting at the
4247top.
4248@end defmac
4249
4250@defmac FUNCTION_ARG_PADDING (@var{mode}, @var{type})
4251If defined, a C expression which determines whether, and in which direction,
4252to pad out an argument with extra space. The value should be of type
4253@code{enum direction}: either @code{upward} to pad above the argument,
4254@code{downward} to pad below, or @code{none} to inhibit padding.
4255
4256The @emph{amount} of padding is always just enough to reach the next
4257multiple of @code{FUNCTION_ARG_BOUNDARY}; this macro does not control
4258it.
4259
4260This macro has a default definition which is right for most systems.
4261For little-endian machines, the default is to pad upward. For
4262big-endian machines, the default is to pad downward for an argument of
4263constant size shorter than an @code{int}, and upward otherwise.
4264@end defmac
4265
4266@defmac PAD_VARARGS_DOWN
4267If defined, a C expression which determines whether the default
4268implementation of va_arg will attempt to pad down before reading the
4269next argument, if that argument is smaller than its aligned space as
4270controlled by @code{PARM_BOUNDARY}. If this macro is not defined, all such
4271arguments are padded down if @code{BYTES_BIG_ENDIAN} is true.
4272@end defmac
4273
4274@defmac BLOCK_REG_PADDING (@var{mode}, @var{type}, @var{first})
4275Specify padding for the last element of a block move between registers and
4276memory. @var{first} is nonzero if this is the only element. Defining this
4277macro allows better control of register function parameters on big-endian
4278machines, without using @code{PARALLEL} rtl. In particular,
4279@code{MUST_PASS_IN_STACK} need not test padding and mode of types in
4280registers, as there is no longer a "wrong" part of a register; For example,
4281a three byte aggregate may be passed in the high part of a register if so
4282required.
4283@end defmac
4284
4285@defmac FUNCTION_ARG_BOUNDARY (@var{mode}, @var{type})
4286If defined, a C expression that gives the alignment boundary, in bits,
4287of an argument with the specified mode and type. If it is not defined,
4288@code{PARM_BOUNDARY} is used for all arguments.
4289@end defmac
4290
4291@defmac FUNCTION_ARG_REGNO_P (@var{regno})
4292A C expression that is nonzero if @var{regno} is the number of a hard
4293register in which function arguments are sometimes passed. This does
4294@emph{not} include implicit arguments such as the static chain and
4295the structure-value address. On many machines, no registers can be
4296used for this purpose since all function arguments are pushed on the
4297stack.
4298@end defmac
4299
4300@hook TARGET_SPLIT_COMPLEX_ARG
4301This hook should return true if parameter of type @var{type} are passed
4302as two scalar parameters. By default, GCC will attempt to pack complex
4303arguments into the target's word size. Some ABIs require complex arguments
4304to be split and treated as their individual components. For example, on
4305AIX64, complex floats should be passed in a pair of floating point
4306registers, even though a complex float would fit in one 64-bit floating
4307point register.
4308
4309The default value of this hook is @code{NULL}, which is treated as always
4310false.
4311@end deftypefn
4312
4313@hook TARGET_BUILD_BUILTIN_VA_LIST
4314This hook returns a type node for @code{va_list} for the target.
4315The default version of the hook returns @code{void*}.
4316@end deftypefn
4317
07a5b2bc 4318@hook TARGET_ENUM_VA_LIST_P
38f8b050
JR
4319This target hook is used in function @code{c_common_nodes_and_builtins}
4320to iterate through the target specific builtin types for va_list. The
4321variable @var{idx} is used as iterator. @var{pname} has to be a pointer
07a5b2bc 4322to a @code{const char *} and @var{ptree} a pointer to a @code{tree} typed
38f8b050 4323variable.
07a5b2bc 4324The arguments @var{pname} and @var{ptree} are used to store the result of
38f8b050
JR
4325this macro and are set to the name of the va_list builtin type and its
4326internal type.
4327If the return value of this macro is zero, then there is no more element.
4328Otherwise the @var{IDX} should be increased for the next call of this
4329macro to iterate through all types.
4330@end deftypefn
4331
4332@hook TARGET_FN_ABI_VA_LIST
4333This hook returns the va_list type of the calling convention specified by
4334@var{fndecl}.
4335The default version of this hook returns @code{va_list_type_node}.
4336@end deftypefn
4337
4338@hook TARGET_CANONICAL_VA_LIST_TYPE
4339This hook returns the va_list type of the calling convention specified by the
4340type of @var{type}. If @var{type} is not a valid va_list type, it returns
4341@code{NULL_TREE}.
4342@end deftypefn
4343
4344@hook TARGET_GIMPLIFY_VA_ARG_EXPR
4345This hook performs target-specific gimplification of
4346@code{VA_ARG_EXPR}. The first two parameters correspond to the
4347arguments to @code{va_arg}; the latter two are as in
4348@code{gimplify.c:gimplify_expr}.
4349@end deftypefn
4350
4351@hook TARGET_VALID_POINTER_MODE
4352Define this to return nonzero if the port can handle pointers
4353with machine mode @var{mode}. The default version of this
4354hook returns true for both @code{ptr_mode} and @code{Pmode}.
4355@end deftypefn
4356
4357@hook TARGET_SCALAR_MODE_SUPPORTED_P
4358Define this to return nonzero if the port is prepared to handle
4359insns involving scalar mode @var{mode}. For a scalar mode to be
4360considered supported, all the basic arithmetic and comparisons
4361must work.
4362
4363The default version of this hook returns true for any mode
4364required to handle the basic C types (as defined by the port).
4365Included here are the double-word arithmetic supported by the
4366code in @file{optabs.c}.
4367@end deftypefn
4368
4369@hook TARGET_VECTOR_MODE_SUPPORTED_P
4370Define this to return nonzero if the port is prepared to handle
4371insns involving vector mode @var{mode}. At the very least, it
4372must have move patterns for this mode.
4373@end deftypefn
4374
4375@hook TARGET_SMALL_REGISTER_CLASSES_FOR_MODE_P
4376Define this to return nonzero for machine modes for which the port has
4377small register classes. If this target hook returns nonzero for a given
4378@var{mode}, the compiler will try to minimize the lifetime of registers
4379in @var{mode}. The hook may be called with @code{VOIDmode} as argument.
4380In this case, the hook is expected to return nonzero if it returns nonzero
4381for any mode.
4382
4383On some machines, it is risky to let hard registers live across arbitrary
4384insns. Typically, these machines have instructions that require values
4385to be in specific registers (like an accumulator), and reload will fail
4386if the required hard register is used for another purpose across such an
4387insn.
4388
4389Passes before reload do not know which hard registers will be used
4390in an instruction, but the machine modes of the registers set or used in
4391the instruction are already known. And for some machines, register
4392classes are small for, say, integer registers but not for floating point
4393registers. For example, the AMD x86-64 architecture requires specific
4394registers for the legacy x86 integer instructions, but there are many
4395SSE registers for floating point operations. On such targets, a good
4396strategy may be to return nonzero from this hook for @code{INTEGRAL_MODE_P}
4397machine modes but zero for the SSE register classes.
4398
4399The default version of this hook retuns false for any mode. It is always
4400safe to redefine this hook to return with a nonzero value. But if you
4401unnecessarily define it, you will reduce the amount of optimizations
4402that can be performed in some cases. If you do not define this hook
4403to return a nonzero value when it is required, the compiler will run out
4404of spill registers and print a fatal error message.
4405@end deftypefn
4406
4407@node Scalar Return
4408@subsection How Scalar Function Values Are Returned
4409@cindex return values in registers
4410@cindex values, returned by functions
4411@cindex scalars, returned as values
4412
4413This section discusses the macros that control returning scalars as
4414values---values that can fit in registers.
4415
4416@hook TARGET_FUNCTION_VALUE
4417
4418Define this to return an RTX representing the place where a function
4419returns or receives a value of data type @var{ret_type}, a tree node
4420representing a data type. @var{fn_decl_or_type} is a tree node
4421representing @code{FUNCTION_DECL} or @code{FUNCTION_TYPE} of a
4422function being called. If @var{outgoing} is false, the hook should
4423compute the register in which the caller will see the return value.
4424Otherwise, the hook should return an RTX representing the place where
4425a function returns a value.
4426
4427On many machines, only @code{TYPE_MODE (@var{ret_type})} is relevant.
4428(Actually, on most machines, scalar values are returned in the same
4429place regardless of mode.) The value of the expression is usually a
4430@code{reg} RTX for the hard register where the return value is stored.
4431The value can also be a @code{parallel} RTX, if the return value is in
4432multiple places. See @code{FUNCTION_ARG} for an explanation of the
4433@code{parallel} form. Note that the callee will populate every
4434location specified in the @code{parallel}, but if the first element of
4435the @code{parallel} contains the whole return value, callers will use
4436that element as the canonical location and ignore the others. The m68k
4437port uses this type of @code{parallel} to return pointers in both
4438@samp{%a0} (the canonical location) and @samp{%d0}.
4439
4440If @code{TARGET_PROMOTE_FUNCTION_RETURN} returns true, you must apply
4441the same promotion rules specified in @code{PROMOTE_MODE} if
4442@var{valtype} is a scalar type.
4443
4444If the precise function being called is known, @var{func} is a tree
4445node (@code{FUNCTION_DECL}) for it; otherwise, @var{func} is a null
4446pointer. This makes it possible to use a different value-returning
4447convention for specific functions when all their calls are
4448known.
4449
4450Some target machines have ``register windows'' so that the register in
4451which a function returns its value is not the same as the one in which
4452the caller sees the value. For such machines, you should return
4453different RTX depending on @var{outgoing}.
4454
4455@code{TARGET_FUNCTION_VALUE} is not used for return values with
4456aggregate data types, because these are returned in another way. See
4457@code{TARGET_STRUCT_VALUE_RTX} and related macros, below.
4458@end deftypefn
4459
4460@defmac FUNCTION_VALUE (@var{valtype}, @var{func})
4461This macro has been deprecated. Use @code{TARGET_FUNCTION_VALUE} for
4462a new target instead.
4463@end defmac
4464
4465@defmac LIBCALL_VALUE (@var{mode})
4466A C expression to create an RTX representing the place where a library
4467function returns a value of mode @var{mode}.
4468
4469Note that ``library function'' in this context means a compiler
4470support routine, used to perform arithmetic, whose name is known
4471specially by the compiler and was not mentioned in the C code being
4472compiled.
4473@end defmac
4474
4475@hook TARGET_LIBCALL_VALUE
4476Define this hook if the back-end needs to know the name of the libcall
4477function in order to determine where the result should be returned.
4478
4479The mode of the result is given by @var{mode} and the name of the called
4480library function is given by @var{fun}. The hook should return an RTX
4481representing the place where the library function result will be returned.
4482
4483If this hook is not defined, then LIBCALL_VALUE will be used.
4484@end deftypefn
4485
4486@defmac FUNCTION_VALUE_REGNO_P (@var{regno})
4487A C expression that is nonzero if @var{regno} is the number of a hard
4488register in which the values of called function may come back.
4489
4490A register whose use for returning values is limited to serving as the
4491second of a pair (for a value of type @code{double}, say) need not be
4492recognized by this macro. So for most machines, this definition
4493suffices:
4494
4495@smallexample
4496#define FUNCTION_VALUE_REGNO_P(N) ((N) == 0)
4497@end smallexample
4498
4499If the machine has register windows, so that the caller and the called
4500function use different registers for the return value, this macro
4501should recognize only the caller's register numbers.
4502
4503This macro has been deprecated. Use @code{TARGET_FUNCTION_VALUE_REGNO_P}
4504for a new target instead.
4505@end defmac
4506
4507@hook TARGET_FUNCTION_VALUE_REGNO_P
4508A target hook that return @code{true} if @var{regno} is the number of a hard
4509register in which the values of called function may come back.
4510
4511A register whose use for returning values is limited to serving as the
4512second of a pair (for a value of type @code{double}, say) need not be
4513recognized by this target hook.
4514
4515If the machine has register windows, so that the caller and the called
4516function use different registers for the return value, this target hook
4517should recognize only the caller's register numbers.
4518
4519If this hook is not defined, then FUNCTION_VALUE_REGNO_P will be used.
4520@end deftypefn
4521
4522@defmac APPLY_RESULT_SIZE
4523Define this macro if @samp{untyped_call} and @samp{untyped_return}
4524need more space than is implied by @code{FUNCTION_VALUE_REGNO_P} for
4525saving and restoring an arbitrary return value.
4526@end defmac
4527
4528@hook TARGET_RETURN_IN_MSB
4529This hook should return true if values of type @var{type} are returned
4530at the most significant end of a register (in other words, if they are
4531padded at the least significant end). You can assume that @var{type}
4532is returned in a register; the caller is required to check this.
4533
4534Note that the register provided by @code{TARGET_FUNCTION_VALUE} must
4535be able to hold the complete return value. For example, if a 1-, 2-
4536or 3-byte structure is returned at the most significant end of a
45374-byte register, @code{TARGET_FUNCTION_VALUE} should provide an
4538@code{SImode} rtx.
4539@end deftypefn
4540
4541@node Aggregate Return
4542@subsection How Large Values Are Returned
4543@cindex aggregates as return values
4544@cindex large return values
4545@cindex returning aggregate values
4546@cindex structure value address
4547
4548When a function value's mode is @code{BLKmode} (and in some other
4549cases), the value is not returned according to
4550@code{TARGET_FUNCTION_VALUE} (@pxref{Scalar Return}). Instead, the
4551caller passes the address of a block of memory in which the value
4552should be stored. This address is called the @dfn{structure value
4553address}.
4554
4555This section describes how to control returning structure values in
4556memory.
4557
4558@hook TARGET_RETURN_IN_MEMORY
4559This target hook should return a nonzero value to say to return the
4560function value in memory, just as large structures are always returned.
4561Here @var{type} will be the data type of the value, and @var{fntype}
4562will be the type of the function doing the returning, or @code{NULL} for
4563libcalls.
4564
4565Note that values of mode @code{BLKmode} must be explicitly handled
4566by this function. Also, the option @option{-fpcc-struct-return}
4567takes effect regardless of this macro. On most systems, it is
4568possible to leave the hook undefined; this causes a default
4569definition to be used, whose value is the constant 1 for @code{BLKmode}
4570values, and 0 otherwise.
4571
4572Do not use this hook to indicate that structures and unions should always
4573be returned in memory. You should instead use @code{DEFAULT_PCC_STRUCT_RETURN}
4574to indicate this.
4575@end deftypefn
4576
4577@defmac DEFAULT_PCC_STRUCT_RETURN
4578Define this macro to be 1 if all structure and union return values must be
4579in memory. Since this results in slower code, this should be defined
4580only if needed for compatibility with other compilers or with an ABI@.
4581If you define this macro to be 0, then the conventions used for structure
4582and union return values are decided by the @code{TARGET_RETURN_IN_MEMORY}
4583target hook.
4584
4585If not defined, this defaults to the value 1.
4586@end defmac
4587
4588@hook TARGET_STRUCT_VALUE_RTX
4589This target hook should return the location of the structure value
4590address (normally a @code{mem} or @code{reg}), or 0 if the address is
4591passed as an ``invisible'' first argument. Note that @var{fndecl} may
4592be @code{NULL}, for libcalls. You do not need to define this target
4593hook if the address is always passed as an ``invisible'' first
4594argument.
4595
4596On some architectures the place where the structure value address
4597is found by the called function is not the same place that the
4598caller put it. This can be due to register windows, or it could
4599be because the function prologue moves it to a different place.
4600@var{incoming} is @code{1} or @code{2} when the location is needed in
4601the context of the called function, and @code{0} in the context of
4602the caller.
4603
4604If @var{incoming} is nonzero and the address is to be found on the
4605stack, return a @code{mem} which refers to the frame pointer. If
4606@var{incoming} is @code{2}, the result is being used to fetch the
4607structure value address at the beginning of a function. If you need
4608to emit adjusting code, you should do it at this point.
4609@end deftypefn
4610
4611@defmac PCC_STATIC_STRUCT_RETURN
4612Define this macro if the usual system convention on the target machine
4613for returning structures and unions is for the called function to return
4614the address of a static variable containing the value.
4615
4616Do not define this if the usual system convention is for the caller to
4617pass an address to the subroutine.
4618
4619This macro has effect in @option{-fpcc-struct-return} mode, but it does
4620nothing when you use @option{-freg-struct-return} mode.
4621@end defmac
4622
4623@node Caller Saves
4624@subsection Caller-Saves Register Allocation
4625
4626If you enable it, GCC can save registers around function calls. This
4627makes it possible to use call-clobbered registers to hold variables that
4628must live across calls.
4629
4630@defmac CALLER_SAVE_PROFITABLE (@var{refs}, @var{calls})
4631A C expression to determine whether it is worthwhile to consider placing
4632a pseudo-register in a call-clobbered hard register and saving and
4633restoring it around each function call. The expression should be 1 when
4634this is worth doing, and 0 otherwise.
4635
4636If you don't define this macro, a default is used which is good on most
4637machines: @code{4 * @var{calls} < @var{refs}}.
4638@end defmac
4639
4640@defmac HARD_REGNO_CALLER_SAVE_MODE (@var{regno}, @var{nregs})
4641A C expression specifying which mode is required for saving @var{nregs}
4642of a pseudo-register in call-clobbered hard register @var{regno}. If
4643@var{regno} is unsuitable for caller save, @code{VOIDmode} should be
4644returned. For most machines this macro need not be defined since GCC
4645will select the smallest suitable mode.
4646@end defmac
4647
4648@node Function Entry
4649@subsection Function Entry and Exit
4650@cindex function entry and exit
4651@cindex prologue
4652@cindex epilogue
4653
4654This section describes the macros that output function entry
4655(@dfn{prologue}) and exit (@dfn{epilogue}) code.
4656
4657@hook TARGET_ASM_FUNCTION_PROLOGUE
4658If defined, a function that outputs the assembler code for entry to a
4659function. The prologue is responsible for setting up the stack frame,
4660initializing the frame pointer register, saving registers that must be
4661saved, and allocating @var{size} additional bytes of storage for the
4662local variables. @var{size} is an integer. @var{file} is a stdio
4663stream to which the assembler code should be output.
4664
4665The label for the beginning of the function need not be output by this
4666macro. That has already been done when the macro is run.
4667
4668@findex regs_ever_live
4669To determine which registers to save, the macro can refer to the array
4670@code{regs_ever_live}: element @var{r} is nonzero if hard register
4671@var{r} is used anywhere within the function. This implies the function
4672prologue should save register @var{r}, provided it is not one of the
4673call-used registers. (@code{TARGET_ASM_FUNCTION_EPILOGUE} must likewise use
4674@code{regs_ever_live}.)
4675
4676On machines that have ``register windows'', the function entry code does
4677not save on the stack the registers that are in the windows, even if
4678they are supposed to be preserved by function calls; instead it takes
4679appropriate steps to ``push'' the register stack, if any non-call-used
4680registers are used in the function.
4681
4682@findex frame_pointer_needed
4683On machines where functions may or may not have frame-pointers, the
4684function entry code must vary accordingly; it must set up the frame
4685pointer if one is wanted, and not otherwise. To determine whether a
4686frame pointer is in wanted, the macro can refer to the variable
4687@code{frame_pointer_needed}. The variable's value will be 1 at run
4688time in a function that needs a frame pointer. @xref{Elimination}.
4689
4690The function entry code is responsible for allocating any stack space
4691required for the function. This stack space consists of the regions
4692listed below. In most cases, these regions are allocated in the
4693order listed, with the last listed region closest to the top of the
4694stack (the lowest address if @code{STACK_GROWS_DOWNWARD} is defined, and
4695the highest address if it is not defined). You can use a different order
4696for a machine if doing so is more convenient or required for
4697compatibility reasons. Except in cases where required by standard
4698or by a debugger, there is no reason why the stack layout used by GCC
4699need agree with that used by other compilers for a machine.
4700@end deftypefn
4701
4702@hook TARGET_ASM_FUNCTION_END_PROLOGUE
4703If defined, a function that outputs assembler code at the end of a
4704prologue. This should be used when the function prologue is being
4705emitted as RTL, and you have some extra assembler that needs to be
4706emitted. @xref{prologue instruction pattern}.
4707@end deftypefn
4708
4709@hook TARGET_ASM_FUNCTION_BEGIN_EPILOGUE
4710If defined, a function that outputs assembler code at the start of an
4711epilogue. This should be used when the function epilogue is being
4712emitted as RTL, and you have some extra assembler that needs to be
4713emitted. @xref{epilogue instruction pattern}.
4714@end deftypefn
4715
4716@hook TARGET_ASM_FUNCTION_EPILOGUE
4717If defined, a function that outputs the assembler code for exit from a
4718function. The epilogue is responsible for restoring the saved
4719registers and stack pointer to their values when the function was
4720called, and returning control to the caller. This macro takes the
4721same arguments as the macro @code{TARGET_ASM_FUNCTION_PROLOGUE}, and the
4722registers to restore are determined from @code{regs_ever_live} and
4723@code{CALL_USED_REGISTERS} in the same way.
4724
4725On some machines, there is a single instruction that does all the work
4726of returning from the function. On these machines, give that
4727instruction the name @samp{return} and do not define the macro
4728@code{TARGET_ASM_FUNCTION_EPILOGUE} at all.
4729
4730Do not define a pattern named @samp{return} if you want the
4731@code{TARGET_ASM_FUNCTION_EPILOGUE} to be used. If you want the target
4732switches to control whether return instructions or epilogues are used,
4733define a @samp{return} pattern with a validity condition that tests the
4734target switches appropriately. If the @samp{return} pattern's validity
4735condition is false, epilogues will be used.
4736
4737On machines where functions may or may not have frame-pointers, the
4738function exit code must vary accordingly. Sometimes the code for these
4739two cases is completely different. To determine whether a frame pointer
4740is wanted, the macro can refer to the variable
4741@code{frame_pointer_needed}. The variable's value will be 1 when compiling
4742a function that needs a frame pointer.
4743
4744Normally, @code{TARGET_ASM_FUNCTION_PROLOGUE} and
4745@code{TARGET_ASM_FUNCTION_EPILOGUE} must treat leaf functions specially.
4746The C variable @code{current_function_is_leaf} is nonzero for such a
4747function. @xref{Leaf Functions}.
4748
4749On some machines, some functions pop their arguments on exit while
4750others leave that for the caller to do. For example, the 68020 when
4751given @option{-mrtd} pops arguments in functions that take a fixed
4752number of arguments.
4753
4754@findex current_function_pops_args
4755Your definition of the macro @code{RETURN_POPS_ARGS} decides which
4756functions pop their own arguments. @code{TARGET_ASM_FUNCTION_EPILOGUE}
4757needs to know what was decided. The number of bytes of the current
4758function's arguments that this function should pop is available in
4759@code{crtl->args.pops_args}. @xref{Scalar Return}.
4760@end deftypefn
4761
4762@itemize @bullet
4763@item
4764@findex current_function_pretend_args_size
4765A region of @code{current_function_pretend_args_size} bytes of
4766uninitialized space just underneath the first argument arriving on the
4767stack. (This may not be at the very start of the allocated stack region
4768if the calling sequence has pushed anything else since pushing the stack
4769arguments. But usually, on such machines, nothing else has been pushed
4770yet, because the function prologue itself does all the pushing.) This
4771region is used on machines where an argument may be passed partly in
4772registers and partly in memory, and, in some cases to support the
4773features in @code{<stdarg.h>}.
4774
4775@item
4776An area of memory used to save certain registers used by the function.
4777The size of this area, which may also include space for such things as
4778the return address and pointers to previous stack frames, is
4779machine-specific and usually depends on which registers have been used
4780in the function. Machines with register windows often do not require
4781a save area.
4782
4783@item
4784A region of at least @var{size} bytes, possibly rounded up to an allocation
4785boundary, to contain the local variables of the function. On some machines,
4786this region and the save area may occur in the opposite order, with the
4787save area closer to the top of the stack.
4788
4789@item
4790@cindex @code{ACCUMULATE_OUTGOING_ARGS} and stack frames
4791Optionally, when @code{ACCUMULATE_OUTGOING_ARGS} is defined, a region of
4792@code{current_function_outgoing_args_size} bytes to be used for outgoing
4793argument lists of the function. @xref{Stack Arguments}.
4794@end itemize
4795
4796@defmac EXIT_IGNORE_STACK
4797Define this macro as a C expression that is nonzero if the return
4798instruction or the function epilogue ignores the value of the stack
4799pointer; in other words, if it is safe to delete an instruction to
4800adjust the stack pointer before a return from the function. The
4801default is 0.
4802
4803Note that this macro's value is relevant only for functions for which
4804frame pointers are maintained. It is never safe to delete a final
4805stack adjustment in a function that has no frame pointer, and the
4806compiler knows this regardless of @code{EXIT_IGNORE_STACK}.
4807@end defmac
4808
4809@defmac EPILOGUE_USES (@var{regno})
4810Define this macro as a C expression that is nonzero for registers that are
4811used by the epilogue or the @samp{return} pattern. The stack and frame
4812pointer registers are already assumed to be used as needed.
4813@end defmac
4814
4815@defmac EH_USES (@var{regno})
4816Define this macro as a C expression that is nonzero for registers that are
4817used by the exception handling mechanism, and so should be considered live
4818on entry to an exception edge.
4819@end defmac
4820
4821@defmac DELAY_SLOTS_FOR_EPILOGUE
4822Define this macro if the function epilogue contains delay slots to which
4823instructions from the rest of the function can be ``moved''. The
4824definition should be a C expression whose value is an integer
4825representing the number of delay slots there.
4826@end defmac
4827
4828@defmac ELIGIBLE_FOR_EPILOGUE_DELAY (@var{insn}, @var{n})
4829A C expression that returns 1 if @var{insn} can be placed in delay
4830slot number @var{n} of the epilogue.
4831
4832The argument @var{n} is an integer which identifies the delay slot now
4833being considered (since different slots may have different rules of
4834eligibility). It is never negative and is always less than the number
4835of epilogue delay slots (what @code{DELAY_SLOTS_FOR_EPILOGUE} returns).
4836If you reject a particular insn for a given delay slot, in principle, it
4837may be reconsidered for a subsequent delay slot. Also, other insns may
4838(at least in principle) be considered for the so far unfilled delay
4839slot.
4840
4841@findex current_function_epilogue_delay_list
4842@findex final_scan_insn
4843The insns accepted to fill the epilogue delay slots are put in an RTL
4844list made with @code{insn_list} objects, stored in the variable
4845@code{current_function_epilogue_delay_list}. The insn for the first
4846delay slot comes first in the list. Your definition of the macro
4847@code{TARGET_ASM_FUNCTION_EPILOGUE} should fill the delay slots by
4848outputting the insns in this list, usually by calling
4849@code{final_scan_insn}.
4850
4851You need not define this macro if you did not define
4852@code{DELAY_SLOTS_FOR_EPILOGUE}.
4853@end defmac
4854
4855@hook TARGET_ASM_OUTPUT_MI_THUNK
4856A function that outputs the assembler code for a thunk
4857function, used to implement C++ virtual function calls with multiple
4858inheritance. The thunk acts as a wrapper around a virtual function,
4859adjusting the implicit object parameter before handing control off to
4860the real function.
4861
4862First, emit code to add the integer @var{delta} to the location that
4863contains the incoming first argument. Assume that this argument
4864contains a pointer, and is the one used to pass the @code{this} pointer
4865in C++. This is the incoming argument @emph{before} the function prologue,
4866e.g.@: @samp{%o0} on a sparc. The addition must preserve the values of
4867all other incoming arguments.
4868
4869Then, if @var{vcall_offset} is nonzero, an additional adjustment should be
4870made after adding @code{delta}. In particular, if @var{p} is the
4871adjusted pointer, the following adjustment should be made:
4872
4873@smallexample
4874p += (*((ptrdiff_t **)p))[vcall_offset/sizeof(ptrdiff_t)]
4875@end smallexample
4876
4877After the additions, emit code to jump to @var{function}, which is a
4878@code{FUNCTION_DECL}. This is a direct pure jump, not a call, and does
4879not touch the return address. Hence returning from @var{FUNCTION} will
4880return to whoever called the current @samp{thunk}.
4881
4882The effect must be as if @var{function} had been called directly with
4883the adjusted first argument. This macro is responsible for emitting all
4884of the code for a thunk function; @code{TARGET_ASM_FUNCTION_PROLOGUE}
4885and @code{TARGET_ASM_FUNCTION_EPILOGUE} are not invoked.
4886
4887The @var{thunk_fndecl} is redundant. (@var{delta} and @var{function}
4888have already been extracted from it.) It might possibly be useful on
4889some targets, but probably not.
4890
4891If you do not define this macro, the target-independent code in the C++
4892front end will generate a less efficient heavyweight thunk that calls
4893@var{function} instead of jumping to it. The generic approach does
4894not support varargs.
4895@end deftypefn
4896
4897@hook TARGET_ASM_CAN_OUTPUT_MI_THUNK
4898A function that returns true if TARGET_ASM_OUTPUT_MI_THUNK would be able
4899to output the assembler code for the thunk function specified by the
4900arguments it is passed, and false otherwise. In the latter case, the
4901generic approach will be used by the C++ front end, with the limitations
4902previously exposed.
4903@end deftypefn
4904
4905@node Profiling
4906@subsection Generating Code for Profiling
4907@cindex profiling, code generation
4908
4909These macros will help you generate code for profiling.
4910
4911@defmac FUNCTION_PROFILER (@var{file}, @var{labelno})
4912A C statement or compound statement to output to @var{file} some
4913assembler code to call the profiling subroutine @code{mcount}.
4914
4915@findex mcount
4916The details of how @code{mcount} expects to be called are determined by
4917your operating system environment, not by GCC@. To figure them out,
4918compile a small program for profiling using the system's installed C
4919compiler and look at the assembler code that results.
4920
4921Older implementations of @code{mcount} expect the address of a counter
4922variable to be loaded into some register. The name of this variable is
4923@samp{LP} followed by the number @var{labelno}, so you would generate
4924the name using @samp{LP%d} in a @code{fprintf}.
4925@end defmac
4926
4927@defmac PROFILE_HOOK
4928A C statement or compound statement to output to @var{file} some assembly
4929code to call the profiling subroutine @code{mcount} even the target does
4930not support profiling.
4931@end defmac
4932
4933@defmac NO_PROFILE_COUNTERS
4934Define this macro to be an expression with a nonzero value if the
4935@code{mcount} subroutine on your system does not need a counter variable
4936allocated for each function. This is true for almost all modern
4937implementations. If you define this macro, you must not use the
4938@var{labelno} argument to @code{FUNCTION_PROFILER}.
4939@end defmac
4940
4941@defmac PROFILE_BEFORE_PROLOGUE
4942Define this macro if the code for function profiling should come before
4943the function prologue. Normally, the profiling code comes after.
4944@end defmac
4945
4946@node Tail Calls
4947@subsection Permitting tail calls
4948@cindex tail calls
4949
4950@hook TARGET_FUNCTION_OK_FOR_SIBCALL
4951True if it is ok to do sibling call optimization for the specified
4952call expression @var{exp}. @var{decl} will be the called function,
4953or @code{NULL} if this is an indirect call.
4954
4955It is not uncommon for limitations of calling conventions to prevent
4956tail calls to functions outside the current unit of translation, or
4957during PIC compilation. The hook is used to enforce these restrictions,
4958as the @code{sibcall} md pattern can not fail, or fall over to a
4959``normal'' call. The criteria for successful sibling call optimization
4960may vary greatly between different architectures.
4961@end deftypefn
4962
4963@hook TARGET_EXTRA_LIVE_ON_ENTRY
4964Add any hard registers to @var{regs} that are live on entry to the
4965function. This hook only needs to be defined to provide registers that
4966cannot be found by examination of FUNCTION_ARG_REGNO_P, the callee saved
4967registers, STATIC_CHAIN_INCOMING_REGNUM, STATIC_CHAIN_REGNUM,
4968TARGET_STRUCT_VALUE_RTX, FRAME_POINTER_REGNUM, EH_USES,
4969FRAME_POINTER_REGNUM, ARG_POINTER_REGNUM, and the PIC_OFFSET_TABLE_REGNUM.
4970@end deftypefn
4971
4972@node Stack Smashing Protection
4973@subsection Stack smashing protection
4974@cindex stack smashing protection
4975
4976@hook TARGET_STACK_PROTECT_GUARD
4977This hook returns a @code{DECL} node for the external variable to use
4978for the stack protection guard. This variable is initialized by the
4979runtime to some random value and is used to initialize the guard value
4980that is placed at the top of the local stack frame. The type of this
4981variable must be @code{ptr_type_node}.
4982
4983The default version of this hook creates a variable called
4984@samp{__stack_chk_guard}, which is normally defined in @file{libgcc2.c}.
4985@end deftypefn
4986
4987@hook TARGET_STACK_PROTECT_FAIL
4988This hook returns a tree expression that alerts the runtime that the
4989stack protect guard variable has been modified. This expression should
4990involve a call to a @code{noreturn} function.
4991
4992The default version of this hook invokes a function called
4993@samp{__stack_chk_fail}, taking no arguments. This function is
4994normally defined in @file{libgcc2.c}.
4995@end deftypefn
4996
7458026b
ILT
4997@hook TARGET_SUPPORTS_SPLIT_STACK
4998
38f8b050
JR
4999@node Varargs
5000@section Implementing the Varargs Macros
5001@cindex varargs implementation
5002
5003GCC comes with an implementation of @code{<varargs.h>} and
5004@code{<stdarg.h>} that work without change on machines that pass arguments
5005on the stack. Other machines require their own implementations of
5006varargs, and the two machine independent header files must have
5007conditionals to include it.
5008
5009ISO @code{<stdarg.h>} differs from traditional @code{<varargs.h>} mainly in
5010the calling convention for @code{va_start}. The traditional
5011implementation takes just one argument, which is the variable in which
5012to store the argument pointer. The ISO implementation of
5013@code{va_start} takes an additional second argument. The user is
5014supposed to write the last named argument of the function here.
5015
5016However, @code{va_start} should not use this argument. The way to find
5017the end of the named arguments is with the built-in functions described
5018below.
5019
5020@defmac __builtin_saveregs ()
5021Use this built-in function to save the argument registers in memory so
5022that the varargs mechanism can access them. Both ISO and traditional
5023versions of @code{va_start} must use @code{__builtin_saveregs}, unless
5024you use @code{TARGET_SETUP_INCOMING_VARARGS} (see below) instead.
5025
5026On some machines, @code{__builtin_saveregs} is open-coded under the
5027control of the target hook @code{TARGET_EXPAND_BUILTIN_SAVEREGS}. On
5028other machines, it calls a routine written in assembler language,
5029found in @file{libgcc2.c}.
5030
5031Code generated for the call to @code{__builtin_saveregs} appears at the
5032beginning of the function, as opposed to where the call to
5033@code{__builtin_saveregs} is written, regardless of what the code is.
5034This is because the registers must be saved before the function starts
5035to use them for its own purposes.
5036@c i rewrote the first sentence above to fix an overfull hbox. --mew
5037@c 10feb93
5038@end defmac
5039
38f8b050 5040@defmac __builtin_next_arg (@var{lastarg})
c59a0a1d 5041This builtin returns the address of the first anonymous stack
38f8b050
JR
5042argument, as type @code{void *}. If @code{ARGS_GROW_DOWNWARD}, it
5043returns the address of the location above the first anonymous stack
5044argument. Use it in @code{va_start} to initialize the pointer for
5045fetching arguments from the stack. Also use it in @code{va_start} to
5046verify that the second parameter @var{lastarg} is the last named argument
5047of the current function.
5048@end defmac
5049
5050@defmac __builtin_classify_type (@var{object})
5051Since each machine has its own conventions for which data types are
5052passed in which kind of register, your implementation of @code{va_arg}
5053has to embody these conventions. The easiest way to categorize the
5054specified data type is to use @code{__builtin_classify_type} together
5055with @code{sizeof} and @code{__alignof__}.
5056
5057@code{__builtin_classify_type} ignores the value of @var{object},
5058considering only its data type. It returns an integer describing what
5059kind of type that is---integer, floating, pointer, structure, and so on.
5060
5061The file @file{typeclass.h} defines an enumeration that you can use to
5062interpret the values of @code{__builtin_classify_type}.
5063@end defmac
5064
5065These machine description macros help implement varargs:
5066
5067@hook TARGET_EXPAND_BUILTIN_SAVEREGS
5068If defined, this hook produces the machine-specific code for a call to
5069@code{__builtin_saveregs}. This code will be moved to the very
5070beginning of the function, before any parameter access are made. The
5071return value of this function should be an RTX that contains the value
5072to use as the return of @code{__builtin_saveregs}.
5073@end deftypefn
5074
5075@hook TARGET_SETUP_INCOMING_VARARGS
5076This target hook offers an alternative to using
5077@code{__builtin_saveregs} and defining the hook
5078@code{TARGET_EXPAND_BUILTIN_SAVEREGS}. Use it to store the anonymous
5079register arguments into the stack so that all the arguments appear to
5080have been passed consecutively on the stack. Once this is done, you can
5081use the standard implementation of varargs that works for machines that
5082pass all their arguments on the stack.
5083
5084The argument @var{args_so_far} points to the @code{CUMULATIVE_ARGS} data
5085structure, containing the values that are obtained after processing the
5086named arguments. The arguments @var{mode} and @var{type} describe the
5087last named argument---its machine mode and its data type as a tree node.
5088
5089The target hook should do two things: first, push onto the stack all the
5090argument registers @emph{not} used for the named arguments, and second,
5091store the size of the data thus pushed into the @code{int}-valued
5092variable pointed to by @var{pretend_args_size}. The value that you
5093store here will serve as additional offset for setting up the stack
5094frame.
5095
5096Because you must generate code to push the anonymous arguments at
5097compile time without knowing their data types,
5098@code{TARGET_SETUP_INCOMING_VARARGS} is only useful on machines that
5099have just a single category of argument register and use it uniformly
5100for all data types.
5101
5102If the argument @var{second_time} is nonzero, it means that the
5103arguments of the function are being analyzed for the second time. This
5104happens for an inline function, which is not actually compiled until the
5105end of the source file. The hook @code{TARGET_SETUP_INCOMING_VARARGS} should
5106not generate any instructions in this case.
5107@end deftypefn
5108
5109@hook TARGET_STRICT_ARGUMENT_NAMING
5110Define this hook to return @code{true} if the location where a function
5111argument is passed depends on whether or not it is a named argument.
5112
5113This hook controls how the @var{named} argument to @code{FUNCTION_ARG}
5114is set for varargs and stdarg functions. If this hook returns
5115@code{true}, the @var{named} argument is always true for named
5116arguments, and false for unnamed arguments. If it returns @code{false},
5117but @code{TARGET_PRETEND_OUTGOING_VARARGS_NAMED} returns @code{true},
5118then all arguments are treated as named. Otherwise, all named arguments
5119except the last are treated as named.
5120
5121You need not define this hook if it always returns @code{false}.
5122@end deftypefn
5123
5124@hook TARGET_PRETEND_OUTGOING_VARARGS_NAMED
5125If you need to conditionally change ABIs so that one works with
5126@code{TARGET_SETUP_INCOMING_VARARGS}, but the other works like neither
5127@code{TARGET_SETUP_INCOMING_VARARGS} nor @code{TARGET_STRICT_ARGUMENT_NAMING} was
5128defined, then define this hook to return @code{true} if
5129@code{TARGET_SETUP_INCOMING_VARARGS} is used, @code{false} otherwise.
5130Otherwise, you should not define this hook.
5131@end deftypefn
5132
5133@node Trampolines
5134@section Trampolines for Nested Functions
5135@cindex trampolines for nested functions
5136@cindex nested functions, trampolines for
5137
5138A @dfn{trampoline} is a small piece of code that is created at run time
5139when the address of a nested function is taken. It normally resides on
5140the stack, in the stack frame of the containing function. These macros
5141tell GCC how to generate code to allocate and initialize a
5142trampoline.
5143
5144The instructions in the trampoline must do two things: load a constant
5145address into the static chain register, and jump to the real address of
5146the nested function. On CISC machines such as the m68k, this requires
5147two instructions, a move immediate and a jump. Then the two addresses
5148exist in the trampoline as word-long immediate operands. On RISC
5149machines, it is often necessary to load each address into a register in
5150two parts. Then pieces of each address form separate immediate
5151operands.
5152
5153The code generated to initialize the trampoline must store the variable
5154parts---the static chain value and the function address---into the
5155immediate operands of the instructions. On a CISC machine, this is
5156simply a matter of copying each address to a memory reference at the
5157proper offset from the start of the trampoline. On a RISC machine, it
5158may be necessary to take out pieces of the address and store them
5159separately.
5160
5161@hook TARGET_ASM_TRAMPOLINE_TEMPLATE
5162This hook is called by @code{assemble_trampoline_template} to output,
5163on the stream @var{f}, assembler code for a block of data that contains
5164the constant parts of a trampoline. This code should not include a
5165label---the label is taken care of automatically.
5166
5167If you do not define this hook, it means no template is needed
5168for the target. Do not define this hook on systems where the block move
5169code to copy the trampoline into place would be larger than the code
5170to generate it on the spot.
5171@end deftypefn
5172
5173@defmac TRAMPOLINE_SECTION
5174Return the section into which the trampoline template is to be placed
5175(@pxref{Sections}). The default value is @code{readonly_data_section}.
5176@end defmac
5177
5178@defmac TRAMPOLINE_SIZE
5179A C expression for the size in bytes of the trampoline, as an integer.
5180@end defmac
5181
5182@defmac TRAMPOLINE_ALIGNMENT
5183Alignment required for trampolines, in bits.
5184
5185If you don't define this macro, the value of @code{FUNCTION_ALIGNMENT}
5186is used for aligning trampolines.
5187@end defmac
5188
5189@hook TARGET_TRAMPOLINE_INIT
5190This hook is called to initialize a trampoline.
5191@var{m_tramp} is an RTX for the memory block for the trampoline; @var{fndecl}
5192is the @code{FUNCTION_DECL} for the nested function; @var{static_chain} is an
5193RTX for the static chain value that should be passed to the function
5194when it is called.
5195
5196If the target defines @code{TARGET_ASM_TRAMPOLINE_TEMPLATE}, then the
5197first thing this hook should do is emit a block move into @var{m_tramp}
5198from the memory block returned by @code{assemble_trampoline_template}.
5199Note that the block move need only cover the constant parts of the
5200trampoline. If the target isolates the variable parts of the trampoline
5201to the end, not all @code{TRAMPOLINE_SIZE} bytes need be copied.
5202
5203If the target requires any other actions, such as flushing caches or
5204enabling stack execution, these actions should be performed after
5205initializing the trampoline proper.
5206@end deftypefn
5207
5208@hook TARGET_TRAMPOLINE_ADJUST_ADDRESS
5209This hook should perform any machine-specific adjustment in
5210the address of the trampoline. Its argument contains the address of the
5211memory block that was passed to @code{TARGET_TRAMPOLINE_INIT}. In case
5212the address to be used for a function call should be different from the
5213address at which the template was stored, the different address should
5214be returned; otherwise @var{addr} should be returned unchanged.
5215If this hook is not defined, @var{addr} will be used for function calls.
5216@end deftypefn
5217
5218Implementing trampolines is difficult on many machines because they have
5219separate instruction and data caches. Writing into a stack location
5220fails to clear the memory in the instruction cache, so when the program
5221jumps to that location, it executes the old contents.
5222
5223Here are two possible solutions. One is to clear the relevant parts of
5224the instruction cache whenever a trampoline is set up. The other is to
5225make all trampolines identical, by having them jump to a standard
5226subroutine. The former technique makes trampoline execution faster; the
5227latter makes initialization faster.
5228
5229To clear the instruction cache when a trampoline is initialized, define
5230the following macro.
5231
5232@defmac CLEAR_INSN_CACHE (@var{beg}, @var{end})
5233If defined, expands to a C expression clearing the @emph{instruction
5234cache} in the specified interval. The definition of this macro would
5235typically be a series of @code{asm} statements. Both @var{beg} and
5236@var{end} are both pointer expressions.
5237@end defmac
5238
5239The operating system may also require the stack to be made executable
5240before calling the trampoline. To implement this requirement, define
5241the following macro.
5242
5243@defmac ENABLE_EXECUTE_STACK
5244Define this macro if certain operations must be performed before executing
5245code located on the stack. The macro should expand to a series of C
5246file-scope constructs (e.g.@: functions) and provide a unique entry point
5247named @code{__enable_execute_stack}. The target is responsible for
5248emitting calls to the entry point in the code, for example from the
5249@code{TARGET_TRAMPOLINE_INIT} hook.
5250@end defmac
5251
5252To use a standard subroutine, define the following macro. In addition,
5253you must make sure that the instructions in a trampoline fill an entire
5254cache line with identical instructions, or else ensure that the
5255beginning of the trampoline code is always aligned at the same point in
5256its cache line. Look in @file{m68k.h} as a guide.
5257
5258@defmac TRANSFER_FROM_TRAMPOLINE
5259Define this macro if trampolines need a special subroutine to do their
5260work. The macro should expand to a series of @code{asm} statements
5261which will be compiled with GCC@. They go in a library function named
5262@code{__transfer_from_trampoline}.
5263
5264If you need to avoid executing the ordinary prologue code of a compiled
5265C function when you jump to the subroutine, you can do so by placing a
5266special label of your own in the assembler code. Use one @code{asm}
5267statement to generate an assembler label, and another to make the label
5268global. Then trampolines can use that label to jump directly to your
5269special assembler code.
5270@end defmac
5271
5272@node Library Calls
5273@section Implicit Calls to Library Routines
5274@cindex library subroutine names
5275@cindex @file{libgcc.a}
5276
5277@c prevent bad page break with this line
5278Here is an explanation of implicit calls to library routines.
5279
5280@defmac DECLARE_LIBRARY_RENAMES
5281This macro, if defined, should expand to a piece of C code that will get
5282expanded when compiling functions for libgcc.a. It can be used to
5283provide alternate names for GCC's internal library functions if there
5284are ABI-mandated names that the compiler should provide.
5285@end defmac
5286
5287@findex set_optab_libfunc
5288@findex init_one_libfunc
5289@hook TARGET_INIT_LIBFUNCS
5290This hook should declare additional library routines or rename
5291existing ones, using the functions @code{set_optab_libfunc} and
5292@code{init_one_libfunc} defined in @file{optabs.c}.
5293@code{init_optabs} calls this macro after initializing all the normal
5294library routines.
5295
5296The default is to do nothing. Most ports don't need to define this hook.
5297@end deftypefn
5298
5299@defmac FLOAT_LIB_COMPARE_RETURNS_BOOL (@var{mode}, @var{comparison})
5300This macro should return @code{true} if the library routine that
5301implements the floating point comparison operator @var{comparison} in
5302mode @var{mode} will return a boolean, and @var{false} if it will
5303return a tristate.
5304
5305GCC's own floating point libraries return tristates from the
5306comparison operators, so the default returns false always. Most ports
5307don't need to define this macro.
5308@end defmac
5309
5310@defmac TARGET_LIB_INT_CMP_BIASED
5311This macro should evaluate to @code{true} if the integer comparison
5312functions (like @code{__cmpdi2}) return 0 to indicate that the first
5313operand is smaller than the second, 1 to indicate that they are equal,
5314and 2 to indicate that the first operand is greater than the second.
5315If this macro evaluates to @code{false} the comparison functions return
5316@minus{}1, 0, and 1 instead of 0, 1, and 2. If the target uses the routines
5317in @file{libgcc.a}, you do not need to define this macro.
5318@end defmac
5319
5320@cindex US Software GOFAST, floating point emulation library
5321@cindex floating point emulation library, US Software GOFAST
5322@cindex GOFAST, floating point emulation library
5323@findex gofast_maybe_init_libfuncs
5324@defmac US_SOFTWARE_GOFAST
5325Define this macro if your system C library uses the US Software GOFAST
5326library to provide floating point emulation.
5327
5328In addition to defining this macro, your architecture must set
5329@code{TARGET_INIT_LIBFUNCS} to @code{gofast_maybe_init_libfuncs}, or
5330else call that function from its version of that hook. It is defined
5331in @file{config/gofast.h}, which must be included by your
5332architecture's @file{@var{cpu}.c} file. See @file{sparc/sparc.c} for
5333an example.
5334
5335If this macro is defined, the
5336@code{TARGET_FLOAT_LIB_COMPARE_RETURNS_BOOL} target hook must return
5337false for @code{SFmode} and @code{DFmode} comparisons.
5338@end defmac
5339
5340@cindex @code{EDOM}, implicit usage
5341@findex matherr
5342@defmac TARGET_EDOM
5343The value of @code{EDOM} on the target machine, as a C integer constant
5344expression. If you don't define this macro, GCC does not attempt to
5345deposit the value of @code{EDOM} into @code{errno} directly. Look in
5346@file{/usr/include/errno.h} to find the value of @code{EDOM} on your
5347system.
5348
5349If you do not define @code{TARGET_EDOM}, then compiled code reports
5350domain errors by calling the library function and letting it report the
5351error. If mathematical functions on your system use @code{matherr} when
5352there is an error, then you should leave @code{TARGET_EDOM} undefined so
5353that @code{matherr} is used normally.
5354@end defmac
5355
5356@cindex @code{errno}, implicit usage
5357@defmac GEN_ERRNO_RTX
5358Define this macro as a C expression to create an rtl expression that
5359refers to the global ``variable'' @code{errno}. (On certain systems,
5360@code{errno} may not actually be a variable.) If you don't define this
5361macro, a reasonable default is used.
5362@end defmac
5363
5364@cindex C99 math functions, implicit usage
5365@defmac TARGET_C99_FUNCTIONS
5366When this macro is nonzero, GCC will implicitly optimize @code{sin} calls into
5367@code{sinf} and similarly for other functions defined by C99 standard. The
5368default is zero because a number of existing systems lack support for these
5369functions in their runtime so this macro needs to be redefined to one on
5370systems that do support the C99 runtime.
5371@end defmac
5372
5373@cindex sincos math function, implicit usage
5374@defmac TARGET_HAS_SINCOS
5375When this macro is nonzero, GCC will implicitly optimize calls to @code{sin}
5376and @code{cos} with the same argument to a call to @code{sincos}. The
5377default is zero. The target has to provide the following functions:
5378@smallexample
5379void sincos(double x, double *sin, double *cos);
5380void sincosf(float x, float *sin, float *cos);
5381void sincosl(long double x, long double *sin, long double *cos);
5382@end smallexample
5383@end defmac
5384
5385@defmac NEXT_OBJC_RUNTIME
5386Define this macro to generate code for Objective-C message sending using
5387the calling convention of the NeXT system. This calling convention
5388involves passing the object, the selector and the method arguments all
5389at once to the method-lookup library function.
5390
5391The default calling convention passes just the object and the selector
5392to the lookup function, which returns a pointer to the method.
5393@end defmac
5394
5395@node Addressing Modes
5396@section Addressing Modes
5397@cindex addressing modes
5398
5399@c prevent bad page break with this line
5400This is about addressing modes.
5401
5402@defmac HAVE_PRE_INCREMENT
5403@defmacx HAVE_PRE_DECREMENT
5404@defmacx HAVE_POST_INCREMENT
5405@defmacx HAVE_POST_DECREMENT
5406A C expression that is nonzero if the machine supports pre-increment,
5407pre-decrement, post-increment, or post-decrement addressing respectively.
5408@end defmac
5409
5410@defmac HAVE_PRE_MODIFY_DISP
5411@defmacx HAVE_POST_MODIFY_DISP
5412A C expression that is nonzero if the machine supports pre- or
5413post-address side-effect generation involving constants other than
5414the size of the memory operand.
5415@end defmac
5416
5417@defmac HAVE_PRE_MODIFY_REG
5418@defmacx HAVE_POST_MODIFY_REG
5419A C expression that is nonzero if the machine supports pre- or
5420post-address side-effect generation involving a register displacement.
5421@end defmac
5422
5423@defmac CONSTANT_ADDRESS_P (@var{x})
5424A C expression that is 1 if the RTX @var{x} is a constant which
5425is a valid address. On most machines the default definition of
5426@code{(CONSTANT_P (@var{x}) && GET_CODE (@var{x}) != CONST_DOUBLE)}
5427is acceptable, but a few machines are more restrictive as to which
5428constant addresses are supported.
5429@end defmac
5430
5431@defmac CONSTANT_P (@var{x})
5432@code{CONSTANT_P}, which is defined by target-independent code,
5433accepts integer-values expressions whose values are not explicitly
5434known, such as @code{symbol_ref}, @code{label_ref}, and @code{high}
5435expressions and @code{const} arithmetic expressions, in addition to
5436@code{const_int} and @code{const_double} expressions.
5437@end defmac
5438
5439@defmac MAX_REGS_PER_ADDRESS
5440A number, the maximum number of registers that can appear in a valid
5441memory address. Note that it is up to you to specify a value equal to
5442the maximum number that @code{TARGET_LEGITIMATE_ADDRESS_P} would ever
5443accept.
5444@end defmac
5445
5446@hook TARGET_LEGITIMATE_ADDRESS_P
5447A function that returns whether @var{x} (an RTX) is a legitimate memory
5448address on the target machine for a memory operand of mode @var{mode}.
5449
5450Legitimate addresses are defined in two variants: a strict variant and a
5451non-strict one. The @var{strict} parameter chooses which variant is
5452desired by the caller.
5453
5454The strict variant is used in the reload pass. It must be defined so
5455that any pseudo-register that has not been allocated a hard register is
5456considered a memory reference. This is because in contexts where some
5457kind of register is required, a pseudo-register with no hard register
5458must be rejected. For non-hard registers, the strict variant should look
5459up the @code{reg_renumber} array; it should then proceed using the hard
5460register number in the array, or treat the pseudo as a memory reference
5461if the array holds @code{-1}.
5462
5463The non-strict variant is used in other passes. It must be defined to
5464accept all pseudo-registers in every context where some kind of
5465register is required.
5466
5467Normally, constant addresses which are the sum of a @code{symbol_ref}
5468and an integer are stored inside a @code{const} RTX to mark them as
5469constant. Therefore, there is no need to recognize such sums
5470specifically as legitimate addresses. Normally you would simply
5471recognize any @code{const} as legitimate.
5472
5473Usually @code{PRINT_OPERAND_ADDRESS} is not prepared to handle constant
5474sums that are not marked with @code{const}. It assumes that a naked
5475@code{plus} indicates indexing. If so, then you @emph{must} reject such
5476naked constant sums as illegitimate addresses, so that none of them will
5477be given to @code{PRINT_OPERAND_ADDRESS}.
5478
5479@cindex @code{TARGET_ENCODE_SECTION_INFO} and address validation
5480On some machines, whether a symbolic address is legitimate depends on
5481the section that the address refers to. On these machines, define the
5482target hook @code{TARGET_ENCODE_SECTION_INFO} to store the information
5483into the @code{symbol_ref}, and then check for it here. When you see a
5484@code{const}, you will have to look inside it to find the
5485@code{symbol_ref} in order to determine the section. @xref{Assembler
5486Format}.
5487
5488@cindex @code{GO_IF_LEGITIMATE_ADDRESS}
5489Some ports are still using a deprecated legacy substitute for
5490this hook, the @code{GO_IF_LEGITIMATE_ADDRESS} macro. This macro
5491has this syntax:
5492
5493@example
5494#define GO_IF_LEGITIMATE_ADDRESS (@var{mode}, @var{x}, @var{label})
5495@end example
5496
5497@noindent
5498and should @code{goto @var{label}} if the address @var{x} is a valid
5499address on the target machine for a memory operand of mode @var{mode}.
5500Whether the strict or non-strict variants are desired is defined by
5501the @code{REG_OK_STRICT} macro introduced earlier in this section.
5502Using the hook is usually simpler because it limits the number of
5503files that are recompiled when changes are made.
5504@end deftypefn
5505
5506@defmac TARGET_MEM_CONSTRAINT
5507A single character to be used instead of the default @code{'m'}
5508character for general memory addresses. This defines the constraint
5509letter which matches the memory addresses accepted by
5510@code{TARGET_LEGITIMATE_ADDRESS_P}. Define this macro if you want to
5511support new address formats in your back end without changing the
5512semantics of the @code{'m'} constraint. This is necessary in order to
5513preserve functionality of inline assembly constructs using the
5514@code{'m'} constraint.
5515@end defmac
5516
5517@defmac FIND_BASE_TERM (@var{x})
5518A C expression to determine the base term of address @var{x},
5519or to provide a simplified version of @var{x} from which @file{alias.c}
5520can easily find the base term. This macro is used in only two places:
5521@code{find_base_value} and @code{find_base_term} in @file{alias.c}.
5522
5523It is always safe for this macro to not be defined. It exists so
5524that alias analysis can understand machine-dependent addresses.
5525
5526The typical use of this macro is to handle addresses containing
5527a label_ref or symbol_ref within an UNSPEC@.
5528@end defmac
5529
5530@hook TARGET_LEGITIMIZE_ADDRESS
5531This hook is given an invalid memory address @var{x} for an
5532operand of mode @var{mode} and should try to return a valid memory
5533address.
5534
5535@findex break_out_memory_refs
5536@var{x} will always be the result of a call to @code{break_out_memory_refs},
5537and @var{oldx} will be the operand that was given to that function to produce
5538@var{x}.
5539
5540The code of the hook should not alter the substructure of
5541@var{x}. If it transforms @var{x} into a more legitimate form, it
5542should return the new @var{x}.
5543
5544It is not necessary for this hook to come up with a legitimate address.
5545The compiler has standard ways of doing so in all cases. In fact, it
5546is safe to omit this hook or make it return @var{x} if it cannot find
5547a valid way to legitimize the address. But often a machine-dependent
5548strategy can generate better code.
5549@end deftypefn
5550
5551@defmac LEGITIMIZE_RELOAD_ADDRESS (@var{x}, @var{mode}, @var{opnum}, @var{type}, @var{ind_levels}, @var{win})
5552A C compound statement that attempts to replace @var{x}, which is an address
5553that needs reloading, with a valid memory address for an operand of mode
5554@var{mode}. @var{win} will be a C statement label elsewhere in the code.
5555It is not necessary to define this macro, but it might be useful for
5556performance reasons.
5557
5558For example, on the i386, it is sometimes possible to use a single
5559reload register instead of two by reloading a sum of two pseudo
5560registers into a register. On the other hand, for number of RISC
5561processors offsets are limited so that often an intermediate address
5562needs to be generated in order to address a stack slot. By defining
5563@code{LEGITIMIZE_RELOAD_ADDRESS} appropriately, the intermediate addresses
5564generated for adjacent some stack slots can be made identical, and thus
5565be shared.
5566
5567@emph{Note}: This macro should be used with caution. It is necessary
5568to know something of how reload works in order to effectively use this,
5569and it is quite easy to produce macros that build in too much knowledge
5570of reload internals.
5571
5572@emph{Note}: This macro must be able to reload an address created by a
5573previous invocation of this macro. If it fails to handle such addresses
5574then the compiler may generate incorrect code or abort.
5575
5576@findex push_reload
5577The macro definition should use @code{push_reload} to indicate parts that
5578need reloading; @var{opnum}, @var{type} and @var{ind_levels} are usually
5579suitable to be passed unaltered to @code{push_reload}.
5580
5581The code generated by this macro must not alter the substructure of
5582@var{x}. If it transforms @var{x} into a more legitimate form, it
5583should assign @var{x} (which will always be a C variable) a new value.
5584This also applies to parts that you change indirectly by calling
5585@code{push_reload}.
5586
5587@findex strict_memory_address_p
5588The macro definition may use @code{strict_memory_address_p} to test if
5589the address has become legitimate.
5590
5591@findex copy_rtx
5592If you want to change only a part of @var{x}, one standard way of doing
5593this is to use @code{copy_rtx}. Note, however, that it unshares only a
5594single level of rtl. Thus, if the part to be changed is not at the
5595top level, you'll need to replace first the top level.
5596It is not necessary for this macro to come up with a legitimate
5597address; but often a machine-dependent strategy can generate better code.
5598@end defmac
5599
5600@hook TARGET_MODE_DEPENDENT_ADDRESS_P
5601This hook returns @code{true} if memory address @var{addr} can have
5602different meanings depending on the machine mode of the memory
5603reference it is used for or if the address is valid for some modes
5604but not others.
5605
5606Autoincrement and autodecrement addresses typically have mode-dependent
5607effects because the amount of the increment or decrement is the size
5608of the operand being addressed. Some machines have other mode-dependent
5609addresses. Many RISC machines have no mode-dependent addresses.
5610
5611You may assume that @var{addr} is a valid address for the machine.
5612
5613The default version of this hook returns @code{false}.
5614@end deftypefn
5615
5616@defmac GO_IF_MODE_DEPENDENT_ADDRESS (@var{addr}, @var{label})
5617A C statement or compound statement with a conditional @code{goto
5618@var{label};} executed if memory address @var{x} (an RTX) can have
5619different meanings depending on the machine mode of the memory
5620reference it is used for or if the address is valid for some modes
5621but not others.
5622
5623Autoincrement and autodecrement addresses typically have mode-dependent
5624effects because the amount of the increment or decrement is the size
5625of the operand being addressed. Some machines have other mode-dependent
5626addresses. Many RISC machines have no mode-dependent addresses.
5627
5628You may assume that @var{addr} is a valid address for the machine.
5629
5630These are obsolete macros, replaced by the
5631@code{TARGET_MODE_DEPENDENT_ADDRESS_P} target hook.
5632@end defmac
5633
5634@defmac LEGITIMATE_CONSTANT_P (@var{x})
5635A C expression that is nonzero if @var{x} is a legitimate constant for
5636an immediate operand on the target machine. You can assume that
5637@var{x} satisfies @code{CONSTANT_P}, so you need not check this. In fact,
5638@samp{1} is a suitable definition for this macro on machines where
5639anything @code{CONSTANT_P} is valid.
5640@end defmac
5641
5642@hook TARGET_DELEGITIMIZE_ADDRESS
5643This hook is used to undo the possibly obfuscating effects of the
5644@code{LEGITIMIZE_ADDRESS} and @code{LEGITIMIZE_RELOAD_ADDRESS} target
5645macros. Some backend implementations of these macros wrap symbol
5646references inside an @code{UNSPEC} rtx to represent PIC or similar
5647addressing modes. This target hook allows GCC's optimizers to understand
5648the semantics of these opaque @code{UNSPEC}s by converting them back
5649into their original form.
5650@end deftypefn
5651
5652@hook TARGET_CANNOT_FORCE_CONST_MEM
5653This hook should return true if @var{x} is of a form that cannot (or
5654should not) be spilled to the constant pool. The default version of
5655this hook returns false.
5656
5657The primary reason to define this hook is to prevent reload from
5658deciding that a non-legitimate constant would be better reloaded
5659from the constant pool instead of spilling and reloading a register
5660holding the constant. This restriction is often true of addresses
5661of TLS symbols for various targets.
5662@end deftypefn
5663
5664@hook TARGET_USE_BLOCKS_FOR_CONSTANT_P
5665This hook should return true if pool entries for constant @var{x} can
5666be placed in an @code{object_block} structure. @var{mode} is the mode
5667of @var{x}.
5668
5669The default version returns false for all constants.
5670@end deftypefn
5671
89356d17 5672@hook TARGET_BUILTIN_RECIPROCAL
38f8b050
JR
5673This hook should return the DECL of a function that implements reciprocal of
5674the builtin function with builtin function code @var{fn}, or
5675@code{NULL_TREE} if such a function is not available. @var{md_fn} is true
5676when @var{fn} is a code of a machine-dependent builtin function. When
5677@var{sqrt} is true, additional optimizations that apply only to the reciprocal
5678of a square root function are performed, and only reciprocals of @code{sqrt}
5679function are valid.
5680@end deftypefn
5681
5682@hook TARGET_VECTORIZE_BUILTIN_MASK_FOR_LOAD
5683This hook should return the DECL of a function @var{f} that given an
5684address @var{addr} as an argument returns a mask @var{m} that can be
5685used to extract from two vectors the relevant data that resides in
5686@var{addr} in case @var{addr} is not properly aligned.
5687
5688The autovectorizer, when vectorizing a load operation from an address
5689@var{addr} that may be unaligned, will generate two vector loads from
5690the two aligned addresses around @var{addr}. It then generates a
5691@code{REALIGN_LOAD} operation to extract the relevant data from the
5692two loaded vectors. The first two arguments to @code{REALIGN_LOAD},
5693@var{v1} and @var{v2}, are the two vectors, each of size @var{VS}, and
5694the third argument, @var{OFF}, defines how the data will be extracted
5695from these two vectors: if @var{OFF} is 0, then the returned vector is
5696@var{v2}; otherwise, the returned vector is composed from the last
5697@var{VS}-@var{OFF} elements of @var{v1} concatenated to the first
5698@var{OFF} elements of @var{v2}.
5699
5700If this hook is defined, the autovectorizer will generate a call
5701to @var{f} (using the DECL tree that this hook returns) and will
5702use the return value of @var{f} as the argument @var{OFF} to
5703@code{REALIGN_LOAD}. Therefore, the mask @var{m} returned by @var{f}
5704should comply with the semantics expected by @code{REALIGN_LOAD}
5705described above.
5706If this hook is not defined, then @var{addr} will be used as
5707the argument @var{OFF} to @code{REALIGN_LOAD}, in which case the low
5708log2(@var{VS}) @minus{} 1 bits of @var{addr} will be considered.
5709@end deftypefn
5710
5711@hook TARGET_VECTORIZE_BUILTIN_MUL_WIDEN_EVEN
5712This hook should return the DECL of a function @var{f} that implements
5713widening multiplication of the even elements of two input vectors of type @var{x}.
5714
5715If this hook is defined, the autovectorizer will use it along with the
5716@code{TARGET_VECTORIZE_BUILTIN_MUL_WIDEN_ODD} target hook when vectorizing
5717widening multiplication in cases that the order of the results does not have to be
5718preserved (e.g.@: used only by a reduction computation). Otherwise, the
5719@code{widen_mult_hi/lo} idioms will be used.
5720@end deftypefn
5721
5722@hook TARGET_VECTORIZE_BUILTIN_MUL_WIDEN_ODD
5723This hook should return the DECL of a function @var{f} that implements
5724widening multiplication of the odd elements of two input vectors of type @var{x}.
5725
5726If this hook is defined, the autovectorizer will use it along with the
5727@code{TARGET_VECTORIZE_BUILTIN_MUL_WIDEN_EVEN} target hook when vectorizing
5728widening multiplication in cases that the order of the results does not have to be
5729preserved (e.g.@: used only by a reduction computation). Otherwise, the
5730@code{widen_mult_hi/lo} idioms will be used.
5731@end deftypefn
5732
5733@hook TARGET_VECTORIZE_BUILTIN_VECTORIZATION_COST
5734Returns cost of different scalar or vector statements for vectorization cost model.
720f5239
IR
5735For vector memory operations the cost may depend on type (@var{vectype}) and
5736misalignment value (@var{misalign}).
38f8b050
JR
5737@end deftypefn
5738
5739@hook TARGET_VECTORIZE_VECTOR_ALIGNMENT_REACHABLE
5740Return true if vector alignment is reachable (by peeling N iterations) for the given type.
5741@end deftypefn
5742
5743@hook TARGET_VECTORIZE_BUILTIN_VEC_PERM
5744Target builtin that implements vector permute.
5745@end deftypefn
5746
5747@hook TARGET_VECTORIZE_BUILTIN_VEC_PERM_OK
5748Return true if a vector created for @code{builtin_vec_perm} is valid.
5749@end deftypefn
5750
5751@hook TARGET_VECTORIZE_BUILTIN_CONVERSION
5752This hook should return the DECL of a function that implements conversion of the
5753input vector of type @var{src_type} to type @var{dest_type}.
5754The value of @var{code} is one of the enumerators in @code{enum tree_code} and
5755specifies how the conversion is to be applied
5756(truncation, rounding, etc.).
5757
5758If this hook is defined, the autovectorizer will use the
5759@code{TARGET_VECTORIZE_BUILTIN_CONVERSION} target hook when vectorizing
5760conversion. Otherwise, it will return @code{NULL_TREE}.
5761@end deftypefn
5762
5763@hook TARGET_VECTORIZE_BUILTIN_VECTORIZED_FUNCTION
5764This hook should return the decl of a function that implements the
5765vectorized variant of the builtin function with builtin function code
5766@var{code} or @code{NULL_TREE} if such a function is not available.
5767The value of @var{fndecl} is the builtin function declaration. The
5768return type of the vectorized function shall be of vector type
5769@var{vec_type_out} and the argument types should be @var{vec_type_in}.
5770@end deftypefn
5771
5772@hook TARGET_VECTORIZE_SUPPORT_VECTOR_MISALIGNMENT
5773This hook should return true if the target supports misaligned vector
5774store/load of a specific factor denoted in the @var{misalignment}
5775parameter. The vector store/load should be of machine mode @var{mode} and
5776the elements in the vectors should be of type @var{type}. @var{is_packed}
5777parameter is true if the memory access is defined in a packed struct.
5778@end deftypefn
5779
cc4b5170
RG
5780@hook TARGET_VECTORIZE_PREFERRED_SIMD_MODE
5781This hook should return the preferred mode for vectorizing scalar
5782mode @var{mode}. The default is
5783equal to @code{word_mode}, because the vectorizer can do some
26983c22
L
5784transformations even in absence of specialized @acronym{SIMD} hardware.
5785@end deftypefn
5786
767f865f
RG
5787@hook TARGET_VECTORIZE_AUTOVECTORIZE_VECTOR_SIZES
5788This hook should return a mask of sizes that should be iterated over
5789after trying to autovectorize using the vector size derived from the
5790mode returned by @code{TARGET_VECTORIZE_PREFERRED_SIMD_MODE}.
5791The default is zero which means to not iterate over other vector sizes.
5792@end deftypefn
5793
38f8b050
JR
5794@node Anchored Addresses
5795@section Anchored Addresses
5796@cindex anchored addresses
5797@cindex @option{-fsection-anchors}
5798
5799GCC usually addresses every static object as a separate entity.
5800For example, if we have:
5801
5802@smallexample
5803static int a, b, c;
5804int foo (void) @{ return a + b + c; @}
5805@end smallexample
5806
5807the code for @code{foo} will usually calculate three separate symbolic
5808addresses: those of @code{a}, @code{b} and @code{c}. On some targets,
5809it would be better to calculate just one symbolic address and access
5810the three variables relative to it. The equivalent pseudocode would
5811be something like:
5812
5813@smallexample
5814int foo (void)
5815@{
5816 register int *xr = &x;
5817 return xr[&a - &x] + xr[&b - &x] + xr[&c - &x];
5818@}
5819@end smallexample
5820
5821(which isn't valid C). We refer to shared addresses like @code{x} as
5822``section anchors''. Their use is controlled by @option{-fsection-anchors}.
5823
5824The hooks below describe the target properties that GCC needs to know
5825in order to make effective use of section anchors. It won't use
5826section anchors at all unless either @code{TARGET_MIN_ANCHOR_OFFSET}
5827or @code{TARGET_MAX_ANCHOR_OFFSET} is set to a nonzero value.
5828
5829@hook TARGET_MIN_ANCHOR_OFFSET
5830The minimum offset that should be applied to a section anchor.
5831On most targets, it should be the smallest offset that can be
5832applied to a base register while still giving a legitimate address
5833for every mode. The default value is 0.
5834@end deftypevr
5835
5836@hook TARGET_MAX_ANCHOR_OFFSET
5837Like @code{TARGET_MIN_ANCHOR_OFFSET}, but the maximum (inclusive)
5838offset that should be applied to section anchors. The default
5839value is 0.
5840@end deftypevr
5841
5842@hook TARGET_ASM_OUTPUT_ANCHOR
5843Write the assembly code to define section anchor @var{x}, which is a
5844@code{SYMBOL_REF} for which @samp{SYMBOL_REF_ANCHOR_P (@var{x})} is true.
5845The hook is called with the assembly output position set to the beginning
5846of @code{SYMBOL_REF_BLOCK (@var{x})}.
5847
5848If @code{ASM_OUTPUT_DEF} is available, the hook's default definition uses
5849it to define the symbol as @samp{. + SYMBOL_REF_BLOCK_OFFSET (@var{x})}.
5850If @code{ASM_OUTPUT_DEF} is not available, the hook's default definition
5851is @code{NULL}, which disables the use of section anchors altogether.
5852@end deftypefn
5853
5854@hook TARGET_USE_ANCHORS_FOR_SYMBOL_P
5855Return true if GCC should attempt to use anchors to access @code{SYMBOL_REF}
5856@var{x}. You can assume @samp{SYMBOL_REF_HAS_BLOCK_INFO_P (@var{x})} and
5857@samp{!SYMBOL_REF_ANCHOR_P (@var{x})}.
5858
5859The default version is correct for most targets, but you might need to
5860intercept this hook to handle things like target-specific attributes
5861or target-specific sections.
5862@end deftypefn
5863
5864@node Condition Code
5865@section Condition Code Status
5866@cindex condition code status
5867
5868The macros in this section can be split in two families, according to the
5869two ways of representing condition codes in GCC.
5870
5871The first representation is the so called @code{(cc0)} representation
5872(@pxref{Jump Patterns}), where all instructions can have an implicit
5873clobber of the condition codes. The second is the condition code
5874register representation, which provides better schedulability for
5875architectures that do have a condition code register, but on which
5876most instructions do not affect it. The latter category includes
5877most RISC machines.
5878
5879The implicit clobbering poses a strong restriction on the placement of
5880the definition and use of the condition code, which need to be in adjacent
5881insns for machines using @code{(cc0)}. This can prevent important
5882optimizations on some machines. For example, on the IBM RS/6000, there
5883is a delay for taken branches unless the condition code register is set
5884three instructions earlier than the conditional branch. The instruction
5885scheduler cannot perform this optimization if it is not permitted to
5886separate the definition and use of the condition code register.
5887
5888For this reason, it is possible and suggested to use a register to
5889represent the condition code for new ports. If there is a specific
5890condition code register in the machine, use a hard register. If the
5891condition code or comparison result can be placed in any general register,
5892or if there are multiple condition registers, use a pseudo register.
5893Registers used to store the condition code value will usually have a mode
5894that is in class @code{MODE_CC}.
5895
5896Alternatively, you can use @code{BImode} if the comparison operator is
5897specified already in the compare instruction. In this case, you are not
5898interested in most macros in this section.
5899
5900@menu
5901* CC0 Condition Codes:: Old style representation of condition codes.
5902* MODE_CC Condition Codes:: Modern representation of condition codes.
5903* Cond. Exec. Macros:: Macros to control conditional execution.
5904@end menu
5905
5906@node CC0 Condition Codes
5907@subsection Representation of condition codes using @code{(cc0)}
5908@findex cc0
5909
5910@findex cc_status
5911The file @file{conditions.h} defines a variable @code{cc_status} to
5912describe how the condition code was computed (in case the interpretation of
5913the condition code depends on the instruction that it was set by). This
5914variable contains the RTL expressions on which the condition code is
5915currently based, and several standard flags.
5916
5917Sometimes additional machine-specific flags must be defined in the machine
5918description header file. It can also add additional machine-specific
5919information by defining @code{CC_STATUS_MDEP}.
5920
5921@defmac CC_STATUS_MDEP
5922C code for a data type which is used for declaring the @code{mdep}
5923component of @code{cc_status}. It defaults to @code{int}.
5924
5925This macro is not used on machines that do not use @code{cc0}.
5926@end defmac
5927
5928@defmac CC_STATUS_MDEP_INIT
5929A C expression to initialize the @code{mdep} field to ``empty''.
5930The default definition does nothing, since most machines don't use
5931the field anyway. If you want to use the field, you should probably
5932define this macro to initialize it.
5933
5934This macro is not used on machines that do not use @code{cc0}.
5935@end defmac
5936
5937@defmac NOTICE_UPDATE_CC (@var{exp}, @var{insn})
5938A C compound statement to set the components of @code{cc_status}
5939appropriately for an insn @var{insn} whose body is @var{exp}. It is
5940this macro's responsibility to recognize insns that set the condition
5941code as a byproduct of other activity as well as those that explicitly
5942set @code{(cc0)}.
5943
5944This macro is not used on machines that do not use @code{cc0}.
5945
5946If there are insns that do not set the condition code but do alter
5947other machine registers, this macro must check to see whether they
5948invalidate the expressions that the condition code is recorded as
5949reflecting. For example, on the 68000, insns that store in address
5950registers do not set the condition code, which means that usually
5951@code{NOTICE_UPDATE_CC} can leave @code{cc_status} unaltered for such
5952insns. But suppose that the previous insn set the condition code
5953based on location @samp{a4@@(102)} and the current insn stores a new
5954value in @samp{a4}. Although the condition code is not changed by
5955this, it will no longer be true that it reflects the contents of
5956@samp{a4@@(102)}. Therefore, @code{NOTICE_UPDATE_CC} must alter
5957@code{cc_status} in this case to say that nothing is known about the
5958condition code value.
5959
5960The definition of @code{NOTICE_UPDATE_CC} must be prepared to deal
5961with the results of peephole optimization: insns whose patterns are
5962@code{parallel} RTXs containing various @code{reg}, @code{mem} or
5963constants which are just the operands. The RTL structure of these
5964insns is not sufficient to indicate what the insns actually do. What
5965@code{NOTICE_UPDATE_CC} should do when it sees one is just to run
5966@code{CC_STATUS_INIT}.
5967
5968A possible definition of @code{NOTICE_UPDATE_CC} is to call a function
5969that looks at an attribute (@pxref{Insn Attributes}) named, for example,
5970@samp{cc}. This avoids having detailed information about patterns in
5971two places, the @file{md} file and in @code{NOTICE_UPDATE_CC}.
5972@end defmac
5973
5974@node MODE_CC Condition Codes
5975@subsection Representation of condition codes using registers
5976@findex CCmode
5977@findex MODE_CC
5978
5979@defmac SELECT_CC_MODE (@var{op}, @var{x}, @var{y})
5980On many machines, the condition code may be produced by other instructions
5981than compares, for example the branch can use directly the condition
5982code set by a subtract instruction. However, on some machines
5983when the condition code is set this way some bits (such as the overflow
5984bit) are not set in the same way as a test instruction, so that a different
5985branch instruction must be used for some conditional branches. When
5986this happens, use the machine mode of the condition code register to
5987record different formats of the condition code register. Modes can
5988also be used to record which compare instruction (e.g. a signed or an
5989unsigned comparison) produced the condition codes.
5990
5991If other modes than @code{CCmode} are required, add them to
5992@file{@var{machine}-modes.def} and define @code{SELECT_CC_MODE} to choose
5993a mode given an operand of a compare. This is needed because the modes
5994have to be chosen not only during RTL generation but also, for example,
5995by instruction combination. The result of @code{SELECT_CC_MODE} should
5996be consistent with the mode used in the patterns; for example to support
5997the case of the add on the SPARC discussed above, we have the pattern
5998
5999@smallexample
6000(define_insn ""
6001 [(set (reg:CC_NOOV 0)
6002 (compare:CC_NOOV
6003 (plus:SI (match_operand:SI 0 "register_operand" "%r")
6004 (match_operand:SI 1 "arith_operand" "rI"))
6005 (const_int 0)))]
6006 ""
6007 "@dots{}")
6008@end smallexample
6009
6010@noindent
6011together with a @code{SELECT_CC_MODE} that returns @code{CC_NOOVmode}
6012for comparisons whose argument is a @code{plus}:
6013
6014@smallexample
6015#define SELECT_CC_MODE(OP,X,Y) \
6016 (GET_MODE_CLASS (GET_MODE (X)) == MODE_FLOAT \
6017 ? ((OP == EQ || OP == NE) ? CCFPmode : CCFPEmode) \
6018 : ((GET_CODE (X) == PLUS || GET_CODE (X) == MINUS \
6019 || GET_CODE (X) == NEG) \
6020 ? CC_NOOVmode : CCmode))
6021@end smallexample
6022
6023Another reason to use modes is to retain information on which operands
6024were used by the comparison; see @code{REVERSIBLE_CC_MODE} later in
6025this section.
6026
6027You should define this macro if and only if you define extra CC modes
6028in @file{@var{machine}-modes.def}.
6029@end defmac
6030
6031@defmac CANONICALIZE_COMPARISON (@var{code}, @var{op0}, @var{op1})
6032On some machines not all possible comparisons are defined, but you can
6033convert an invalid comparison into a valid one. For example, the Alpha
6034does not have a @code{GT} comparison, but you can use an @code{LT}
6035comparison instead and swap the order of the operands.
6036
6037On such machines, define this macro to be a C statement to do any
6038required conversions. @var{code} is the initial comparison code
6039and @var{op0} and @var{op1} are the left and right operands of the
6040comparison, respectively. You should modify @var{code}, @var{op0}, and
6041@var{op1} as required.
6042
6043GCC will not assume that the comparison resulting from this macro is
6044valid but will see if the resulting insn matches a pattern in the
6045@file{md} file.
6046
6047You need not define this macro if it would never change the comparison
6048code or operands.
6049@end defmac
6050
6051@defmac REVERSIBLE_CC_MODE (@var{mode})
6052A C expression whose value is one if it is always safe to reverse a
6053comparison whose mode is @var{mode}. If @code{SELECT_CC_MODE}
6054can ever return @var{mode} for a floating-point inequality comparison,
6055then @code{REVERSIBLE_CC_MODE (@var{mode})} must be zero.
6056
6057You need not define this macro if it would always returns zero or if the
6058floating-point format is anything other than @code{IEEE_FLOAT_FORMAT}.
6059For example, here is the definition used on the SPARC, where floating-point
6060inequality comparisons are always given @code{CCFPEmode}:
6061
6062@smallexample
6063#define REVERSIBLE_CC_MODE(MODE) ((MODE) != CCFPEmode)
6064@end smallexample
6065@end defmac
6066
6067@defmac REVERSE_CONDITION (@var{code}, @var{mode})
6068A C expression whose value is reversed condition code of the @var{code} for
6069comparison done in CC_MODE @var{mode}. The macro is used only in case
6070@code{REVERSIBLE_CC_MODE (@var{mode})} is nonzero. Define this macro in case
6071machine has some non-standard way how to reverse certain conditionals. For
6072instance in case all floating point conditions are non-trapping, compiler may
6073freely convert unordered compares to ordered one. Then definition may look
6074like:
6075
6076@smallexample
6077#define REVERSE_CONDITION(CODE, MODE) \
6078 ((MODE) != CCFPmode ? reverse_condition (CODE) \
6079 : reverse_condition_maybe_unordered (CODE))
6080@end smallexample
6081@end defmac
6082
6083@hook TARGET_FIXED_CONDITION_CODE_REGS
6084On targets which do not use @code{(cc0)}, and which use a hard
6085register rather than a pseudo-register to hold condition codes, the
6086regular CSE passes are often not able to identify cases in which the
6087hard register is set to a common value. Use this hook to enable a
6088small pass which optimizes such cases. This hook should return true
6089to enable this pass, and it should set the integers to which its
6090arguments point to the hard register numbers used for condition codes.
6091When there is only one such register, as is true on most systems, the
6092integer pointed to by @var{p2} should be set to
6093@code{INVALID_REGNUM}.
6094
6095The default version of this hook returns false.
6096@end deftypefn
6097
6098@hook TARGET_CC_MODES_COMPATIBLE
6099On targets which use multiple condition code modes in class
6100@code{MODE_CC}, it is sometimes the case that a comparison can be
6101validly done in more than one mode. On such a system, define this
6102target hook to take two mode arguments and to return a mode in which
6103both comparisons may be validly done. If there is no such mode,
6104return @code{VOIDmode}.
6105
6106The default version of this hook checks whether the modes are the
6107same. If they are, it returns that mode. If they are different, it
6108returns @code{VOIDmode}.
6109@end deftypefn
6110
6111@node Cond. Exec. Macros
6112@subsection Macros to control conditional execution
6113@findex conditional execution
6114@findex predication
6115
6116There is one macro that may need to be defined for targets
6117supporting conditional execution, independent of how they
6118represent conditional branches.
6119
6120@defmac REVERSE_CONDEXEC_PREDICATES_P (@var{op1}, @var{op2})
6121A C expression that returns true if the conditional execution predicate
6122@var{op1}, a comparison operation, is the inverse of @var{op2} and vice
6123versa. Define this to return 0 if the target has conditional execution
6124predicates that cannot be reversed safely. There is no need to validate
6125that the arguments of op1 and op2 are the same, this is done separately.
6126If no expansion is specified, this macro is defined as follows:
6127
6128@smallexample
6129#define REVERSE_CONDEXEC_PREDICATES_P (x, y) \
6130 (GET_CODE ((x)) == reversed_comparison_code ((y), NULL))
6131@end smallexample
6132@end defmac
6133
6134@node Costs
6135@section Describing Relative Costs of Operations
6136@cindex costs of instructions
6137@cindex relative costs
6138@cindex speed of instructions
6139
6140These macros let you describe the relative speed of various operations
6141on the target machine.
6142
6143@defmac REGISTER_MOVE_COST (@var{mode}, @var{from}, @var{to})
6144A C expression for the cost of moving data of mode @var{mode} from a
6145register in class @var{from} to one in class @var{to}. The classes are
6146expressed using the enumeration values such as @code{GENERAL_REGS}. A
6147value of 2 is the default; other values are interpreted relative to
6148that.
6149
6150It is not required that the cost always equal 2 when @var{from} is the
6151same as @var{to}; on some machines it is expensive to move between
6152registers if they are not general registers.
6153
6154If reload sees an insn consisting of a single @code{set} between two
6155hard registers, and if @code{REGISTER_MOVE_COST} applied to their
6156classes returns a value of 2, reload does not check to ensure that the
6157constraints of the insn are met. Setting a cost of other than 2 will
6158allow reload to verify that the constraints are met. You should do this
6159if the @samp{mov@var{m}} pattern's constraints do not allow such copying.
6160
6161These macros are obsolete, new ports should use the target hook
6162@code{TARGET_REGISTER_MOVE_COST} instead.
6163@end defmac
6164
6165@hook TARGET_REGISTER_MOVE_COST
6166This target hook should return the cost of moving data of mode @var{mode}
6167from a register in class @var{from} to one in class @var{to}. The classes
6168are expressed using the enumeration values such as @code{GENERAL_REGS}.
6169A value of 2 is the default; other values are interpreted relative to
6170that.
6171
6172It is not required that the cost always equal 2 when @var{from} is the
6173same as @var{to}; on some machines it is expensive to move between
6174registers if they are not general registers.
6175
6176If reload sees an insn consisting of a single @code{set} between two
6177hard registers, and if @code{TARGET_REGISTER_MOVE_COST} applied to their
6178classes returns a value of 2, reload does not check to ensure that the
6179constraints of the insn are met. Setting a cost of other than 2 will
6180allow reload to verify that the constraints are met. You should do this
6181if the @samp{mov@var{m}} pattern's constraints do not allow such copying.
6182
6183The default version of this function returns 2.
6184@end deftypefn
6185
6186@defmac MEMORY_MOVE_COST (@var{mode}, @var{class}, @var{in})
6187A C expression for the cost of moving data of mode @var{mode} between a
6188register of class @var{class} and memory; @var{in} is zero if the value
6189is to be written to memory, nonzero if it is to be read in. This cost
6190is relative to those in @code{REGISTER_MOVE_COST}. If moving between
6191registers and memory is more expensive than between two registers, you
6192should define this macro to express the relative cost.
6193
6194If you do not define this macro, GCC uses a default cost of 4 plus
6195the cost of copying via a secondary reload register, if one is
6196needed. If your machine requires a secondary reload register to copy
6197between memory and a register of @var{class} but the reload mechanism is
6198more complex than copying via an intermediate, define this macro to
6199reflect the actual cost of the move.
6200
6201GCC defines the function @code{memory_move_secondary_cost} if
6202secondary reloads are needed. It computes the costs due to copying via
6203a secondary register. If your machine copies from memory using a
6204secondary register in the conventional way but the default base value of
62054 is not correct for your machine, define this macro to add some other
6206value to the result of that function. The arguments to that function
6207are the same as to this macro.
6208
6209These macros are obsolete, new ports should use the target hook
6210@code{TARGET_MEMORY_MOVE_COST} instead.
6211@end defmac
6212
911852ff 6213@hook TARGET_MEMORY_MOVE_COST
38f8b050 6214This target hook should return the cost of moving data of mode @var{mode}
911852ff 6215between a register of class @var{rclass} and memory; @var{in} is @code{false}
38f8b050
JR
6216if the value is to be written to memory, @code{true} if it is to be read in.
6217This cost is relative to those in @code{TARGET_REGISTER_MOVE_COST}.
6218If moving between registers and memory is more expensive than between two
6219registers, you should add this target hook to express the relative cost.
6220
6221If you do not add this target hook, GCC uses a default cost of 4 plus
6222the cost of copying via a secondary reload register, if one is
6223needed. If your machine requires a secondary reload register to copy
911852ff 6224between memory and a register of @var{rclass} but the reload mechanism is
38f8b050
JR
6225more complex than copying via an intermediate, use this target hook to
6226reflect the actual cost of the move.
6227
6228GCC defines the function @code{memory_move_secondary_cost} if
6229secondary reloads are needed. It computes the costs due to copying via
6230a secondary register. If your machine copies from memory using a
6231secondary register in the conventional way but the default base value of
62324 is not correct for your machine, use this target hook to add some other
6233value to the result of that function. The arguments to that function
6234are the same as to this target hook.
6235@end deftypefn
6236
6237@defmac BRANCH_COST (@var{speed_p}, @var{predictable_p})
6238A C expression for the cost of a branch instruction. A value of 1 is the
6239default; other values are interpreted relative to that. Parameter @var{speed_p}
6240is true when the branch in question should be optimized for speed. When
6241it is false, @code{BRANCH_COST} should be returning value optimal for code size
6242rather then performance considerations. @var{predictable_p} is true for well
6243predictable branches. On many architectures the @code{BRANCH_COST} can be
6244reduced then.
6245@end defmac
6246
6247Here are additional macros which do not specify precise relative costs,
6248but only that certain actions are more expensive than GCC would
6249ordinarily expect.
6250
6251@defmac SLOW_BYTE_ACCESS
6252Define this macro as a C expression which is nonzero if accessing less
6253than a word of memory (i.e.@: a @code{char} or a @code{short}) is no
6254faster than accessing a word of memory, i.e., if such access
6255require more than one instruction or if there is no difference in cost
6256between byte and (aligned) word loads.
6257
6258When this macro is not defined, the compiler will access a field by
6259finding the smallest containing object; when it is defined, a fullword
6260load will be used if alignment permits. Unless bytes accesses are
6261faster than word accesses, using word accesses is preferable since it
6262may eliminate subsequent memory access if subsequent accesses occur to
6263other fields in the same word of the structure, but to different bytes.
6264@end defmac
6265
6266@defmac SLOW_UNALIGNED_ACCESS (@var{mode}, @var{alignment})
6267Define this macro to be the value 1 if memory accesses described by the
6268@var{mode} and @var{alignment} parameters have a cost many times greater
6269than aligned accesses, for example if they are emulated in a trap
6270handler.
6271
6272When this macro is nonzero, the compiler will act as if
6273@code{STRICT_ALIGNMENT} were nonzero when generating code for block
6274moves. This can cause significantly more instructions to be produced.
6275Therefore, do not set this macro nonzero if unaligned accesses only add a
6276cycle or two to the time for a memory access.
6277
6278If the value of this macro is always zero, it need not be defined. If
6279this macro is defined, it should produce a nonzero value when
6280@code{STRICT_ALIGNMENT} is nonzero.
6281@end defmac
6282
6283@defmac MOVE_RATIO (@var{speed})
6284The threshold of number of scalar memory-to-memory move insns, @emph{below}
6285which a sequence of insns should be generated instead of a
6286string move insn or a library call. Increasing the value will always
6287make code faster, but eventually incurs high cost in increased code size.
6288
6289Note that on machines where the corresponding move insn is a
6290@code{define_expand} that emits a sequence of insns, this macro counts
6291the number of such sequences.
6292
6293The parameter @var{speed} is true if the code is currently being
6294optimized for speed rather than size.
6295
6296If you don't define this, a reasonable default is used.
6297@end defmac
6298
6299@defmac MOVE_BY_PIECES_P (@var{size}, @var{alignment})
6300A C expression used to determine whether @code{move_by_pieces} will be used to
6301copy a chunk of memory, or whether some other block move mechanism
6302will be used. Defaults to 1 if @code{move_by_pieces_ninsns} returns less
6303than @code{MOVE_RATIO}.
6304@end defmac
6305
6306@defmac MOVE_MAX_PIECES
6307A C expression used by @code{move_by_pieces} to determine the largest unit
6308a load or store used to copy memory is. Defaults to @code{MOVE_MAX}.
6309@end defmac
6310
6311@defmac CLEAR_RATIO (@var{speed})
6312The threshold of number of scalar move insns, @emph{below} which a sequence
6313of insns should be generated to clear memory instead of a string clear insn
6314or a library call. Increasing the value will always make code faster, but
6315eventually incurs high cost in increased code size.
6316
6317The parameter @var{speed} is true if the code is currently being
6318optimized for speed rather than size.
6319
6320If you don't define this, a reasonable default is used.
6321@end defmac
6322
6323@defmac CLEAR_BY_PIECES_P (@var{size}, @var{alignment})
6324A C expression used to determine whether @code{clear_by_pieces} will be used
6325to clear a chunk of memory, or whether some other block clear mechanism
6326will be used. Defaults to 1 if @code{move_by_pieces_ninsns} returns less
6327than @code{CLEAR_RATIO}.
6328@end defmac
6329
6330@defmac SET_RATIO (@var{speed})
6331The threshold of number of scalar move insns, @emph{below} which a sequence
6332of insns should be generated to set memory to a constant value, instead of
6333a block set insn or a library call.
6334Increasing the value will always make code faster, but
6335eventually incurs high cost in increased code size.
6336
6337The parameter @var{speed} is true if the code is currently being
6338optimized for speed rather than size.
6339
6340If you don't define this, it defaults to the value of @code{MOVE_RATIO}.
6341@end defmac
6342
6343@defmac SET_BY_PIECES_P (@var{size}, @var{alignment})
6344A C expression used to determine whether @code{store_by_pieces} will be
6345used to set a chunk of memory to a constant value, or whether some
6346other mechanism will be used. Used by @code{__builtin_memset} when
6347storing values other than constant zero.
6348Defaults to 1 if @code{move_by_pieces_ninsns} returns less
6349than @code{SET_RATIO}.
6350@end defmac
6351
6352@defmac STORE_BY_PIECES_P (@var{size}, @var{alignment})
6353A C expression used to determine whether @code{store_by_pieces} will be
6354used to set a chunk of memory to a constant string value, or whether some
6355other mechanism will be used. Used by @code{__builtin_strcpy} when
6356called with a constant source string.
6357Defaults to 1 if @code{move_by_pieces_ninsns} returns less
6358than @code{MOVE_RATIO}.
6359@end defmac
6360
6361@defmac USE_LOAD_POST_INCREMENT (@var{mode})
6362A C expression used to determine whether a load postincrement is a good
6363thing to use for a given mode. Defaults to the value of
6364@code{HAVE_POST_INCREMENT}.
6365@end defmac
6366
6367@defmac USE_LOAD_POST_DECREMENT (@var{mode})
6368A C expression used to determine whether a load postdecrement is a good
6369thing to use for a given mode. Defaults to the value of
6370@code{HAVE_POST_DECREMENT}.
6371@end defmac
6372
6373@defmac USE_LOAD_PRE_INCREMENT (@var{mode})
6374A C expression used to determine whether a load preincrement is a good
6375thing to use for a given mode. Defaults to the value of
6376@code{HAVE_PRE_INCREMENT}.
6377@end defmac
6378
6379@defmac USE_LOAD_PRE_DECREMENT (@var{mode})
6380A C expression used to determine whether a load predecrement is a good
6381thing to use for a given mode. Defaults to the value of
6382@code{HAVE_PRE_DECREMENT}.
6383@end defmac
6384
6385@defmac USE_STORE_POST_INCREMENT (@var{mode})
6386A C expression used to determine whether a store postincrement is a good
6387thing to use for a given mode. Defaults to the value of
6388@code{HAVE_POST_INCREMENT}.
6389@end defmac
6390
6391@defmac USE_STORE_POST_DECREMENT (@var{mode})
6392A C expression used to determine whether a store postdecrement is a good
6393thing to use for a given mode. Defaults to the value of
6394@code{HAVE_POST_DECREMENT}.
6395@end defmac
6396
6397@defmac USE_STORE_PRE_INCREMENT (@var{mode})
6398This macro is used to determine whether a store preincrement is a good
6399thing to use for a given mode. Defaults to the value of
6400@code{HAVE_PRE_INCREMENT}.
6401@end defmac
6402
6403@defmac USE_STORE_PRE_DECREMENT (@var{mode})
6404This macro is used to determine whether a store predecrement is a good
6405thing to use for a given mode. Defaults to the value of
6406@code{HAVE_PRE_DECREMENT}.
6407@end defmac
6408
6409@defmac NO_FUNCTION_CSE
6410Define this macro if it is as good or better to call a constant
6411function address than to call an address kept in a register.
6412@end defmac
6413
6414@defmac RANGE_TEST_NON_SHORT_CIRCUIT
6415Define this macro if a non-short-circuit operation produced by
6416@samp{fold_range_test ()} is optimal. This macro defaults to true if
6417@code{BRANCH_COST} is greater than or equal to the value 2.
6418@end defmac
6419
6420@hook TARGET_RTX_COSTS
6421This target hook describes the relative costs of RTL expressions.
6422
6423The cost may depend on the precise form of the expression, which is
6424available for examination in @var{x}, and the rtx code of the expression
6425in which it is contained, found in @var{outer_code}. @var{code} is the
6426expression code---redundant, since it can be obtained with
6427@code{GET_CODE (@var{x})}.
6428
6429In implementing this hook, you can use the construct
6430@code{COSTS_N_INSNS (@var{n})} to specify a cost equal to @var{n} fast
6431instructions.
6432
6433On entry to the hook, @code{*@var{total}} contains a default estimate
6434for the cost of the expression. The hook should modify this value as
6435necessary. Traditionally, the default costs are @code{COSTS_N_INSNS (5)}
6436for multiplications, @code{COSTS_N_INSNS (7)} for division and modulus
6437operations, and @code{COSTS_N_INSNS (1)} for all other operations.
6438
6439When optimizing for code size, i.e.@: when @code{speed} is
6440false, this target hook should be used to estimate the relative
6441size cost of an expression, again relative to @code{COSTS_N_INSNS}.
6442
6443The hook returns true when all subexpressions of @var{x} have been
6444processed, and false when @code{rtx_cost} should recurse.
6445@end deftypefn
6446
6447@hook TARGET_ADDRESS_COST
6448This hook computes the cost of an addressing mode that contains
6449@var{address}. If not defined, the cost is computed from
6450the @var{address} expression and the @code{TARGET_RTX_COST} hook.
6451
6452For most CISC machines, the default cost is a good approximation of the
6453true cost of the addressing mode. However, on RISC machines, all
6454instructions normally have the same length and execution time. Hence
6455all addresses will have equal costs.
6456
6457In cases where more than one form of an address is known, the form with
6458the lowest cost will be used. If multiple forms have the same, lowest,
6459cost, the one that is the most complex will be used.
6460
6461For example, suppose an address that is equal to the sum of a register
6462and a constant is used twice in the same basic block. When this macro
6463is not defined, the address will be computed in a register and memory
6464references will be indirect through that register. On machines where
6465the cost of the addressing mode containing the sum is no higher than
6466that of a simple indirect reference, this will produce an additional
6467instruction and possibly require an additional register. Proper
6468specification of this macro eliminates this overhead for such machines.
6469
6470This hook is never called with an invalid address.
6471
6472On machines where an address involving more than one register is as
6473cheap as an address computation involving only one register, defining
6474@code{TARGET_ADDRESS_COST} to reflect this can cause two registers to
6475be live over a region of code where only one would have been if
6476@code{TARGET_ADDRESS_COST} were not defined in that manner. This effect
6477should be considered in the definition of this macro. Equivalent costs
6478should probably only be given to addresses with different numbers of
6479registers on machines with lots of registers.
6480@end deftypefn
6481
6482@node Scheduling
6483@section Adjusting the Instruction Scheduler
6484
6485The instruction scheduler may need a fair amount of machine-specific
6486adjustment in order to produce good code. GCC provides several target
6487hooks for this purpose. It is usually enough to define just a few of
6488them: try the first ones in this list first.
6489
6490@hook TARGET_SCHED_ISSUE_RATE
6491This hook returns the maximum number of instructions that can ever
6492issue at the same time on the target machine. The default is one.
6493Although the insn scheduler can define itself the possibility of issue
6494an insn on the same cycle, the value can serve as an additional
6495constraint to issue insns on the same simulated processor cycle (see
6496hooks @samp{TARGET_SCHED_REORDER} and @samp{TARGET_SCHED_REORDER2}).
6497This value must be constant over the entire compilation. If you need
6498it to vary depending on what the instructions are, you must use
6499@samp{TARGET_SCHED_VARIABLE_ISSUE}.
6500@end deftypefn
6501
6502@hook TARGET_SCHED_VARIABLE_ISSUE
6503This hook is executed by the scheduler after it has scheduled an insn
6504from the ready list. It should return the number of insns which can
6505still be issued in the current cycle. The default is
6506@samp{@w{@var{more} - 1}} for insns other than @code{CLOBBER} and
6507@code{USE}, which normally are not counted against the issue rate.
6508You should define this hook if some insns take more machine resources
6509than others, so that fewer insns can follow them in the same cycle.
6510@var{file} is either a null pointer, or a stdio stream to write any
6511debug output to. @var{verbose} is the verbose level provided by
6512@option{-fsched-verbose-@var{n}}. @var{insn} is the instruction that
6513was scheduled.
6514@end deftypefn
6515
6516@hook TARGET_SCHED_ADJUST_COST
6517This function corrects the value of @var{cost} based on the
6518relationship between @var{insn} and @var{dep_insn} through the
6519dependence @var{link}. It should return the new value. The default
6520is to make no adjustment to @var{cost}. This can be used for example
6521to specify to the scheduler using the traditional pipeline description
6522that an output- or anti-dependence does not incur the same cost as a
6523data-dependence. If the scheduler using the automaton based pipeline
6524description, the cost of anti-dependence is zero and the cost of
6525output-dependence is maximum of one and the difference of latency
6526times of the first and the second insns. If these values are not
6527acceptable, you could use the hook to modify them too. See also
6528@pxref{Processor pipeline description}.
6529@end deftypefn
6530
6531@hook TARGET_SCHED_ADJUST_PRIORITY
6532This hook adjusts the integer scheduling priority @var{priority} of
6533@var{insn}. It should return the new priority. Increase the priority to
6534execute @var{insn} earlier, reduce the priority to execute @var{insn}
6535later. Do not define this hook if you do not need to adjust the
6536scheduling priorities of insns.
6537@end deftypefn
6538
6539@hook TARGET_SCHED_REORDER
6540This hook is executed by the scheduler after it has scheduled the ready
6541list, to allow the machine description to reorder it (for example to
6542combine two small instructions together on @samp{VLIW} machines).
6543@var{file} is either a null pointer, or a stdio stream to write any
6544debug output to. @var{verbose} is the verbose level provided by
6545@option{-fsched-verbose-@var{n}}. @var{ready} is a pointer to the ready
6546list of instructions that are ready to be scheduled. @var{n_readyp} is
6547a pointer to the number of elements in the ready list. The scheduler
6548reads the ready list in reverse order, starting with
6549@var{ready}[@var{*n_readyp} @minus{} 1] and going to @var{ready}[0]. @var{clock}
6550is the timer tick of the scheduler. You may modify the ready list and
6551the number of ready insns. The return value is the number of insns that
6552can issue this cycle; normally this is just @code{issue_rate}. See also
6553@samp{TARGET_SCHED_REORDER2}.
6554@end deftypefn
6555
6556@hook TARGET_SCHED_REORDER2
6557Like @samp{TARGET_SCHED_REORDER}, but called at a different time. That
6558function is called whenever the scheduler starts a new cycle. This one
6559is called once per iteration over a cycle, immediately after
6560@samp{TARGET_SCHED_VARIABLE_ISSUE}; it can reorder the ready list and
6561return the number of insns to be scheduled in the same cycle. Defining
6562this hook can be useful if there are frequent situations where
6563scheduling one insn causes other insns to become ready in the same
6564cycle. These other insns can then be taken into account properly.
6565@end deftypefn
6566
6567@hook TARGET_SCHED_DEPENDENCIES_EVALUATION_HOOK
6568This hook is called after evaluation forward dependencies of insns in
6569chain given by two parameter values (@var{head} and @var{tail}
6570correspondingly) but before insns scheduling of the insn chain. For
6571example, it can be used for better insn classification if it requires
6572analysis of dependencies. This hook can use backward and forward
6573dependencies of the insn scheduler because they are already
6574calculated.
6575@end deftypefn
6576
6577@hook TARGET_SCHED_INIT
6578This hook is executed by the scheduler at the beginning of each block of
6579instructions that are to be scheduled. @var{file} is either a null
6580pointer, or a stdio stream to write any debug output to. @var{verbose}
6581is the verbose level provided by @option{-fsched-verbose-@var{n}}.
6582@var{max_ready} is the maximum number of insns in the current scheduling
6583region that can be live at the same time. This can be used to allocate
6584scratch space if it is needed, e.g.@: by @samp{TARGET_SCHED_REORDER}.
6585@end deftypefn
6586
6587@hook TARGET_SCHED_FINISH
6588This hook is executed by the scheduler at the end of each block of
6589instructions that are to be scheduled. It can be used to perform
6590cleanup of any actions done by the other scheduling hooks. @var{file}
6591is either a null pointer, or a stdio stream to write any debug output
6592to. @var{verbose} is the verbose level provided by
6593@option{-fsched-verbose-@var{n}}.
6594@end deftypefn
6595
6596@hook TARGET_SCHED_INIT_GLOBAL
6597This hook is executed by the scheduler after function level initializations.
6598@var{file} is either a null pointer, or a stdio stream to write any debug output to.
6599@var{verbose} is the verbose level provided by @option{-fsched-verbose-@var{n}}.
6600@var{old_max_uid} is the maximum insn uid when scheduling begins.
6601@end deftypefn
6602
6603@hook TARGET_SCHED_FINISH_GLOBAL
6604This is the cleanup hook corresponding to @code{TARGET_SCHED_INIT_GLOBAL}.
6605@var{file} is either a null pointer, or a stdio stream to write any debug output to.
6606@var{verbose} is the verbose level provided by @option{-fsched-verbose-@var{n}}.
6607@end deftypefn
6608
6609@hook TARGET_SCHED_DFA_PRE_CYCLE_INSN
6610The hook returns an RTL insn. The automaton state used in the
6611pipeline hazard recognizer is changed as if the insn were scheduled
6612when the new simulated processor cycle starts. Usage of the hook may
6613simplify the automaton pipeline description for some @acronym{VLIW}
6614processors. If the hook is defined, it is used only for the automaton
6615based pipeline description. The default is not to change the state
6616when the new simulated processor cycle starts.
6617@end deftypefn
6618
6619@hook TARGET_SCHED_INIT_DFA_PRE_CYCLE_INSN
6620The hook can be used to initialize data used by the previous hook.
6621@end deftypefn
6622
6623@hook TARGET_SCHED_DFA_POST_CYCLE_INSN
6624The hook is analogous to @samp{TARGET_SCHED_DFA_PRE_CYCLE_INSN} but used
6625to changed the state as if the insn were scheduled when the new
6626simulated processor cycle finishes.
6627@end deftypefn
6628
6629@hook TARGET_SCHED_INIT_DFA_POST_CYCLE_INSN
6630The hook is analogous to @samp{TARGET_SCHED_INIT_DFA_PRE_CYCLE_INSN} but
6631used to initialize data used by the previous hook.
6632@end deftypefn
6633
6634@hook TARGET_SCHED_DFA_PRE_ADVANCE_CYCLE
6635The hook to notify target that the current simulated cycle is about to finish.
6636The hook is analogous to @samp{TARGET_SCHED_DFA_PRE_CYCLE_INSN} but used
6637to change the state in more complicated situations - e.g., when advancing
6638state on a single insn is not enough.
6639@end deftypefn
6640
6641@hook TARGET_SCHED_DFA_POST_ADVANCE_CYCLE
6642The hook to notify target that new simulated cycle has just started.
6643The hook is analogous to @samp{TARGET_SCHED_DFA_POST_CYCLE_INSN} but used
6644to change the state in more complicated situations - e.g., when advancing
6645state on a single insn is not enough.
6646@end deftypefn
6647
6648@hook TARGET_SCHED_FIRST_CYCLE_MULTIPASS_DFA_LOOKAHEAD
6649This hook controls better choosing an insn from the ready insn queue
6650for the @acronym{DFA}-based insn scheduler. Usually the scheduler
6651chooses the first insn from the queue. If the hook returns a positive
6652value, an additional scheduler code tries all permutations of
6653@samp{TARGET_SCHED_FIRST_CYCLE_MULTIPASS_DFA_LOOKAHEAD ()}
6654subsequent ready insns to choose an insn whose issue will result in
6655maximal number of issued insns on the same cycle. For the
6656@acronym{VLIW} processor, the code could actually solve the problem of
6657packing simple insns into the @acronym{VLIW} insn. Of course, if the
6658rules of @acronym{VLIW} packing are described in the automaton.
6659
6660This code also could be used for superscalar @acronym{RISC}
6661processors. Let us consider a superscalar @acronym{RISC} processor
6662with 3 pipelines. Some insns can be executed in pipelines @var{A} or
6663@var{B}, some insns can be executed only in pipelines @var{B} or
6664@var{C}, and one insn can be executed in pipeline @var{B}. The
6665processor may issue the 1st insn into @var{A} and the 2nd one into
6666@var{B}. In this case, the 3rd insn will wait for freeing @var{B}
6667until the next cycle. If the scheduler issues the 3rd insn the first,
6668the processor could issue all 3 insns per cycle.
6669
6670Actually this code demonstrates advantages of the automaton based
6671pipeline hazard recognizer. We try quickly and easy many insn
6672schedules to choose the best one.
6673
6674The default is no multipass scheduling.
6675@end deftypefn
6676
6677@hook TARGET_SCHED_FIRST_CYCLE_MULTIPASS_DFA_LOOKAHEAD_GUARD
6678
6679This hook controls what insns from the ready insn queue will be
6680considered for the multipass insn scheduling. If the hook returns
6681zero for @var{insn}, the insn will be not chosen to
6682be issued.
6683
6684The default is that any ready insns can be chosen to be issued.
6685@end deftypefn
6686
c06bbdf7 6687@hook TARGET_SCHED_DFA_NEW_CYCLE
38f8b050
JR
6688This hook is called by the insn scheduler before issuing @var{insn}
6689on cycle @var{clock}. If the hook returns nonzero,
6690@var{insn} is not issued on this processor cycle. Instead,
6691the processor cycle is advanced. If *@var{sort_p}
6692is zero, the insn ready queue is not sorted on the new cycle
6693start as usually. @var{dump} and @var{verbose} specify the file and
6694verbosity level to use for debugging output.
6695@var{last_clock} and @var{clock} are, respectively, the
6696processor cycle on which the previous insn has been issued,
6697and the current processor cycle.
6698@end deftypefn
6699
6700@hook TARGET_SCHED_IS_COSTLY_DEPENDENCE
6701This hook is used to define which dependences are considered costly by
6702the target, so costly that it is not advisable to schedule the insns that
6703are involved in the dependence too close to one another. The parameters
6704to this hook are as follows: The first parameter @var{_dep} is the dependence
6705being evaluated. The second parameter @var{cost} is the cost of the
6706dependence as estimated by the scheduler, and the third
6707parameter @var{distance} is the distance in cycles between the two insns.
6708The hook returns @code{true} if considering the distance between the two
6709insns the dependence between them is considered costly by the target,
6710and @code{false} otherwise.
6711
6712Defining this hook can be useful in multiple-issue out-of-order machines,
6713where (a) it's practically hopeless to predict the actual data/resource
6714delays, however: (b) there's a better chance to predict the actual grouping
6715that will be formed, and (c) correctly emulating the grouping can be very
6716important. In such targets one may want to allow issuing dependent insns
6717closer to one another---i.e., closer than the dependence distance; however,
6718not in cases of ``costly dependences'', which this hooks allows to define.
6719@end deftypefn
6720
6721@hook TARGET_SCHED_H_I_D_EXTENDED
6722This hook is called by the insn scheduler after emitting a new instruction to
6723the instruction stream. The hook notifies a target backend to extend its
6724per instruction data structures.
6725@end deftypefn
6726
6727@hook TARGET_SCHED_ALLOC_SCHED_CONTEXT
6728Return a pointer to a store large enough to hold target scheduling context.
6729@end deftypefn
6730
6731@hook TARGET_SCHED_INIT_SCHED_CONTEXT
6732Initialize store pointed to by @var{tc} to hold target scheduling context.
6733It @var{clean_p} is true then initialize @var{tc} as if scheduler is at the
6734beginning of the block. Otherwise, copy the current context into @var{tc}.
6735@end deftypefn
6736
6737@hook TARGET_SCHED_SET_SCHED_CONTEXT
6738Copy target scheduling context pointed to by @var{tc} to the current context.
6739@end deftypefn
6740
6741@hook TARGET_SCHED_CLEAR_SCHED_CONTEXT
6742Deallocate internal data in target scheduling context pointed to by @var{tc}.
6743@end deftypefn
6744
6745@hook TARGET_SCHED_FREE_SCHED_CONTEXT
6746Deallocate a store for target scheduling context pointed to by @var{tc}.
6747@end deftypefn
6748
6749@hook TARGET_SCHED_SPECULATE_INSN
6750This hook is called by the insn scheduler when @var{insn} has only
6751speculative dependencies and therefore can be scheduled speculatively.
6752The hook is used to check if the pattern of @var{insn} has a speculative
6753version and, in case of successful check, to generate that speculative
6754pattern. The hook should return 1, if the instruction has a speculative form,
6755or @minus{}1, if it doesn't. @var{request} describes the type of requested
6756speculation. If the return value equals 1 then @var{new_pat} is assigned
6757the generated speculative pattern.
6758@end deftypefn
6759
6760@hook TARGET_SCHED_NEEDS_BLOCK_P
6761This hook is called by the insn scheduler during generation of recovery code
6762for @var{insn}. It should return @code{true}, if the corresponding check
6763instruction should branch to recovery code, or @code{false} otherwise.
6764@end deftypefn
6765
6766@hook TARGET_SCHED_GEN_SPEC_CHECK
6767This hook is called by the insn scheduler to generate a pattern for recovery
6768check instruction. If @var{mutate_p} is zero, then @var{insn} is a
6769speculative instruction for which the check should be generated.
6770@var{label} is either a label of a basic block, where recovery code should
6771be emitted, or a null pointer, when requested check doesn't branch to
6772recovery code (a simple check). If @var{mutate_p} is nonzero, then
6773a pattern for a branchy check corresponding to a simple check denoted by
6774@var{insn} should be generated. In this case @var{label} can't be null.
6775@end deftypefn
6776
6777@hook TARGET_SCHED_FIRST_CYCLE_MULTIPASS_DFA_LOOKAHEAD_GUARD_SPEC
6778This hook is used as a workaround for
6779@samp{TARGET_SCHED_FIRST_CYCLE_MULTIPASS_DFA_LOOKAHEAD_GUARD} not being
6780called on the first instruction of the ready list. The hook is used to
6781discard speculative instructions that stand first in the ready list from
6782being scheduled on the current cycle. If the hook returns @code{false},
6783@var{insn} will not be chosen to be issued.
6784For non-speculative instructions,
6785the hook should always return @code{true}. For example, in the ia64 backend
6786the hook is used to cancel data speculative insns when the ALAT table
6787is nearly full.
6788@end deftypefn
6789
6790@hook TARGET_SCHED_SET_SCHED_FLAGS
6791This hook is used by the insn scheduler to find out what features should be
6792enabled/used.
6793The structure *@var{spec_info} should be filled in by the target.
6794The structure describes speculation types that can be used in the scheduler.
6795@end deftypefn
6796
6797@hook TARGET_SCHED_SMS_RES_MII
6798This hook is called by the swing modulo scheduler to calculate a
6799resource-based lower bound which is based on the resources available in
6800the machine and the resources required by each instruction. The target
6801backend can use @var{g} to calculate such bound. A very simple lower
6802bound will be used in case this hook is not implemented: the total number
6803of instructions divided by the issue rate.
6804@end deftypefn
6805
7942e47e
RY
6806@hook TARGET_SCHED_DISPATCH
6807This hook is called by Haifa Scheduler. It returns true if dispatch scheduling
6808is supported in hardware and the condition specified in the parameter is true.
6809@end deftypefn
6810
6811@hook TARGET_SCHED_DISPATCH_DO
6812This hook is called by Haifa Scheduler. It performs the operation specified
6813in its second parameter.
6814@end deftypefn
6815
38f8b050
JR
6816@node Sections
6817@section Dividing the Output into Sections (Texts, Data, @dots{})
6818@c the above section title is WAY too long. maybe cut the part between
6819@c the (...)? --mew 10feb93
6820
6821An object file is divided into sections containing different types of
6822data. In the most common case, there are three sections: the @dfn{text
6823section}, which holds instructions and read-only data; the @dfn{data
6824section}, which holds initialized writable data; and the @dfn{bss
6825section}, which holds uninitialized data. Some systems have other kinds
6826of sections.
6827
6828@file{varasm.c} provides several well-known sections, such as
6829@code{text_section}, @code{data_section} and @code{bss_section}.
6830The normal way of controlling a @code{@var{foo}_section} variable
6831is to define the associated @code{@var{FOO}_SECTION_ASM_OP} macro,
6832as described below. The macros are only read once, when @file{varasm.c}
6833initializes itself, so their values must be run-time constants.
6834They may however depend on command-line flags.
6835
6836@emph{Note:} Some run-time files, such @file{crtstuff.c}, also make
6837use of the @code{@var{FOO}_SECTION_ASM_OP} macros, and expect them
6838to be string literals.
6839
6840Some assemblers require a different string to be written every time a
6841section is selected. If your assembler falls into this category, you
6842should define the @code{TARGET_ASM_INIT_SECTIONS} hook and use
6843@code{get_unnamed_section} to set up the sections.
6844
6845You must always create a @code{text_section}, either by defining
6846@code{TEXT_SECTION_ASM_OP} or by initializing @code{text_section}
6847in @code{TARGET_ASM_INIT_SECTIONS}. The same is true of
6848@code{data_section} and @code{DATA_SECTION_ASM_OP}. If you do not
6849create a distinct @code{readonly_data_section}, the default is to
6850reuse @code{text_section}.
6851
6852All the other @file{varasm.c} sections are optional, and are null
6853if the target does not provide them.
6854
6855@defmac TEXT_SECTION_ASM_OP
6856A C expression whose value is a string, including spacing, containing the
6857assembler operation that should precede instructions and read-only data.
6858Normally @code{"\t.text"} is right.
6859@end defmac
6860
6861@defmac HOT_TEXT_SECTION_NAME
6862If defined, a C string constant for the name of the section containing most
6863frequently executed functions of the program. If not defined, GCC will provide
6864a default definition if the target supports named sections.
6865@end defmac
6866
6867@defmac UNLIKELY_EXECUTED_TEXT_SECTION_NAME
6868If defined, a C string constant for the name of the section containing unlikely
6869executed functions in the program.
6870@end defmac
6871
6872@defmac DATA_SECTION_ASM_OP
6873A C expression whose value is a string, including spacing, containing the
6874assembler operation to identify the following data as writable initialized
6875data. Normally @code{"\t.data"} is right.
6876@end defmac
6877
6878@defmac SDATA_SECTION_ASM_OP
6879If defined, a C expression whose value is a string, including spacing,
6880containing the assembler operation to identify the following data as
6881initialized, writable small data.
6882@end defmac
6883
6884@defmac READONLY_DATA_SECTION_ASM_OP
6885A C expression whose value is a string, including spacing, containing the
6886assembler operation to identify the following data as read-only initialized
6887data.
6888@end defmac
6889
6890@defmac BSS_SECTION_ASM_OP
6891If defined, a C expression whose value is a string, including spacing,
6892containing the assembler operation to identify the following data as
6893uninitialized global data. If not defined, and neither
6894@code{ASM_OUTPUT_BSS} nor @code{ASM_OUTPUT_ALIGNED_BSS} are defined,
6895uninitialized global data will be output in the data section if
6896@option{-fno-common} is passed, otherwise @code{ASM_OUTPUT_COMMON} will be
6897used.
6898@end defmac
6899
6900@defmac SBSS_SECTION_ASM_OP
6901If defined, a C expression whose value is a string, including spacing,
6902containing the assembler operation to identify the following data as
6903uninitialized, writable small data.
6904@end defmac
6905
6906@defmac TLS_COMMON_ASM_OP
6907If defined, a C expression whose value is a string containing the
6908assembler operation to identify the following data as thread-local
6909common data. The default is @code{".tls_common"}.
6910@end defmac
6911
6912@defmac TLS_SECTION_ASM_FLAG
6913If defined, a C expression whose value is a character constant
6914containing the flag used to mark a section as a TLS section. The
6915default is @code{'T'}.
6916@end defmac
6917
6918@defmac INIT_SECTION_ASM_OP
6919If defined, a C expression whose value is a string, including spacing,
6920containing the assembler operation to identify the following data as
6921initialization code. If not defined, GCC will assume such a section does
6922not exist. This section has no corresponding @code{init_section}
6923variable; it is used entirely in runtime code.
6924@end defmac
6925
6926@defmac FINI_SECTION_ASM_OP
6927If defined, a C expression whose value is a string, including spacing,
6928containing the assembler operation to identify the following data as
6929finalization code. If not defined, GCC will assume such a section does
6930not exist. This section has no corresponding @code{fini_section}
6931variable; it is used entirely in runtime code.
6932@end defmac
6933
6934@defmac INIT_ARRAY_SECTION_ASM_OP
6935If defined, a C expression whose value is a string, including spacing,
6936containing the assembler operation to identify the following data as
6937part of the @code{.init_array} (or equivalent) section. If not
6938defined, GCC will assume such a section does not exist. Do not define
6939both this macro and @code{INIT_SECTION_ASM_OP}.
6940@end defmac
6941
6942@defmac FINI_ARRAY_SECTION_ASM_OP
6943If defined, a C expression whose value is a string, including spacing,
6944containing the assembler operation to identify the following data as
6945part of the @code{.fini_array} (or equivalent) section. If not
6946defined, GCC will assume such a section does not exist. Do not define
6947both this macro and @code{FINI_SECTION_ASM_OP}.
6948@end defmac
6949
6950@defmac CRT_CALL_STATIC_FUNCTION (@var{section_op}, @var{function})
6951If defined, an ASM statement that switches to a different section
6952via @var{section_op}, calls @var{function}, and switches back to
6953the text section. This is used in @file{crtstuff.c} if
6954@code{INIT_SECTION_ASM_OP} or @code{FINI_SECTION_ASM_OP} to calls
6955to initialization and finalization functions from the init and fini
6956sections. By default, this macro uses a simple function call. Some
6957ports need hand-crafted assembly code to avoid dependencies on
6958registers initialized in the function prologue or to ensure that
6959constant pools don't end up too far way in the text section.
6960@end defmac
6961
6962@defmac TARGET_LIBGCC_SDATA_SECTION
6963If defined, a string which names the section into which small
6964variables defined in crtstuff and libgcc should go. This is useful
6965when the target has options for optimizing access to small data, and
6966you want the crtstuff and libgcc routines to be conservative in what
6967they expect of your application yet liberal in what your application
6968expects. For example, for targets with a @code{.sdata} section (like
6969MIPS), you could compile crtstuff with @code{-G 0} so that it doesn't
6970require small data support from your application, but use this macro
6971to put small data into @code{.sdata} so that your application can
6972access these variables whether it uses small data or not.
6973@end defmac
6974
6975@defmac FORCE_CODE_SECTION_ALIGN
6976If defined, an ASM statement that aligns a code section to some
6977arbitrary boundary. This is used to force all fragments of the
6978@code{.init} and @code{.fini} sections to have to same alignment
6979and thus prevent the linker from having to add any padding.
6980@end defmac
6981
6982@defmac JUMP_TABLES_IN_TEXT_SECTION
6983Define this macro to be an expression with a nonzero value if jump
6984tables (for @code{tablejump} insns) should be output in the text
6985section, along with the assembler instructions. Otherwise, the
6986readonly data section is used.
6987
6988This macro is irrelevant if there is no separate readonly data section.
6989@end defmac
6990
6991@hook TARGET_ASM_INIT_SECTIONS
6992Define this hook if you need to do something special to set up the
6993@file{varasm.c} sections, or if your target has some special sections
6994of its own that you need to create.
6995
6996GCC calls this hook after processing the command line, but before writing
6997any assembly code, and before calling any of the section-returning hooks
6998described below.
6999@end deftypefn
7000
7001@hook TARGET_ASM_RELOC_RW_MASK
7002Return a mask describing how relocations should be treated when
7003selecting sections. Bit 1 should be set if global relocations
7004should be placed in a read-write section; bit 0 should be set if
7005local relocations should be placed in a read-write section.
7006
7007The default version of this function returns 3 when @option{-fpic}
7008is in effect, and 0 otherwise. The hook is typically redefined
7009when the target cannot support (some kinds of) dynamic relocations
7010in read-only sections even in executables.
7011@end deftypefn
7012
7013@hook TARGET_ASM_SELECT_SECTION
7014Return the section into which @var{exp} should be placed. You can
7015assume that @var{exp} is either a @code{VAR_DECL} node or a constant of
7016some sort. @var{reloc} indicates whether the initial value of @var{exp}
7017requires link-time relocations. Bit 0 is set when variable contains
7018local relocations only, while bit 1 is set for global relocations.
7019@var{align} is the constant alignment in bits.
7020
7021The default version of this function takes care of putting read-only
7022variables in @code{readonly_data_section}.
7023
7024See also @var{USE_SELECT_SECTION_FOR_FUNCTIONS}.
7025@end deftypefn
7026
7027@defmac USE_SELECT_SECTION_FOR_FUNCTIONS
7028Define this macro if you wish TARGET_ASM_SELECT_SECTION to be called
7029for @code{FUNCTION_DECL}s as well as for variables and constants.
7030
7031In the case of a @code{FUNCTION_DECL}, @var{reloc} will be zero if the
7032function has been determined to be likely to be called, and nonzero if
7033it is unlikely to be called.
7034@end defmac
7035
7036@hook TARGET_ASM_UNIQUE_SECTION
7037Build up a unique section name, expressed as a @code{STRING_CST} node,
7038and assign it to @samp{DECL_SECTION_NAME (@var{decl})}.
7039As with @code{TARGET_ASM_SELECT_SECTION}, @var{reloc} indicates whether
7040the initial value of @var{exp} requires link-time relocations.
7041
7042The default version of this function appends the symbol name to the
7043ELF section name that would normally be used for the symbol. For
7044example, the function @code{foo} would be placed in @code{.text.foo}.
7045Whatever the actual target object format, this is often good enough.
7046@end deftypefn
7047
7048@hook TARGET_ASM_FUNCTION_RODATA_SECTION
7049Return the readonly data section associated with
7050@samp{DECL_SECTION_NAME (@var{decl})}.
7051The default version of this function selects @code{.gnu.linkonce.r.name} if
7052the function's section is @code{.gnu.linkonce.t.name}, @code{.rodata.name}
7053if function is in @code{.text.name}, and the normal readonly-data section
7054otherwise.
7055@end deftypefn
7056
7057@hook TARGET_ASM_SELECT_RTX_SECTION
7058Return the section into which a constant @var{x}, of mode @var{mode},
7059should be placed. You can assume that @var{x} is some kind of
7060constant in RTL@. The argument @var{mode} is redundant except in the
7061case of a @code{const_int} rtx. @var{align} is the constant alignment
7062in bits.
7063
7064The default version of this function takes care of putting symbolic
7065constants in @code{flag_pic} mode in @code{data_section} and everything
7066else in @code{readonly_data_section}.
7067@end deftypefn
7068
7069@hook TARGET_MANGLE_DECL_ASSEMBLER_NAME
7070Define this hook if you need to postprocess the assembler name generated
7071by target-independent code. The @var{id} provided to this hook will be
7072the computed name (e.g., the macro @code{DECL_NAME} of the @var{decl} in C,
7073or the mangled name of the @var{decl} in C++). The return value of the
7074hook is an @code{IDENTIFIER_NODE} for the appropriate mangled name on
7075your target system. The default implementation of this hook just
7076returns the @var{id} provided.
7077@end deftypefn
7078
7079@hook TARGET_ENCODE_SECTION_INFO
7080Define this hook if references to a symbol or a constant must be
7081treated differently depending on something about the variable or
7082function named by the symbol (such as what section it is in).
7083
7084The hook is executed immediately after rtl has been created for
7085@var{decl}, which may be a variable or function declaration or
7086an entry in the constant pool. In either case, @var{rtl} is the
7087rtl in question. Do @emph{not} use @code{DECL_RTL (@var{decl})}
7088in this hook; that field may not have been initialized yet.
7089
7090In the case of a constant, it is safe to assume that the rtl is
7091a @code{mem} whose address is a @code{symbol_ref}. Most decls
7092will also have this form, but that is not guaranteed. Global
7093register variables, for instance, will have a @code{reg} for their
7094rtl. (Normally the right thing to do with such unusual rtl is
7095leave it alone.)
7096
7097The @var{new_decl_p} argument will be true if this is the first time
7098that @code{TARGET_ENCODE_SECTION_INFO} has been invoked on this decl. It will
7099be false for subsequent invocations, which will happen for duplicate
7100declarations. Whether or not anything must be done for the duplicate
7101declaration depends on whether the hook examines @code{DECL_ATTRIBUTES}.
7102@var{new_decl_p} is always true when the hook is called for a constant.
7103
7104@cindex @code{SYMBOL_REF_FLAG}, in @code{TARGET_ENCODE_SECTION_INFO}
7105The usual thing for this hook to do is to record flags in the
7106@code{symbol_ref}, using @code{SYMBOL_REF_FLAG} or @code{SYMBOL_REF_FLAGS}.
7107Historically, the name string was modified if it was necessary to
7108encode more than one bit of information, but this practice is now
7109discouraged; use @code{SYMBOL_REF_FLAGS}.
7110
7111The default definition of this hook, @code{default_encode_section_info}
7112in @file{varasm.c}, sets a number of commonly-useful bits in
7113@code{SYMBOL_REF_FLAGS}. Check whether the default does what you need
7114before overriding it.
7115@end deftypefn
7116
7117@hook TARGET_STRIP_NAME_ENCODING
7118Decode @var{name} and return the real name part, sans
7119the characters that @code{TARGET_ENCODE_SECTION_INFO}
7120may have added.
7121@end deftypefn
7122
7123@hook TARGET_IN_SMALL_DATA_P
7124Returns true if @var{exp} should be placed into a ``small data'' section.
7125The default version of this hook always returns false.
7126@end deftypefn
7127
7128@hook TARGET_HAVE_SRODATA_SECTION
7129Contains the value true if the target places read-only
7130``small data'' into a separate section. The default value is false.
7131@end deftypevr
7132
3c5273a9
KT
7133@hook TARGET_PROFILE_BEFORE_PROLOGUE
7134
38f8b050
JR
7135@hook TARGET_BINDS_LOCAL_P
7136Returns true if @var{exp} names an object for which name resolution
7137rules must resolve to the current ``module'' (dynamic shared library
7138or executable image).
7139
7140The default version of this hook implements the name resolution rules
7141for ELF, which has a looser model of global name binding than other
7142currently supported object file formats.
7143@end deftypefn
7144
7145@hook TARGET_HAVE_TLS
7146Contains the value true if the target supports thread-local storage.
7147The default value is false.
7148@end deftypevr
7149
7150
7151@node PIC
7152@section Position Independent Code
7153@cindex position independent code
7154@cindex PIC
7155
7156This section describes macros that help implement generation of position
7157independent code. Simply defining these macros is not enough to
7158generate valid PIC; you must also add support to the hook
7159@code{TARGET_LEGITIMATE_ADDRESS_P} and to the macro
7160@code{PRINT_OPERAND_ADDRESS}, as well as @code{LEGITIMIZE_ADDRESS}. You
7161must modify the definition of @samp{movsi} to do something appropriate
7162when the source operand contains a symbolic address. You may also
7163need to alter the handling of switch statements so that they use
7164relative addresses.
7165@c i rearranged the order of the macros above to try to force one of
7166@c them to the next line, to eliminate an overfull hbox. --mew 10feb93
7167
7168@defmac PIC_OFFSET_TABLE_REGNUM
7169The register number of the register used to address a table of static
7170data addresses in memory. In some cases this register is defined by a
7171processor's ``application binary interface'' (ABI)@. When this macro
7172is defined, RTL is generated for this register once, as with the stack
7173pointer and frame pointer registers. If this macro is not defined, it
7174is up to the machine-dependent files to allocate such a register (if
7175necessary). Note that this register must be fixed when in use (e.g.@:
7176when @code{flag_pic} is true).
7177@end defmac
7178
7179@defmac PIC_OFFSET_TABLE_REG_CALL_CLOBBERED
f8fe0a4a
JM
7180A C expression that is nonzero if the register defined by
7181@code{PIC_OFFSET_TABLE_REGNUM} is clobbered by calls. If not defined,
7182the default is zero. Do not define
38f8b050
JR
7183this macro if @code{PIC_OFFSET_TABLE_REGNUM} is not defined.
7184@end defmac
7185
7186@defmac LEGITIMATE_PIC_OPERAND_P (@var{x})
7187A C expression that is nonzero if @var{x} is a legitimate immediate
7188operand on the target machine when generating position independent code.
7189You can assume that @var{x} satisfies @code{CONSTANT_P}, so you need not
7190check this. You can also assume @var{flag_pic} is true, so you need not
7191check it either. You need not define this macro if all constants
7192(including @code{SYMBOL_REF}) can be immediate operands when generating
7193position independent code.
7194@end defmac
7195
7196@node Assembler Format
7197@section Defining the Output Assembler Language
7198
7199This section describes macros whose principal purpose is to describe how
7200to write instructions in assembler language---rather than what the
7201instructions do.
7202
7203@menu
7204* File Framework:: Structural information for the assembler file.
7205* Data Output:: Output of constants (numbers, strings, addresses).
7206* Uninitialized Data:: Output of uninitialized variables.
7207* Label Output:: Output and generation of labels.
7208* Initialization:: General principles of initialization
7209 and termination routines.
7210* Macros for Initialization::
7211 Specific macros that control the handling of
7212 initialization and termination routines.
7213* Instruction Output:: Output of actual instructions.
7214* Dispatch Tables:: Output of jump tables.
7215* Exception Region Output:: Output of exception region code.
7216* Alignment Output:: Pseudo ops for alignment and skipping data.
7217@end menu
7218
7219@node File Framework
7220@subsection The Overall Framework of an Assembler File
7221@cindex assembler format
7222@cindex output of assembler code
7223
7224@c prevent bad page break with this line
7225This describes the overall framework of an assembly file.
7226
7227@findex default_file_start
7228@hook TARGET_ASM_FILE_START
7229Output to @code{asm_out_file} any text which the assembler expects to
7230find at the beginning of a file. The default behavior is controlled
7231by two flags, documented below. Unless your target's assembler is
7232quite unusual, if you override the default, you should call
7233@code{default_file_start} at some point in your target hook. This
7234lets other target files rely on these variables.
7235@end deftypefn
7236
7237@hook TARGET_ASM_FILE_START_APP_OFF
7238If this flag is true, the text of the macro @code{ASM_APP_OFF} will be
7239printed as the very first line in the assembly file, unless
7240@option{-fverbose-asm} is in effect. (If that macro has been defined
7241to the empty string, this variable has no effect.) With the normal
7242definition of @code{ASM_APP_OFF}, the effect is to notify the GNU
7243assembler that it need not bother stripping comments or extra
7244whitespace from its input. This allows it to work a bit faster.
7245
7246The default is false. You should not set it to true unless you have
7247verified that your port does not generate any extra whitespace or
7248comments that will cause GAS to issue errors in NO_APP mode.
7249@end deftypevr
7250
7251@hook TARGET_ASM_FILE_START_FILE_DIRECTIVE
7252If this flag is true, @code{output_file_directive} will be called
7253for the primary source file, immediately after printing
7254@code{ASM_APP_OFF} (if that is enabled). Most ELF assemblers expect
7255this to be done. The default is false.
7256@end deftypevr
7257
7258@hook TARGET_ASM_FILE_END
7259Output to @code{asm_out_file} any text which the assembler expects
7260to find at the end of a file. The default is to output nothing.
7261@end deftypefn
7262
7263@deftypefun void file_end_indicate_exec_stack ()
7264Some systems use a common convention, the @samp{.note.GNU-stack}
7265special section, to indicate whether or not an object file relies on
7266the stack being executable. If your system uses this convention, you
7267should define @code{TARGET_ASM_FILE_END} to this function. If you
7268need to do other things in that hook, have your hook function call
7269this function.
7270@end deftypefun
7271
7272@hook TARGET_ASM_LTO_START
7273Output to @code{asm_out_file} any text which the assembler expects
7274to find at the start of an LTO section. The default is to output
7275nothing.
7276@end deftypefn
7277
7278@hook TARGET_ASM_LTO_END
7279Output to @code{asm_out_file} any text which the assembler expects
7280to find at the end of an LTO section. The default is to output
7281nothing.
7282@end deftypefn
7283
7284@hook TARGET_ASM_CODE_END
7285Output to @code{asm_out_file} any text which is needed before emitting
7286unwind info and debug info at the end of a file. Some targets emit
7287here PIC setup thunks that cannot be emitted at the end of file,
7288because they couldn't have unwind info then. The default is to output
7289nothing.
7290@end deftypefn
7291
7292@defmac ASM_COMMENT_START
7293A C string constant describing how to begin a comment in the target
7294assembler language. The compiler assumes that the comment will end at
7295the end of the line.
7296@end defmac
7297
7298@defmac ASM_APP_ON
7299A C string constant for text to be output before each @code{asm}
7300statement or group of consecutive ones. Normally this is
7301@code{"#APP"}, which is a comment that has no effect on most
7302assemblers but tells the GNU assembler that it must check the lines
7303that follow for all valid assembler constructs.
7304@end defmac
7305
7306@defmac ASM_APP_OFF
7307A C string constant for text to be output after each @code{asm}
7308statement or group of consecutive ones. Normally this is
7309@code{"#NO_APP"}, which tells the GNU assembler to resume making the
7310time-saving assumptions that are valid for ordinary compiler output.
7311@end defmac
7312
7313@defmac ASM_OUTPUT_SOURCE_FILENAME (@var{stream}, @var{name})
7314A C statement to output COFF information or DWARF debugging information
7315which indicates that filename @var{name} is the current source file to
7316the stdio stream @var{stream}.
7317
7318This macro need not be defined if the standard form of output
7319for the file format in use is appropriate.
7320@end defmac
7321
b5f5d41d
AS
7322@hook TARGET_ASM_OUTPUT_SOURCE_FILENAME
7323
38f8b050
JR
7324@defmac OUTPUT_QUOTED_STRING (@var{stream}, @var{string})
7325A C statement to output the string @var{string} to the stdio stream
7326@var{stream}. If you do not call the function @code{output_quoted_string}
7327in your config files, GCC will only call it to output filenames to
7328the assembler source. So you can use it to canonicalize the format
7329of the filename using this macro.
7330@end defmac
7331
7332@defmac ASM_OUTPUT_IDENT (@var{stream}, @var{string})
7333A C statement to output something to the assembler file to handle a
7334@samp{#ident} directive containing the text @var{string}. If this
7335macro is not defined, nothing is output for a @samp{#ident} directive.
7336@end defmac
7337
7338@hook TARGET_ASM_NAMED_SECTION
7339Output assembly directives to switch to section @var{name}. The section
7340should have attributes as specified by @var{flags}, which is a bit mask
7341of the @code{SECTION_*} flags defined in @file{output.h}. If @var{decl}
7342is non-NULL, it is the @code{VAR_DECL} or @code{FUNCTION_DECL} with which
7343this section is associated.
7344@end deftypefn
7345
7346@hook TARGET_HAVE_NAMED_SECTIONS
7347This flag is true if the target supports @code{TARGET_ASM_NAMED_SECTION}.
7348@end deftypevr
7349
7350@anchor{TARGET_HAVE_SWITCHABLE_BSS_SECTIONS}
7351@hook TARGET_HAVE_SWITCHABLE_BSS_SECTIONS
7352This flag is true if we can create zeroed data by switching to a BSS
7353section and then using @code{ASM_OUTPUT_SKIP} to allocate the space.
7354This is true on most ELF targets.
7355@end deftypevr
7356
7357@hook TARGET_SECTION_TYPE_FLAGS
7358Choose a set of section attributes for use by @code{TARGET_ASM_NAMED_SECTION}
7359based on a variable or function decl, a section name, and whether or not the
7360declaration's initializer may contain runtime relocations. @var{decl} may be
7361null, in which case read-write data should be assumed.
7362
7363The default version of this function handles choosing code vs data,
7364read-only vs read-write data, and @code{flag_pic}. You should only
7365need to override this if your target has special flags that might be
7366set via @code{__attribute__}.
7367@end deftypefn
7368
7369@hook TARGET_ASM_RECORD_GCC_SWITCHES
7370Provides the target with the ability to record the gcc command line
7371switches that have been passed to the compiler, and options that are
7372enabled. The @var{type} argument specifies what is being recorded.
7373It can take the following values:
7374
7375@table @gcctabopt
7376@item SWITCH_TYPE_PASSED
7377@var{text} is a command line switch that has been set by the user.
7378
7379@item SWITCH_TYPE_ENABLED
7380@var{text} is an option which has been enabled. This might be as a
7381direct result of a command line switch, or because it is enabled by
7382default or because it has been enabled as a side effect of a different
7383command line switch. For example, the @option{-O2} switch enables
7384various different individual optimization passes.
7385
7386@item SWITCH_TYPE_DESCRIPTIVE
7387@var{text} is either NULL or some descriptive text which should be
7388ignored. If @var{text} is NULL then it is being used to warn the
7389target hook that either recording is starting or ending. The first
7390time @var{type} is SWITCH_TYPE_DESCRIPTIVE and @var{text} is NULL, the
7391warning is for start up and the second time the warning is for
7392wind down. This feature is to allow the target hook to make any
7393necessary preparations before it starts to record switches and to
7394perform any necessary tidying up after it has finished recording
7395switches.
7396
7397@item SWITCH_TYPE_LINE_START
7398This option can be ignored by this target hook.
7399
7400@item SWITCH_TYPE_LINE_END
7401This option can be ignored by this target hook.
7402@end table
7403
7404The hook's return value must be zero. Other return values may be
7405supported in the future.
7406
7407By default this hook is set to NULL, but an example implementation is
7408provided for ELF based targets. Called @var{elf_record_gcc_switches},
7409it records the switches as ASCII text inside a new, string mergeable
7410section in the assembler output file. The name of the new section is
7411provided by the @code{TARGET_ASM_RECORD_GCC_SWITCHES_SECTION} target
7412hook.
7413@end deftypefn
7414
7415@hook TARGET_ASM_RECORD_GCC_SWITCHES_SECTION
7416This is the name of the section that will be created by the example
7417ELF implementation of the @code{TARGET_ASM_RECORD_GCC_SWITCHES} target
7418hook.
7419@end deftypevr
7420
7421@need 2000
7422@node Data Output
7423@subsection Output of Data
7424
7425
7426@hook TARGET_ASM_BYTE_OP
7427@deftypevrx {Target Hook} {const char *} TARGET_ASM_ALIGNED_HI_OP
7428@deftypevrx {Target Hook} {const char *} TARGET_ASM_ALIGNED_SI_OP
7429@deftypevrx {Target Hook} {const char *} TARGET_ASM_ALIGNED_DI_OP
7430@deftypevrx {Target Hook} {const char *} TARGET_ASM_ALIGNED_TI_OP
7431@deftypevrx {Target Hook} {const char *} TARGET_ASM_UNALIGNED_HI_OP
7432@deftypevrx {Target Hook} {const char *} TARGET_ASM_UNALIGNED_SI_OP
7433@deftypevrx {Target Hook} {const char *} TARGET_ASM_UNALIGNED_DI_OP
7434@deftypevrx {Target Hook} {const char *} TARGET_ASM_UNALIGNED_TI_OP
7435These hooks specify assembly directives for creating certain kinds
7436of integer object. The @code{TARGET_ASM_BYTE_OP} directive creates a
7437byte-sized object, the @code{TARGET_ASM_ALIGNED_HI_OP} one creates an
7438aligned two-byte object, and so on. Any of the hooks may be
7439@code{NULL}, indicating that no suitable directive is available.
7440
7441The compiler will print these strings at the start of a new line,
7442followed immediately by the object's initial value. In most cases,
7443the string should contain a tab, a pseudo-op, and then another tab.
7444@end deftypevr
7445
7446@hook TARGET_ASM_INTEGER
7447The @code{assemble_integer} function uses this hook to output an
7448integer object. @var{x} is the object's value, @var{size} is its size
7449in bytes and @var{aligned_p} indicates whether it is aligned. The
7450function should return @code{true} if it was able to output the
7451object. If it returns false, @code{assemble_integer} will try to
7452split the object into smaller parts.
7453
7454The default implementation of this hook will use the
7455@code{TARGET_ASM_BYTE_OP} family of strings, returning @code{false}
7456when the relevant string is @code{NULL}.
7457@end deftypefn
7458
6cbd8875
AS
7459@hook TARGET_ASM_OUTPUT_ADDR_CONST_EXTRA
7460A target hook to recognize @var{rtx} patterns that @code{output_addr_const}
7461can't deal with, and output assembly code to @var{file} corresponding to
7462the pattern @var{x}. This may be used to allow machine-dependent
7463@code{UNSPEC}s to appear within constants.
7464
7465If target hook fails to recognize a pattern, it must return @code{false},
7466so that a standard error message is printed. If it prints an error message
7467itself, by calling, for example, @code{output_operand_lossage}, it may just
7468return @code{true}.
7469@end deftypefn
7470
38f8b050
JR
7471@defmac OUTPUT_ADDR_CONST_EXTRA (@var{stream}, @var{x}, @var{fail})
7472A C statement to recognize @var{rtx} patterns that
7473@code{output_addr_const} can't deal with, and output assembly code to
7474@var{stream} corresponding to the pattern @var{x}. This may be used to
7475allow machine-dependent @code{UNSPEC}s to appear within constants.
7476
7477If @code{OUTPUT_ADDR_CONST_EXTRA} fails to recognize a pattern, it must
7478@code{goto fail}, so that a standard error message is printed. If it
7479prints an error message itself, by calling, for example,
7480@code{output_operand_lossage}, it may just complete normally.
7481@end defmac
7482
7483@defmac ASM_OUTPUT_ASCII (@var{stream}, @var{ptr}, @var{len})
7484A C statement to output to the stdio stream @var{stream} an assembler
7485instruction to assemble a string constant containing the @var{len}
7486bytes at @var{ptr}. @var{ptr} will be a C expression of type
7487@code{char *} and @var{len} a C expression of type @code{int}.
7488
7489If the assembler has a @code{.ascii} pseudo-op as found in the
7490Berkeley Unix assembler, do not define the macro
7491@code{ASM_OUTPUT_ASCII}.
7492@end defmac
7493
7494@defmac ASM_OUTPUT_FDESC (@var{stream}, @var{decl}, @var{n})
7495A C statement to output word @var{n} of a function descriptor for
7496@var{decl}. This must be defined if @code{TARGET_VTABLE_USES_DESCRIPTORS}
7497is defined, and is otherwise unused.
7498@end defmac
7499
7500@defmac CONSTANT_POOL_BEFORE_FUNCTION
7501You may define this macro as a C expression. You should define the
7502expression to have a nonzero value if GCC should output the constant
7503pool for a function before the code for the function, or a zero value if
7504GCC should output the constant pool after the function. If you do
7505not define this macro, the usual case, GCC will output the constant
7506pool before the function.
7507@end defmac
7508
7509@defmac ASM_OUTPUT_POOL_PROLOGUE (@var{file}, @var{funname}, @var{fundecl}, @var{size})
7510A C statement to output assembler commands to define the start of the
7511constant pool for a function. @var{funname} is a string giving
7512the name of the function. Should the return type of the function
7513be required, it can be obtained via @var{fundecl}. @var{size}
7514is the size, in bytes, of the constant pool that will be written
7515immediately after this call.
7516
7517If no constant-pool prefix is required, the usual case, this macro need
7518not be defined.
7519@end defmac
7520
7521@defmac ASM_OUTPUT_SPECIAL_POOL_ENTRY (@var{file}, @var{x}, @var{mode}, @var{align}, @var{labelno}, @var{jumpto})
7522A C statement (with or without semicolon) to output a constant in the
7523constant pool, if it needs special treatment. (This macro need not do
7524anything for RTL expressions that can be output normally.)
7525
7526The argument @var{file} is the standard I/O stream to output the
7527assembler code on. @var{x} is the RTL expression for the constant to
7528output, and @var{mode} is the machine mode (in case @var{x} is a
7529@samp{const_int}). @var{align} is the required alignment for the value
7530@var{x}; you should output an assembler directive to force this much
7531alignment.
7532
7533The argument @var{labelno} is a number to use in an internal label for
7534the address of this pool entry. The definition of this macro is
7535responsible for outputting the label definition at the proper place.
7536Here is how to do this:
7537
7538@smallexample
7539@code{(*targetm.asm_out.internal_label)} (@var{file}, "LC", @var{labelno});
7540@end smallexample
7541
7542When you output a pool entry specially, you should end with a
7543@code{goto} to the label @var{jumpto}. This will prevent the same pool
7544entry from being output a second time in the usual manner.
7545
7546You need not define this macro if it would do nothing.
7547@end defmac
7548
7549@defmac ASM_OUTPUT_POOL_EPILOGUE (@var{file} @var{funname} @var{fundecl} @var{size})
7550A C statement to output assembler commands to at the end of the constant
7551pool for a function. @var{funname} is a string giving the name of the
7552function. Should the return type of the function be required, you can
7553obtain it via @var{fundecl}. @var{size} is the size, in bytes, of the
7554constant pool that GCC wrote immediately before this call.
7555
7556If no constant-pool epilogue is required, the usual case, you need not
7557define this macro.
7558@end defmac
7559
7560@defmac IS_ASM_LOGICAL_LINE_SEPARATOR (@var{C}, @var{STR})
7561Define this macro as a C expression which is nonzero if @var{C} is
7562used as a logical line separator by the assembler. @var{STR} points
7563to the position in the string where @var{C} was found; this can be used if
7564a line separator uses multiple characters.
7565
7566If you do not define this macro, the default is that only
7567the character @samp{;} is treated as a logical line separator.
7568@end defmac
7569
7570@hook TARGET_ASM_OPEN_PAREN
7571These target hooks are C string constants, describing the syntax in the
7572assembler for grouping arithmetic expressions. If not overridden, they
7573default to normal parentheses, which is correct for most assemblers.
7574@end deftypevr
7575
7576These macros are provided by @file{real.h} for writing the definitions
7577of @code{ASM_OUTPUT_DOUBLE} and the like:
7578
7579@defmac REAL_VALUE_TO_TARGET_SINGLE (@var{x}, @var{l})
7580@defmacx REAL_VALUE_TO_TARGET_DOUBLE (@var{x}, @var{l})
7581@defmacx REAL_VALUE_TO_TARGET_LONG_DOUBLE (@var{x}, @var{l})
7582@defmacx REAL_VALUE_TO_TARGET_DECIMAL32 (@var{x}, @var{l})
7583@defmacx REAL_VALUE_TO_TARGET_DECIMAL64 (@var{x}, @var{l})
7584@defmacx REAL_VALUE_TO_TARGET_DECIMAL128 (@var{x}, @var{l})
7585These translate @var{x}, of type @code{REAL_VALUE_TYPE}, to the
7586target's floating point representation, and store its bit pattern in
7587the variable @var{l}. For @code{REAL_VALUE_TO_TARGET_SINGLE} and
7588@code{REAL_VALUE_TO_TARGET_DECIMAL32}, this variable should be a
7589simple @code{long int}. For the others, it should be an array of
7590@code{long int}. The number of elements in this array is determined
7591by the size of the desired target floating point data type: 32 bits of
7592it go in each @code{long int} array element. Each array element holds
759332 bits of the result, even if @code{long int} is wider than 32 bits
7594on the host machine.
7595
7596The array element values are designed so that you can print them out
7597using @code{fprintf} in the order they should appear in the target
7598machine's memory.
7599@end defmac
7600
7601@node Uninitialized Data
7602@subsection Output of Uninitialized Variables
7603
7604Each of the macros in this section is used to do the whole job of
7605outputting a single uninitialized variable.
7606
7607@defmac ASM_OUTPUT_COMMON (@var{stream}, @var{name}, @var{size}, @var{rounded})
7608A C statement (sans semicolon) to output to the stdio stream
7609@var{stream} the assembler definition of a common-label named
7610@var{name} whose size is @var{size} bytes. The variable @var{rounded}
7611is the size rounded up to whatever alignment the caller wants. It is
7612possible that @var{size} may be zero, for instance if a struct with no
7613other member than a zero-length array is defined. In this case, the
7614backend must output a symbol definition that allocates at least one
7615byte, both so that the address of the resulting object does not compare
7616equal to any other, and because some object formats cannot even express
7617the concept of a zero-sized common symbol, as that is how they represent
7618an ordinary undefined external.
7619
7620Use the expression @code{assemble_name (@var{stream}, @var{name})} to
7621output the name itself; before and after that, output the additional
7622assembler syntax for defining the name, and a newline.
7623
7624This macro controls how the assembler definitions of uninitialized
7625common global variables are output.
7626@end defmac
7627
7628@defmac ASM_OUTPUT_ALIGNED_COMMON (@var{stream}, @var{name}, @var{size}, @var{alignment})
7629Like @code{ASM_OUTPUT_COMMON} except takes the required alignment as a
7630separate, explicit argument. If you define this macro, it is used in
7631place of @code{ASM_OUTPUT_COMMON}, and gives you more flexibility in
7632handling the required alignment of the variable. The alignment is specified
7633as the number of bits.
7634@end defmac
7635
7636@defmac ASM_OUTPUT_ALIGNED_DECL_COMMON (@var{stream}, @var{decl}, @var{name}, @var{size}, @var{alignment})
7637Like @code{ASM_OUTPUT_ALIGNED_COMMON} except that @var{decl} of the
7638variable to be output, if there is one, or @code{NULL_TREE} if there
7639is no corresponding variable. If you define this macro, GCC will use it
7640in place of both @code{ASM_OUTPUT_COMMON} and
7641@code{ASM_OUTPUT_ALIGNED_COMMON}. Define this macro when you need to see
7642the variable's decl in order to chose what to output.
7643@end defmac
7644
7645@defmac ASM_OUTPUT_BSS (@var{stream}, @var{decl}, @var{name}, @var{size}, @var{rounded})
7646A C statement (sans semicolon) to output to the stdio stream
7647@var{stream} the assembler definition of uninitialized global @var{decl} named
7648@var{name} whose size is @var{size} bytes. The variable @var{rounded}
7649is the size rounded up to whatever alignment the caller wants.
7650
7651Try to use function @code{asm_output_bss} defined in @file{varasm.c} when
7652defining this macro. If unable, use the expression
7653@code{assemble_name (@var{stream}, @var{name})} to output the name itself;
7654before and after that, output the additional assembler syntax for defining
7655the name, and a newline.
7656
7657There are two ways of handling global BSS@. One is to define either
7658this macro or its aligned counterpart, @code{ASM_OUTPUT_ALIGNED_BSS}.
7659The other is to have @code{TARGET_ASM_SELECT_SECTION} return a
7660switchable BSS section (@pxref{TARGET_HAVE_SWITCHABLE_BSS_SECTIONS}).
7661You do not need to do both.
7662
7663Some languages do not have @code{common} data, and require a
7664non-common form of global BSS in order to handle uninitialized globals
7665efficiently. C++ is one example of this. However, if the target does
7666not support global BSS, the front end may choose to make globals
7667common in order to save space in the object file.
7668@end defmac
7669
7670@defmac ASM_OUTPUT_ALIGNED_BSS (@var{stream}, @var{decl}, @var{name}, @var{size}, @var{alignment})
7671Like @code{ASM_OUTPUT_BSS} except takes the required alignment as a
7672separate, explicit argument. If you define this macro, it is used in
7673place of @code{ASM_OUTPUT_BSS}, and gives you more flexibility in
7674handling the required alignment of the variable. The alignment is specified
7675as the number of bits.
7676
7677Try to use function @code{asm_output_aligned_bss} defined in file
7678@file{varasm.c} when defining this macro.
7679@end defmac
7680
7681@defmac ASM_OUTPUT_LOCAL (@var{stream}, @var{name}, @var{size}, @var{rounded})
7682A C statement (sans semicolon) to output to the stdio stream
7683@var{stream} the assembler definition of a local-common-label named
7684@var{name} whose size is @var{size} bytes. The variable @var{rounded}
7685is the size rounded up to whatever alignment the caller wants.
7686
7687Use the expression @code{assemble_name (@var{stream}, @var{name})} to
7688output the name itself; before and after that, output the additional
7689assembler syntax for defining the name, and a newline.
7690
7691This macro controls how the assembler definitions of uninitialized
7692static variables are output.
7693@end defmac
7694
7695@defmac ASM_OUTPUT_ALIGNED_LOCAL (@var{stream}, @var{name}, @var{size}, @var{alignment})
7696Like @code{ASM_OUTPUT_LOCAL} except takes the required alignment as a
7697separate, explicit argument. If you define this macro, it is used in
7698place of @code{ASM_OUTPUT_LOCAL}, and gives you more flexibility in
7699handling the required alignment of the variable. The alignment is specified
7700as the number of bits.
7701@end defmac
7702
7703@defmac ASM_OUTPUT_ALIGNED_DECL_LOCAL (@var{stream}, @var{decl}, @var{name}, @var{size}, @var{alignment})
7704Like @code{ASM_OUTPUT_ALIGNED_DECL} except that @var{decl} of the
7705variable to be output, if there is one, or @code{NULL_TREE} if there
7706is no corresponding variable. If you define this macro, GCC will use it
7707in place of both @code{ASM_OUTPUT_DECL} and
7708@code{ASM_OUTPUT_ALIGNED_DECL}. Define this macro when you need to see
7709the variable's decl in order to chose what to output.
7710@end defmac
7711
7712@node Label Output
7713@subsection Output and Generation of Labels
7714
7715@c prevent bad page break with this line
7716This is about outputting labels.
7717
7718@findex assemble_name
7719@defmac ASM_OUTPUT_LABEL (@var{stream}, @var{name})
7720A C statement (sans semicolon) to output to the stdio stream
7721@var{stream} the assembler definition of a label named @var{name}.
7722Use the expression @code{assemble_name (@var{stream}, @var{name})} to
7723output the name itself; before and after that, output the additional
7724assembler syntax for defining the name, and a newline. A default
7725definition of this macro is provided which is correct for most systems.
7726@end defmac
7727
135a687e
KT
7728@defmac ASM_OUTPUT_FUNCTION_LABEL (@var{stream}, @var{name}, @var{decl})
7729A C statement (sans semicolon) to output to the stdio stream
7730@var{stream} the assembler definition of a label named @var{name} of
7731a function.
7732Use the expression @code{assemble_name (@var{stream}, @var{name})} to
7733output the name itself; before and after that, output the additional
7734assembler syntax for defining the name, and a newline. A default
7735definition of this macro is provided which is correct for most systems.
7736
7737If this macro is not defined, then the function name is defined in the
7738usual manner as a label (by means of @code{ASM_OUTPUT_LABEL}).
7739@end defmac
7740
38f8b050
JR
7741@findex assemble_name_raw
7742@defmac ASM_OUTPUT_INTERNAL_LABEL (@var{stream}, @var{name})
7743Identical to @code{ASM_OUTPUT_LABEL}, except that @var{name} is known
7744to refer to a compiler-generated label. The default definition uses
7745@code{assemble_name_raw}, which is like @code{assemble_name} except
7746that it is more efficient.
7747@end defmac
7748
7749@defmac SIZE_ASM_OP
7750A C string containing the appropriate assembler directive to specify the
7751size of a symbol, without any arguments. On systems that use ELF, the
7752default (in @file{config/elfos.h}) is @samp{"\t.size\t"}; on other
7753systems, the default is not to define this macro.
7754
7755Define this macro only if it is correct to use the default definitions
7756of @code{ASM_OUTPUT_SIZE_DIRECTIVE} and @code{ASM_OUTPUT_MEASURED_SIZE}
7757for your system. If you need your own custom definitions of those
7758macros, or if you do not need explicit symbol sizes at all, do not
7759define this macro.
7760@end defmac
7761
7762@defmac ASM_OUTPUT_SIZE_DIRECTIVE (@var{stream}, @var{name}, @var{size})
7763A C statement (sans semicolon) to output to the stdio stream
7764@var{stream} a directive telling the assembler that the size of the
7765symbol @var{name} is @var{size}. @var{size} is a @code{HOST_WIDE_INT}.
7766If you define @code{SIZE_ASM_OP}, a default definition of this macro is
7767provided.
7768@end defmac
7769
7770@defmac ASM_OUTPUT_MEASURED_SIZE (@var{stream}, @var{name})
7771A C statement (sans semicolon) to output to the stdio stream
7772@var{stream} a directive telling the assembler to calculate the size of
7773the symbol @var{name} by subtracting its address from the current
7774address.
7775
7776If you define @code{SIZE_ASM_OP}, a default definition of this macro is
7777provided. The default assumes that the assembler recognizes a special
7778@samp{.} symbol as referring to the current address, and can calculate
7779the difference between this and another symbol. If your assembler does
7780not recognize @samp{.} or cannot do calculations with it, you will need
7781to redefine @code{ASM_OUTPUT_MEASURED_SIZE} to use some other technique.
7782@end defmac
7783
7784@defmac TYPE_ASM_OP
7785A C string containing the appropriate assembler directive to specify the
7786type of a symbol, without any arguments. On systems that use ELF, the
7787default (in @file{config/elfos.h}) is @samp{"\t.type\t"}; on other
7788systems, the default is not to define this macro.
7789
7790Define this macro only if it is correct to use the default definition of
7791@code{ASM_OUTPUT_TYPE_DIRECTIVE} for your system. If you need your own
7792custom definition of this macro, or if you do not need explicit symbol
7793types at all, do not define this macro.
7794@end defmac
7795
7796@defmac TYPE_OPERAND_FMT
7797A C string which specifies (using @code{printf} syntax) the format of
7798the second operand to @code{TYPE_ASM_OP}. On systems that use ELF, the
7799default (in @file{config/elfos.h}) is @samp{"@@%s"}; on other systems,
7800the default is not to define this macro.
7801
7802Define this macro only if it is correct to use the default definition of
7803@code{ASM_OUTPUT_TYPE_DIRECTIVE} for your system. If you need your own
7804custom definition of this macro, or if you do not need explicit symbol
7805types at all, do not define this macro.
7806@end defmac
7807
7808@defmac ASM_OUTPUT_TYPE_DIRECTIVE (@var{stream}, @var{type})
7809A C statement (sans semicolon) to output to the stdio stream
7810@var{stream} a directive telling the assembler that the type of the
7811symbol @var{name} is @var{type}. @var{type} is a C string; currently,
7812that string is always either @samp{"function"} or @samp{"object"}, but
7813you should not count on this.
7814
7815If you define @code{TYPE_ASM_OP} and @code{TYPE_OPERAND_FMT}, a default
7816definition of this macro is provided.
7817@end defmac
7818
7819@defmac ASM_DECLARE_FUNCTION_NAME (@var{stream}, @var{name}, @var{decl})
7820A C statement (sans semicolon) to output to the stdio stream
7821@var{stream} any text necessary for declaring the name @var{name} of a
7822function which is being defined. This macro is responsible for
7823outputting the label definition (perhaps using
135a687e 7824@code{ASM_OUTPUT_FUNCTION_LABEL}). The argument @var{decl} is the
38f8b050
JR
7825@code{FUNCTION_DECL} tree node representing the function.
7826
7827If this macro is not defined, then the function name is defined in the
135a687e 7828usual manner as a label (by means of @code{ASM_OUTPUT_FUNCTION_LABEL}).
38f8b050
JR
7829
7830You may wish to use @code{ASM_OUTPUT_TYPE_DIRECTIVE} in the definition
7831of this macro.
7832@end defmac
7833
7834@defmac ASM_DECLARE_FUNCTION_SIZE (@var{stream}, @var{name}, @var{decl})
7835A C statement (sans semicolon) to output to the stdio stream
7836@var{stream} any text necessary for declaring the size of a function
7837which is being defined. The argument @var{name} is the name of the
7838function. The argument @var{decl} is the @code{FUNCTION_DECL} tree node
7839representing the function.
7840
7841If this macro is not defined, then the function size is not defined.
7842
7843You may wish to use @code{ASM_OUTPUT_MEASURED_SIZE} in the definition
7844of this macro.
7845@end defmac
7846
7847@defmac ASM_DECLARE_OBJECT_NAME (@var{stream}, @var{name}, @var{decl})
7848A C statement (sans semicolon) to output to the stdio stream
7849@var{stream} any text necessary for declaring the name @var{name} of an
7850initialized variable which is being defined. This macro must output the
7851label definition (perhaps using @code{ASM_OUTPUT_LABEL}). The argument
7852@var{decl} is the @code{VAR_DECL} tree node representing the variable.
7853
7854If this macro is not defined, then the variable name is defined in the
7855usual manner as a label (by means of @code{ASM_OUTPUT_LABEL}).
7856
7857You may wish to use @code{ASM_OUTPUT_TYPE_DIRECTIVE} and/or
7858@code{ASM_OUTPUT_SIZE_DIRECTIVE} in the definition of this macro.
7859@end defmac
7860
ad78130c 7861@hook TARGET_ASM_DECLARE_CONSTANT_NAME
38f8b050
JR
7862A target hook to output to the stdio stream @var{file} any text necessary
7863for declaring the name @var{name} of a constant which is being defined. This
7864target hook is responsible for outputting the label definition (perhaps using
7865@code{assemble_label}). The argument @var{exp} is the value of the constant,
7866and @var{size} is the size of the constant in bytes. The @var{name}
7867will be an internal label.
7868
7869The default version of this target hook, define the @var{name} in the
7870usual manner as a label (by means of @code{assemble_label}).
7871
7872You may wish to use @code{ASM_OUTPUT_TYPE_DIRECTIVE} in this target hook.
7873@end deftypefn
7874
7875@defmac ASM_DECLARE_REGISTER_GLOBAL (@var{stream}, @var{decl}, @var{regno}, @var{name})
7876A C statement (sans semicolon) to output to the stdio stream
7877@var{stream} any text necessary for claiming a register @var{regno}
7878for a global variable @var{decl} with name @var{name}.
7879
7880If you don't define this macro, that is equivalent to defining it to do
7881nothing.
7882@end defmac
7883
7884@defmac ASM_FINISH_DECLARE_OBJECT (@var{stream}, @var{decl}, @var{toplevel}, @var{atend})
7885A C statement (sans semicolon) to finish up declaring a variable name
7886once the compiler has processed its initializer fully and thus has had a
7887chance to determine the size of an array when controlled by an
7888initializer. This is used on systems where it's necessary to declare
7889something about the size of the object.
7890
7891If you don't define this macro, that is equivalent to defining it to do
7892nothing.
7893
7894You may wish to use @code{ASM_OUTPUT_SIZE_DIRECTIVE} and/or
7895@code{ASM_OUTPUT_MEASURED_SIZE} in the definition of this macro.
7896@end defmac
7897
7898@hook TARGET_ASM_GLOBALIZE_LABEL
7899This target hook is a function to output to the stdio stream
7900@var{stream} some commands that will make the label @var{name} global;
7901that is, available for reference from other files.
7902
7903The default implementation relies on a proper definition of
7904@code{GLOBAL_ASM_OP}.
7905@end deftypefn
7906
7907@hook TARGET_ASM_GLOBALIZE_DECL_NAME
7908This target hook is a function to output to the stdio stream
7909@var{stream} some commands that will make the name associated with @var{decl}
7910global; that is, available for reference from other files.
7911
7912The default implementation uses the TARGET_ASM_GLOBALIZE_LABEL target hook.
7913@end deftypefn
7914
7915@defmac ASM_WEAKEN_LABEL (@var{stream}, @var{name})
7916A C statement (sans semicolon) to output to the stdio stream
7917@var{stream} some commands that will make the label @var{name} weak;
7918that is, available for reference from other files but only used if
7919no other definition is available. Use the expression
7920@code{assemble_name (@var{stream}, @var{name})} to output the name
7921itself; before and after that, output the additional assembler syntax
7922for making that name weak, and a newline.
7923
7924If you don't define this macro or @code{ASM_WEAKEN_DECL}, GCC will not
7925support weak symbols and you should not define the @code{SUPPORTS_WEAK}
7926macro.
7927@end defmac
7928
7929@defmac ASM_WEAKEN_DECL (@var{stream}, @var{decl}, @var{name}, @var{value})
7930Combines (and replaces) the function of @code{ASM_WEAKEN_LABEL} and
7931@code{ASM_OUTPUT_WEAK_ALIAS}, allowing access to the associated function
7932or variable decl. If @var{value} is not @code{NULL}, this C statement
7933should output to the stdio stream @var{stream} assembler code which
7934defines (equates) the weak symbol @var{name} to have the value
7935@var{value}. If @var{value} is @code{NULL}, it should output commands
7936to make @var{name} weak.
7937@end defmac
7938
7939@defmac ASM_OUTPUT_WEAKREF (@var{stream}, @var{decl}, @var{name}, @var{value})
7940Outputs a directive that enables @var{name} to be used to refer to
7941symbol @var{value} with weak-symbol semantics. @code{decl} is the
7942declaration of @code{name}.
7943@end defmac
7944
7945@defmac SUPPORTS_WEAK
74b90fe2
JDA
7946A preprocessor constant expression which evaluates to true if the target
7947supports weak symbols.
38f8b050
JR
7948
7949If you don't define this macro, @file{defaults.h} provides a default
7950definition. If either @code{ASM_WEAKEN_LABEL} or @code{ASM_WEAKEN_DECL}
74b90fe2
JDA
7951is defined, the default definition is @samp{1}; otherwise, it is @samp{0}.
7952@end defmac
7953
7954@defmac TARGET_SUPPORTS_WEAK
7955A C expression which evaluates to true if the target supports weak symbols.
7956
7957If you don't define this macro, @file{defaults.h} provides a default
7958definition. The default definition is @samp{(SUPPORTS_WEAK)}. Define
7959this macro if you want to control weak symbol support with a compiler
7960flag such as @option{-melf}.
38f8b050
JR
7961@end defmac
7962
7963@defmac MAKE_DECL_ONE_ONLY (@var{decl})
7964A C statement (sans semicolon) to mark @var{decl} to be emitted as a
7965public symbol such that extra copies in multiple translation units will
7966be discarded by the linker. Define this macro if your object file
7967format provides support for this concept, such as the @samp{COMDAT}
7968section flags in the Microsoft Windows PE/COFF format, and this support
7969requires changes to @var{decl}, such as putting it in a separate section.
7970@end defmac
7971
7972@defmac SUPPORTS_ONE_ONLY
7973A C expression which evaluates to true if the target supports one-only
7974semantics.
7975
7976If you don't define this macro, @file{varasm.c} provides a default
7977definition. If @code{MAKE_DECL_ONE_ONLY} is defined, the default
7978definition is @samp{1}; otherwise, it is @samp{0}. Define this macro if
7979you want to control one-only symbol support with a compiler flag, or if
7980setting the @code{DECL_ONE_ONLY} flag is enough to mark a declaration to
7981be emitted as one-only.
7982@end defmac
7983
7984@hook TARGET_ASM_ASSEMBLE_VISIBILITY
7985This target hook is a function to output to @var{asm_out_file} some
7986commands that will make the symbol(s) associated with @var{decl} have
7987hidden, protected or internal visibility as specified by @var{visibility}.
7988@end deftypefn
7989
7990@defmac TARGET_WEAK_NOT_IN_ARCHIVE_TOC
7991A C expression that evaluates to true if the target's linker expects
7992that weak symbols do not appear in a static archive's table of contents.
7993The default is @code{0}.
7994
7995Leaving weak symbols out of an archive's table of contents means that,
7996if a symbol will only have a definition in one translation unit and
7997will have undefined references from other translation units, that
7998symbol should not be weak. Defining this macro to be nonzero will
7999thus have the effect that certain symbols that would normally be weak
8000(explicit template instantiations, and vtables for polymorphic classes
8001with noninline key methods) will instead be nonweak.
8002
8003The C++ ABI requires this macro to be zero. Define this macro for
8004targets where full C++ ABI compliance is impossible and where linker
8005restrictions require weak symbols to be left out of a static archive's
8006table of contents.
8007@end defmac
8008
8009@defmac ASM_OUTPUT_EXTERNAL (@var{stream}, @var{decl}, @var{name})
8010A C statement (sans semicolon) to output to the stdio stream
8011@var{stream} any text necessary for declaring the name of an external
8012symbol named @var{name} which is referenced in this compilation but
8013not defined. The value of @var{decl} is the tree node for the
8014declaration.
8015
8016This macro need not be defined if it does not need to output anything.
8017The GNU assembler and most Unix assemblers don't require anything.
8018@end defmac
8019
8020@hook TARGET_ASM_EXTERNAL_LIBCALL
8021This target hook is a function to output to @var{asm_out_file} an assembler
8022pseudo-op to declare a library function name external. The name of the
8023library function is given by @var{symref}, which is a @code{symbol_ref}.
8024@end deftypefn
8025
8026@hook TARGET_ASM_MARK_DECL_PRESERVED
8027This target hook is a function to output to @var{asm_out_file} an assembler
8028directive to annotate @var{symbol} as used. The Darwin target uses the
8029.no_dead_code_strip directive.
8030@end deftypefn
8031
8032@defmac ASM_OUTPUT_LABELREF (@var{stream}, @var{name})
8033A C statement (sans semicolon) to output to the stdio stream
8034@var{stream} a reference in assembler syntax to a label named
8035@var{name}. This should add @samp{_} to the front of the name, if that
8036is customary on your operating system, as it is in most Berkeley Unix
8037systems. This macro is used in @code{assemble_name}.
8038@end defmac
8039
8040@defmac ASM_OUTPUT_SYMBOL_REF (@var{stream}, @var{sym})
8041A C statement (sans semicolon) to output a reference to
8042@code{SYMBOL_REF} @var{sym}. If not defined, @code{assemble_name}
8043will be used to output the name of the symbol. This macro may be used
8044to modify the way a symbol is referenced depending on information
8045encoded by @code{TARGET_ENCODE_SECTION_INFO}.
8046@end defmac
8047
8048@defmac ASM_OUTPUT_LABEL_REF (@var{stream}, @var{buf})
8049A C statement (sans semicolon) to output a reference to @var{buf}, the
8050result of @code{ASM_GENERATE_INTERNAL_LABEL}. If not defined,
8051@code{assemble_name} will be used to output the name of the symbol.
8052This macro is not used by @code{output_asm_label}, or the @code{%l}
8053specifier that calls it; the intention is that this macro should be set
8054when it is necessary to output a label differently when its address is
8055being taken.
8056@end defmac
8057
8058@hook TARGET_ASM_INTERNAL_LABEL
8059A function to output to the stdio stream @var{stream} a label whose
8060name is made from the string @var{prefix} and the number @var{labelno}.
8061
8062It is absolutely essential that these labels be distinct from the labels
8063used for user-level functions and variables. Otherwise, certain programs
8064will have name conflicts with internal labels.
8065
8066It is desirable to exclude internal labels from the symbol table of the
8067object file. Most assemblers have a naming convention for labels that
8068should be excluded; on many systems, the letter @samp{L} at the
8069beginning of a label has this effect. You should find out what
8070convention your system uses, and follow it.
8071
8072The default version of this function utilizes @code{ASM_GENERATE_INTERNAL_LABEL}.
8073@end deftypefn
8074
8075@defmac ASM_OUTPUT_DEBUG_LABEL (@var{stream}, @var{prefix}, @var{num})
8076A C statement to output to the stdio stream @var{stream} a debug info
8077label whose name is made from the string @var{prefix} and the number
8078@var{num}. This is useful for VLIW targets, where debug info labels
8079may need to be treated differently than branch target labels. On some
8080systems, branch target labels must be at the beginning of instruction
8081bundles, but debug info labels can occur in the middle of instruction
8082bundles.
8083
8084If this macro is not defined, then @code{(*targetm.asm_out.internal_label)} will be
8085used.
8086@end defmac
8087
8088@defmac ASM_GENERATE_INTERNAL_LABEL (@var{string}, @var{prefix}, @var{num})
8089A C statement to store into the string @var{string} a label whose name
8090is made from the string @var{prefix} and the number @var{num}.
8091
8092This string, when output subsequently by @code{assemble_name}, should
8093produce the output that @code{(*targetm.asm_out.internal_label)} would produce
8094with the same @var{prefix} and @var{num}.
8095
8096If the string begins with @samp{*}, then @code{assemble_name} will
8097output the rest of the string unchanged. It is often convenient for
8098@code{ASM_GENERATE_INTERNAL_LABEL} to use @samp{*} in this way. If the
8099string doesn't start with @samp{*}, then @code{ASM_OUTPUT_LABELREF} gets
8100to output the string, and may change it. (Of course,
8101@code{ASM_OUTPUT_LABELREF} is also part of your machine description, so
8102you should know what it does on your machine.)
8103@end defmac
8104
8105@defmac ASM_FORMAT_PRIVATE_NAME (@var{outvar}, @var{name}, @var{number})
8106A C expression to assign to @var{outvar} (which is a variable of type
8107@code{char *}) a newly allocated string made from the string
8108@var{name} and the number @var{number}, with some suitable punctuation
8109added. Use @code{alloca} to get space for the string.
8110
8111The string will be used as an argument to @code{ASM_OUTPUT_LABELREF} to
8112produce an assembler label for an internal static variable whose name is
8113@var{name}. Therefore, the string must be such as to result in valid
8114assembler code. The argument @var{number} is different each time this
8115macro is executed; it prevents conflicts between similarly-named
8116internal static variables in different scopes.
8117
8118Ideally this string should not be a valid C identifier, to prevent any
8119conflict with the user's own symbols. Most assemblers allow periods
8120or percent signs in assembler symbols; putting at least one of these
8121between the name and the number will suffice.
8122
8123If this macro is not defined, a default definition will be provided
8124which is correct for most systems.
8125@end defmac
8126
8127@defmac ASM_OUTPUT_DEF (@var{stream}, @var{name}, @var{value})
8128A C statement to output to the stdio stream @var{stream} assembler code
8129which defines (equates) the symbol @var{name} to have the value @var{value}.
8130
8131@findex SET_ASM_OP
8132If @code{SET_ASM_OP} is defined, a default definition is provided which is
8133correct for most systems.
8134@end defmac
8135
8136@defmac ASM_OUTPUT_DEF_FROM_DECLS (@var{stream}, @var{decl_of_name}, @var{decl_of_value})
8137A C statement to output to the stdio stream @var{stream} assembler code
8138which defines (equates) the symbol whose tree node is @var{decl_of_name}
8139to have the value of the tree node @var{decl_of_value}. This macro will
8140be used in preference to @samp{ASM_OUTPUT_DEF} if it is defined and if
8141the tree nodes are available.
8142
8143@findex SET_ASM_OP
8144If @code{SET_ASM_OP} is defined, a default definition is provided which is
8145correct for most systems.
8146@end defmac
8147
8148@defmac TARGET_DEFERRED_OUTPUT_DEFS (@var{decl_of_name}, @var{decl_of_value})
8149A C statement that evaluates to true if the assembler code which defines
8150(equates) the symbol whose tree node is @var{decl_of_name} to have the value
8151of the tree node @var{decl_of_value} should be emitted near the end of the
8152current compilation unit. The default is to not defer output of defines.
8153This macro affects defines output by @samp{ASM_OUTPUT_DEF} and
8154@samp{ASM_OUTPUT_DEF_FROM_DECLS}.
8155@end defmac
8156
8157@defmac ASM_OUTPUT_WEAK_ALIAS (@var{stream}, @var{name}, @var{value})
8158A C statement to output to the stdio stream @var{stream} assembler code
8159which defines (equates) the weak symbol @var{name} to have the value
8160@var{value}. If @var{value} is @code{NULL}, it defines @var{name} as
8161an undefined weak symbol.
8162
8163Define this macro if the target only supports weak aliases; define
8164@code{ASM_OUTPUT_DEF} instead if possible.
8165@end defmac
8166
8167@defmac OBJC_GEN_METHOD_LABEL (@var{buf}, @var{is_inst}, @var{class_name}, @var{cat_name}, @var{sel_name})
8168Define this macro to override the default assembler names used for
8169Objective-C methods.
8170
8171The default name is a unique method number followed by the name of the
8172class (e.g.@: @samp{_1_Foo}). For methods in categories, the name of
8173the category is also included in the assembler name (e.g.@:
8174@samp{_1_Foo_Bar}).
8175
8176These names are safe on most systems, but make debugging difficult since
8177the method's selector is not present in the name. Therefore, particular
8178systems define other ways of computing names.
8179
8180@var{buf} is an expression of type @code{char *} which gives you a
8181buffer in which to store the name; its length is as long as
8182@var{class_name}, @var{cat_name} and @var{sel_name} put together, plus
818350 characters extra.
8184
8185The argument @var{is_inst} specifies whether the method is an instance
8186method or a class method; @var{class_name} is the name of the class;
8187@var{cat_name} is the name of the category (or @code{NULL} if the method is not
8188in a category); and @var{sel_name} is the name of the selector.
8189
8190On systems where the assembler can handle quoted names, you can use this
8191macro to provide more human-readable names.
8192@end defmac
8193
8194@defmac ASM_DECLARE_CLASS_REFERENCE (@var{stream}, @var{name})
8195A C statement (sans semicolon) to output to the stdio stream
8196@var{stream} commands to declare that the label @var{name} is an
8197Objective-C class reference. This is only needed for targets whose
8198linkers have special support for NeXT-style runtimes.
8199@end defmac
8200
8201@defmac ASM_DECLARE_UNRESOLVED_REFERENCE (@var{stream}, @var{name})
8202A C statement (sans semicolon) to output to the stdio stream
8203@var{stream} commands to declare that the label @var{name} is an
8204unresolved Objective-C class reference. This is only needed for targets
8205whose linkers have special support for NeXT-style runtimes.
8206@end defmac
8207
8208@node Initialization
8209@subsection How Initialization Functions Are Handled
8210@cindex initialization routines
8211@cindex termination routines
8212@cindex constructors, output of
8213@cindex destructors, output of
8214
8215The compiled code for certain languages includes @dfn{constructors}
8216(also called @dfn{initialization routines})---functions to initialize
8217data in the program when the program is started. These functions need
8218to be called before the program is ``started''---that is to say, before
8219@code{main} is called.
8220
8221Compiling some languages generates @dfn{destructors} (also called
8222@dfn{termination routines}) that should be called when the program
8223terminates.
8224
8225To make the initialization and termination functions work, the compiler
8226must output something in the assembler code to cause those functions to
8227be called at the appropriate time. When you port the compiler to a new
8228system, you need to specify how to do this.
8229
8230There are two major ways that GCC currently supports the execution of
8231initialization and termination functions. Each way has two variants.
8232Much of the structure is common to all four variations.
8233
8234@findex __CTOR_LIST__
8235@findex __DTOR_LIST__
8236The linker must build two lists of these functions---a list of
8237initialization functions, called @code{__CTOR_LIST__}, and a list of
8238termination functions, called @code{__DTOR_LIST__}.
8239
8240Each list always begins with an ignored function pointer (which may hold
82410, @minus{}1, or a count of the function pointers after it, depending on
8242the environment). This is followed by a series of zero or more function
8243pointers to constructors (or destructors), followed by a function
8244pointer containing zero.
8245
8246Depending on the operating system and its executable file format, either
8247@file{crtstuff.c} or @file{libgcc2.c} traverses these lists at startup
8248time and exit time. Constructors are called in reverse order of the
8249list; destructors in forward order.
8250
8251The best way to handle static constructors works only for object file
8252formats which provide arbitrarily-named sections. A section is set
8253aside for a list of constructors, and another for a list of destructors.
8254Traditionally these are called @samp{.ctors} and @samp{.dtors}. Each
8255object file that defines an initialization function also puts a word in
8256the constructor section to point to that function. The linker
8257accumulates all these words into one contiguous @samp{.ctors} section.
8258Termination functions are handled similarly.
8259
8260This method will be chosen as the default by @file{target-def.h} if
8261@code{TARGET_ASM_NAMED_SECTION} is defined. A target that does not
8262support arbitrary sections, but does support special designated
8263constructor and destructor sections may define @code{CTORS_SECTION_ASM_OP}
8264and @code{DTORS_SECTION_ASM_OP} to achieve the same effect.
8265
8266When arbitrary sections are available, there are two variants, depending
8267upon how the code in @file{crtstuff.c} is called. On systems that
8268support a @dfn{.init} section which is executed at program startup,
8269parts of @file{crtstuff.c} are compiled into that section. The
8270program is linked by the @command{gcc} driver like this:
8271
8272@smallexample
8273ld -o @var{output_file} crti.o crtbegin.o @dots{} -lgcc crtend.o crtn.o
8274@end smallexample
8275
8276The prologue of a function (@code{__init}) appears in the @code{.init}
8277section of @file{crti.o}; the epilogue appears in @file{crtn.o}. Likewise
8278for the function @code{__fini} in the @dfn{.fini} section. Normally these
8279files are provided by the operating system or by the GNU C library, but
8280are provided by GCC for a few targets.
8281
8282The objects @file{crtbegin.o} and @file{crtend.o} are (for most targets)
8283compiled from @file{crtstuff.c}. They contain, among other things, code
8284fragments within the @code{.init} and @code{.fini} sections that branch
8285to routines in the @code{.text} section. The linker will pull all parts
8286of a section together, which results in a complete @code{__init} function
8287that invokes the routines we need at startup.
8288
8289To use this variant, you must define the @code{INIT_SECTION_ASM_OP}
8290macro properly.
8291
8292If no init section is available, when GCC compiles any function called
8293@code{main} (or more accurately, any function designated as a program
8294entry point by the language front end calling @code{expand_main_function}),
8295it inserts a procedure call to @code{__main} as the first executable code
8296after the function prologue. The @code{__main} function is defined
8297in @file{libgcc2.c} and runs the global constructors.
8298
8299In file formats that don't support arbitrary sections, there are again
8300two variants. In the simplest variant, the GNU linker (GNU @code{ld})
8301and an `a.out' format must be used. In this case,
8302@code{TARGET_ASM_CONSTRUCTOR} is defined to produce a @code{.stabs}
8303entry of type @samp{N_SETT}, referencing the name @code{__CTOR_LIST__},
8304and with the address of the void function containing the initialization
8305code as its value. The GNU linker recognizes this as a request to add
8306the value to a @dfn{set}; the values are accumulated, and are eventually
8307placed in the executable as a vector in the format described above, with
8308a leading (ignored) count and a trailing zero element.
8309@code{TARGET_ASM_DESTRUCTOR} is handled similarly. Since no init
8310section is available, the absence of @code{INIT_SECTION_ASM_OP} causes
8311the compilation of @code{main} to call @code{__main} as above, starting
8312the initialization process.
8313
8314The last variant uses neither arbitrary sections nor the GNU linker.
8315This is preferable when you want to do dynamic linking and when using
8316file formats which the GNU linker does not support, such as `ECOFF'@. In
8317this case, @code{TARGET_HAVE_CTORS_DTORS} is false, initialization and
8318termination functions are recognized simply by their names. This requires
8319an extra program in the linkage step, called @command{collect2}. This program
8320pretends to be the linker, for use with GCC; it does its job by running
8321the ordinary linker, but also arranges to include the vectors of
8322initialization and termination functions. These functions are called
8323via @code{__main} as described above. In order to use this method,
8324@code{use_collect2} must be defined in the target in @file{config.gcc}.
8325
8326@ifinfo
8327The following section describes the specific macros that control and
8328customize the handling of initialization and termination functions.
8329@end ifinfo
8330
8331@node Macros for Initialization
8332@subsection Macros Controlling Initialization Routines
8333
8334Here are the macros that control how the compiler handles initialization
8335and termination functions:
8336
8337@defmac INIT_SECTION_ASM_OP
8338If defined, a C string constant, including spacing, for the assembler
8339operation to identify the following data as initialization code. If not
8340defined, GCC will assume such a section does not exist. When you are
8341using special sections for initialization and termination functions, this
8342macro also controls how @file{crtstuff.c} and @file{libgcc2.c} arrange to
8343run the initialization functions.
8344@end defmac
8345
8346@defmac HAS_INIT_SECTION
8347If defined, @code{main} will not call @code{__main} as described above.
8348This macro should be defined for systems that control start-up code
8349on a symbol-by-symbol basis, such as OSF/1, and should not
8350be defined explicitly for systems that support @code{INIT_SECTION_ASM_OP}.
8351@end defmac
8352
8353@defmac LD_INIT_SWITCH
8354If defined, a C string constant for a switch that tells the linker that
8355the following symbol is an initialization routine.
8356@end defmac
8357
8358@defmac LD_FINI_SWITCH
8359If defined, a C string constant for a switch that tells the linker that
8360the following symbol is a finalization routine.
8361@end defmac
8362
8363@defmac COLLECT_SHARED_INIT_FUNC (@var{stream}, @var{func})
8364If defined, a C statement that will write a function that can be
8365automatically called when a shared library is loaded. The function
8366should call @var{func}, which takes no arguments. If not defined, and
8367the object format requires an explicit initialization function, then a
8368function called @code{_GLOBAL__DI} will be generated.
8369
8370This function and the following one are used by collect2 when linking a
8371shared library that needs constructors or destructors, or has DWARF2
8372exception tables embedded in the code.
8373@end defmac
8374
8375@defmac COLLECT_SHARED_FINI_FUNC (@var{stream}, @var{func})
8376If defined, a C statement that will write a function that can be
8377automatically called when a shared library is unloaded. The function
8378should call @var{func}, which takes no arguments. If not defined, and
8379the object format requires an explicit finalization function, then a
8380function called @code{_GLOBAL__DD} will be generated.
8381@end defmac
8382
8383@defmac INVOKE__main
8384If defined, @code{main} will call @code{__main} despite the presence of
8385@code{INIT_SECTION_ASM_OP}. This macro should be defined for systems
8386where the init section is not actually run automatically, but is still
8387useful for collecting the lists of constructors and destructors.
8388@end defmac
8389
8390@defmac SUPPORTS_INIT_PRIORITY
8391If nonzero, the C++ @code{init_priority} attribute is supported and the
8392compiler should emit instructions to control the order of initialization
8393of objects. If zero, the compiler will issue an error message upon
8394encountering an @code{init_priority} attribute.
8395@end defmac
8396
8397@hook TARGET_HAVE_CTORS_DTORS
8398This value is true if the target supports some ``native'' method of
8399collecting constructors and destructors to be run at startup and exit.
8400It is false if we must use @command{collect2}.
8401@end deftypevr
8402
8403@hook TARGET_ASM_CONSTRUCTOR
8404If defined, a function that outputs assembler code to arrange to call
8405the function referenced by @var{symbol} at initialization time.
8406
8407Assume that @var{symbol} is a @code{SYMBOL_REF} for a function taking
8408no arguments and with no return value. If the target supports initialization
8409priorities, @var{priority} is a value between 0 and @code{MAX_INIT_PRIORITY};
8410otherwise it must be @code{DEFAULT_INIT_PRIORITY}.
8411
8412If this macro is not defined by the target, a suitable default will
8413be chosen if (1) the target supports arbitrary section names, (2) the
8414target defines @code{CTORS_SECTION_ASM_OP}, or (3) @code{USE_COLLECT2}
8415is not defined.
8416@end deftypefn
8417
8418@hook TARGET_ASM_DESTRUCTOR
8419This is like @code{TARGET_ASM_CONSTRUCTOR} but used for termination
8420functions rather than initialization functions.
8421@end deftypefn
8422
8423If @code{TARGET_HAVE_CTORS_DTORS} is true, the initialization routine
8424generated for the generated object file will have static linkage.
8425
8426If your system uses @command{collect2} as the means of processing
8427constructors, then that program normally uses @command{nm} to scan
8428an object file for constructor functions to be called.
8429
8430On certain kinds of systems, you can define this macro to make
8431@command{collect2} work faster (and, in some cases, make it work at all):
8432
8433@defmac OBJECT_FORMAT_COFF
8434Define this macro if the system uses COFF (Common Object File Format)
8435object files, so that @command{collect2} can assume this format and scan
8436object files directly for dynamic constructor/destructor functions.
8437
8438This macro is effective only in a native compiler; @command{collect2} as
8439part of a cross compiler always uses @command{nm} for the target machine.
8440@end defmac
8441
8442@defmac REAL_NM_FILE_NAME
8443Define this macro as a C string constant containing the file name to use
8444to execute @command{nm}. The default is to search the path normally for
8445@command{nm}.
8446
8447If your system supports shared libraries and has a program to list the
8448dynamic dependencies of a given library or executable, you can define
8449these macros to enable support for running initialization and
8450termination functions in shared libraries:
8451@end defmac
8452
8453@defmac LDD_SUFFIX
8454Define this macro to a C string constant containing the name of the program
8455which lists dynamic dependencies, like @command{"ldd"} under SunOS 4.
8456@end defmac
8457
8458@defmac PARSE_LDD_OUTPUT (@var{ptr})
8459Define this macro to be C code that extracts filenames from the output
8460of the program denoted by @code{LDD_SUFFIX}. @var{ptr} is a variable
8461of type @code{char *} that points to the beginning of a line of output
8462from @code{LDD_SUFFIX}. If the line lists a dynamic dependency, the
8463code must advance @var{ptr} to the beginning of the filename on that
8464line. Otherwise, it must set @var{ptr} to @code{NULL}.
8465@end defmac
8466
8467@defmac SHLIB_SUFFIX
8468Define this macro to a C string constant containing the default shared
8469library extension of the target (e.g., @samp{".so"}). @command{collect2}
8470strips version information after this suffix when generating global
8471constructor and destructor names. This define is only needed on targets
8472that use @command{collect2} to process constructors and destructors.
8473@end defmac
8474
8475@node Instruction Output
8476@subsection Output of Assembler Instructions
8477
8478@c prevent bad page break with this line
8479This describes assembler instruction output.
8480
8481@defmac REGISTER_NAMES
8482A C initializer containing the assembler's names for the machine
8483registers, each one as a C string constant. This is what translates
8484register numbers in the compiler into assembler language.
8485@end defmac
8486
8487@defmac ADDITIONAL_REGISTER_NAMES
8488If defined, a C initializer for an array of structures containing a name
8489and a register number. This macro defines additional names for hard
8490registers, thus allowing the @code{asm} option in declarations to refer
8491to registers using alternate names.
8492@end defmac
8493
8494@defmac ASM_OUTPUT_OPCODE (@var{stream}, @var{ptr})
8495Define this macro if you are using an unusual assembler that
8496requires different names for the machine instructions.
8497
8498The definition is a C statement or statements which output an
8499assembler instruction opcode to the stdio stream @var{stream}. The
8500macro-operand @var{ptr} is a variable of type @code{char *} which
8501points to the opcode name in its ``internal'' form---the form that is
8502written in the machine description. The definition should output the
8503opcode name to @var{stream}, performing any translation you desire, and
8504increment the variable @var{ptr} to point at the end of the opcode
8505so that it will not be output twice.
8506
8507In fact, your macro definition may process less than the entire opcode
8508name, or more than the opcode name; but if you want to process text
8509that includes @samp{%}-sequences to substitute operands, you must take
8510care of the substitution yourself. Just be sure to increment
8511@var{ptr} over whatever text should not be output normally.
8512
8513@findex recog_data.operand
8514If you need to look at the operand values, they can be found as the
8515elements of @code{recog_data.operand}.
8516
8517If the macro definition does nothing, the instruction is output
8518in the usual way.
8519@end defmac
8520
8521@defmac FINAL_PRESCAN_INSN (@var{insn}, @var{opvec}, @var{noperands})
8522If defined, a C statement to be executed just prior to the output of
8523assembler code for @var{insn}, to modify the extracted operands so
8524they will be output differently.
8525
8526Here the argument @var{opvec} is the vector containing the operands
8527extracted from @var{insn}, and @var{noperands} is the number of
8528elements of the vector which contain meaningful data for this insn.
8529The contents of this vector are what will be used to convert the insn
8530template into assembler code, so you can change the assembler output
8531by changing the contents of the vector.
8532
8533This macro is useful when various assembler syntaxes share a single
8534file of instruction patterns; by defining this macro differently, you
8535can cause a large class of instructions to be output differently (such
8536as with rearranged operands). Naturally, variations in assembler
8537syntax affecting individual insn patterns ought to be handled by
8538writing conditional output routines in those patterns.
8539
8540If this macro is not defined, it is equivalent to a null statement.
8541@end defmac
8542
8543@hook TARGET_ASM_FINAL_POSTSCAN_INSN
8544If defined, this target hook is a function which is executed just after the
8545output of assembler code for @var{insn}, to change the mode of the assembler
8546if necessary.
8547
8548Here the argument @var{opvec} is the vector containing the operands
8549extracted from @var{insn}, and @var{noperands} is the number of
8550elements of the vector which contain meaningful data for this insn.
8551The contents of this vector are what was used to convert the insn
8552template into assembler code, so you can change the assembler mode
8553by checking the contents of the vector.
8554@end deftypefn
8555
8556@defmac PRINT_OPERAND (@var{stream}, @var{x}, @var{code})
8557A C compound statement to output to stdio stream @var{stream} the
8558assembler syntax for an instruction operand @var{x}. @var{x} is an
8559RTL expression.
8560
8561@var{code} is a value that can be used to specify one of several ways
8562of printing the operand. It is used when identical operands must be
8563printed differently depending on the context. @var{code} comes from
8564the @samp{%} specification that was used to request printing of the
8565operand. If the specification was just @samp{%@var{digit}} then
8566@var{code} is 0; if the specification was @samp{%@var{ltr}
8567@var{digit}} then @var{code} is the ASCII code for @var{ltr}.
8568
8569@findex reg_names
8570If @var{x} is a register, this macro should print the register's name.
8571The names can be found in an array @code{reg_names} whose type is
8572@code{char *[]}. @code{reg_names} is initialized from
8573@code{REGISTER_NAMES}.
8574
8575When the machine description has a specification @samp{%@var{punct}}
8576(a @samp{%} followed by a punctuation character), this macro is called
8577with a null pointer for @var{x} and the punctuation character for
8578@var{code}.
8579@end defmac
8580
8581@defmac PRINT_OPERAND_PUNCT_VALID_P (@var{code})
8582A C expression which evaluates to true if @var{code} is a valid
8583punctuation character for use in the @code{PRINT_OPERAND} macro. If
8584@code{PRINT_OPERAND_PUNCT_VALID_P} is not defined, it means that no
8585punctuation characters (except for the standard one, @samp{%}) are used
8586in this way.
8587@end defmac
8588
8589@defmac PRINT_OPERAND_ADDRESS (@var{stream}, @var{x})
8590A C compound statement to output to stdio stream @var{stream} the
8591assembler syntax for an instruction operand that is a memory reference
8592whose address is @var{x}. @var{x} is an RTL expression.
8593
8594@cindex @code{TARGET_ENCODE_SECTION_INFO} usage
8595On some machines, the syntax for a symbolic address depends on the
8596section that the address refers to. On these machines, define the hook
8597@code{TARGET_ENCODE_SECTION_INFO} to store the information into the
8598@code{symbol_ref}, and then check for it here. @xref{Assembler
8599Format}.
8600@end defmac
8601
8602@findex dbr_sequence_length
8603@defmac DBR_OUTPUT_SEQEND (@var{file})
8604A C statement, to be executed after all slot-filler instructions have
8605been output. If necessary, call @code{dbr_sequence_length} to
8606determine the number of slots filled in a sequence (zero if not
8607currently outputting a sequence), to decide how many no-ops to output,
8608or whatever.
8609
8610Don't define this macro if it has nothing to do, but it is helpful in
8611reading assembly output if the extent of the delay sequence is made
8612explicit (e.g.@: with white space).
8613@end defmac
8614
8615@findex final_sequence
8616Note that output routines for instructions with delay slots must be
8617prepared to deal with not being output as part of a sequence
8618(i.e.@: when the scheduling pass is not run, or when no slot fillers could be
8619found.) The variable @code{final_sequence} is null when not
8620processing a sequence, otherwise it contains the @code{sequence} rtx
8621being output.
8622
8623@findex asm_fprintf
8624@defmac REGISTER_PREFIX
8625@defmacx LOCAL_LABEL_PREFIX
8626@defmacx USER_LABEL_PREFIX
8627@defmacx IMMEDIATE_PREFIX
8628If defined, C string expressions to be used for the @samp{%R}, @samp{%L},
8629@samp{%U}, and @samp{%I} options of @code{asm_fprintf} (see
8630@file{final.c}). These are useful when a single @file{md} file must
8631support multiple assembler formats. In that case, the various @file{tm.h}
8632files can define these macros differently.
8633@end defmac
8634
8635@defmac ASM_FPRINTF_EXTENSIONS (@var{file}, @var{argptr}, @var{format})
8636If defined this macro should expand to a series of @code{case}
8637statements which will be parsed inside the @code{switch} statement of
8638the @code{asm_fprintf} function. This allows targets to define extra
8639printf formats which may useful when generating their assembler
8640statements. Note that uppercase letters are reserved for future
8641generic extensions to asm_fprintf, and so are not available to target
8642specific code. The output file is given by the parameter @var{file}.
8643The varargs input pointer is @var{argptr} and the rest of the format
8644string, starting the character after the one that is being switched
8645upon, is pointed to by @var{format}.
8646@end defmac
8647
8648@defmac ASSEMBLER_DIALECT
8649If your target supports multiple dialects of assembler language (such as
8650different opcodes), define this macro as a C expression that gives the
8651numeric index of the assembler language dialect to use, with zero as the
8652first variant.
8653
8654If this macro is defined, you may use constructs of the form
8655@smallexample
8656@samp{@{option0|option1|option2@dots{}@}}
8657@end smallexample
8658@noindent
8659in the output templates of patterns (@pxref{Output Template}) or in the
8660first argument of @code{asm_fprintf}. This construct outputs
8661@samp{option0}, @samp{option1}, @samp{option2}, etc., if the value of
8662@code{ASSEMBLER_DIALECT} is zero, one, two, etc. Any special characters
8663within these strings retain their usual meaning. If there are fewer
8664alternatives within the braces than the value of
8665@code{ASSEMBLER_DIALECT}, the construct outputs nothing.
8666
8667If you do not define this macro, the characters @samp{@{}, @samp{|} and
8668@samp{@}} do not have any special meaning when used in templates or
8669operands to @code{asm_fprintf}.
8670
8671Define the macros @code{REGISTER_PREFIX}, @code{LOCAL_LABEL_PREFIX},
8672@code{USER_LABEL_PREFIX} and @code{IMMEDIATE_PREFIX} if you can express
8673the variations in assembler language syntax with that mechanism. Define
8674@code{ASSEMBLER_DIALECT} and use the @samp{@{option0|option1@}} syntax
8675if the syntax variant are larger and involve such things as different
8676opcodes or operand order.
8677@end defmac
8678
8679@defmac ASM_OUTPUT_REG_PUSH (@var{stream}, @var{regno})
8680A C expression to output to @var{stream} some assembler code
8681which will push hard register number @var{regno} onto the stack.
8682The code need not be optimal, since this macro is used only when
8683profiling.
8684@end defmac
8685
8686@defmac ASM_OUTPUT_REG_POP (@var{stream}, @var{regno})
8687A C expression to output to @var{stream} some assembler code
8688which will pop hard register number @var{regno} off of the stack.
8689The code need not be optimal, since this macro is used only when
8690profiling.
8691@end defmac
8692
8693@node Dispatch Tables
8694@subsection Output of Dispatch Tables
8695
8696@c prevent bad page break with this line
8697This concerns dispatch tables.
8698
8699@cindex dispatch table
8700@defmac ASM_OUTPUT_ADDR_DIFF_ELT (@var{stream}, @var{body}, @var{value}, @var{rel})
8701A C statement to output to the stdio stream @var{stream} an assembler
8702pseudo-instruction to generate a difference between two labels.
8703@var{value} and @var{rel} are the numbers of two internal labels. The
8704definitions of these labels are output using
8705@code{(*targetm.asm_out.internal_label)}, and they must be printed in the same
8706way here. For example,
8707
8708@smallexample
8709fprintf (@var{stream}, "\t.word L%d-L%d\n",
8710 @var{value}, @var{rel})
8711@end smallexample
8712
8713You must provide this macro on machines where the addresses in a
8714dispatch table are relative to the table's own address. If defined, GCC
8715will also use this macro on all machines when producing PIC@.
8716@var{body} is the body of the @code{ADDR_DIFF_VEC}; it is provided so that the
8717mode and flags can be read.
8718@end defmac
8719
8720@defmac ASM_OUTPUT_ADDR_VEC_ELT (@var{stream}, @var{value})
8721This macro should be provided on machines where the addresses
8722in a dispatch table are absolute.
8723
8724The definition should be a C statement to output to the stdio stream
8725@var{stream} an assembler pseudo-instruction to generate a reference to
8726a label. @var{value} is the number of an internal label whose
8727definition is output using @code{(*targetm.asm_out.internal_label)}.
8728For example,
8729
8730@smallexample
8731fprintf (@var{stream}, "\t.word L%d\n", @var{value})
8732@end smallexample
8733@end defmac
8734
8735@defmac ASM_OUTPUT_CASE_LABEL (@var{stream}, @var{prefix}, @var{num}, @var{table})
8736Define this if the label before a jump-table needs to be output
8737specially. The first three arguments are the same as for
8738@code{(*targetm.asm_out.internal_label)}; the fourth argument is the
8739jump-table which follows (a @code{jump_insn} containing an
8740@code{addr_vec} or @code{addr_diff_vec}).
8741
8742This feature is used on system V to output a @code{swbeg} statement
8743for the table.
8744
8745If this macro is not defined, these labels are output with
8746@code{(*targetm.asm_out.internal_label)}.
8747@end defmac
8748
8749@defmac ASM_OUTPUT_CASE_END (@var{stream}, @var{num}, @var{table})
8750Define this if something special must be output at the end of a
8751jump-table. The definition should be a C statement to be executed
8752after the assembler code for the table is written. It should write
8753the appropriate code to stdio stream @var{stream}. The argument
8754@var{table} is the jump-table insn, and @var{num} is the label-number
8755of the preceding label.
8756
8757If this macro is not defined, nothing special is output at the end of
8758the jump-table.
8759@end defmac
8760
8761@hook TARGET_ASM_EMIT_UNWIND_LABEL
8762This target hook emits a label at the beginning of each FDE@. It
8763should be defined on targets where FDEs need special labels, and it
8764should write the appropriate label, for the FDE associated with the
8765function declaration @var{decl}, to the stdio stream @var{stream}.
8766The third argument, @var{for_eh}, is a boolean: true if this is for an
8767exception table. The fourth argument, @var{empty}, is a boolean:
8768true if this is a placeholder label for an omitted FDE@.
8769
8770The default is that FDEs are not given nonlocal labels.
8771@end deftypefn
8772
8773@hook TARGET_ASM_EMIT_EXCEPT_TABLE_LABEL
8774This target hook emits a label at the beginning of the exception table.
8775It should be defined on targets where it is desirable for the table
8776to be broken up according to function.
8777
8778The default is that no label is emitted.
8779@end deftypefn
8780
a68b5e52
RH
8781@hook TARGET_ASM_EMIT_EXCEPT_PERSONALITY
8782
38f8b050
JR
8783@hook TARGET_ASM_UNWIND_EMIT
8784This target hook emits assembly directives required to unwind the
f0a0390e
RH
8785given instruction. This is only used when @code{TARGET_EXCEPT_UNWIND_INFO}
8786returns @code{UI_TARGET}.
38f8b050
JR
8787@end deftypefn
8788
3bc6b3e6
RH
8789@hook TARGET_ASM_UNWIND_EMIT_BEFORE_INSN
8790
38f8b050
JR
8791@node Exception Region Output
8792@subsection Assembler Commands for Exception Regions
8793
8794@c prevent bad page break with this line
8795
8796This describes commands marking the start and the end of an exception
8797region.
8798
8799@defmac EH_FRAME_SECTION_NAME
8800If defined, a C string constant for the name of the section containing
8801exception handling frame unwind information. If not defined, GCC will
8802provide a default definition if the target supports named sections.
8803@file{crtstuff.c} uses this macro to switch to the appropriate section.
8804
8805You should define this symbol if your target supports DWARF 2 frame
8806unwind information and the default definition does not work.
8807@end defmac
8808
8809@defmac EH_FRAME_IN_DATA_SECTION
8810If defined, DWARF 2 frame unwind information will be placed in the
8811data section even though the target supports named sections. This
8812might be necessary, for instance, if the system linker does garbage
8813collection and sections cannot be marked as not to be collected.
8814
8815Do not define this macro unless @code{TARGET_ASM_NAMED_SECTION} is
8816also defined.
8817@end defmac
8818
8819@defmac EH_TABLES_CAN_BE_READ_ONLY
8820Define this macro to 1 if your target is such that no frame unwind
8821information encoding used with non-PIC code will ever require a
8822runtime relocation, but the linker may not support merging read-only
8823and read-write sections into a single read-write section.
8824@end defmac
8825
8826@defmac MASK_RETURN_ADDR
8827An rtx used to mask the return address found via @code{RETURN_ADDR_RTX}, so
8828that it does not contain any extraneous set bits in it.
8829@end defmac
8830
8831@defmac DWARF2_UNWIND_INFO
8832Define this macro to 0 if your target supports DWARF 2 frame unwind
8833information, but it does not yet work with exception handling.
8834Otherwise, if your target supports this information (if it defines
f0a0390e
RH
8835@code{INCOMING_RETURN_ADDR_RTX} and either @code{UNALIGNED_INT_ASM_OP}
8836or @code{OBJECT_FORMAT_ELF}), GCC will provide a default definition of 1.
8837@end defmac
38f8b050 8838
f0a0390e
RH
8839@hook TARGET_EXCEPT_UNWIND_INFO
8840This hook defines the mechanism that will be used for exception handling
8841by the target. If the target has ABI specified unwind tables, the hook
8842should return @code{UI_TARGET}. If the target is to use the
8843@code{setjmp}/@code{longjmp}-based exception handling scheme, the hook
8844should return @code{UI_SJLJ}. If the target supports DWARF 2 frame unwind
8845information, the hook should return @code{UI_DWARF2}.
38f8b050 8846
f0a0390e
RH
8847A target may, if exceptions are disabled, choose to return @code{UI_NONE}.
8848This may end up simplifying other parts of target-specific code. The
8849default implementation of this hook never returns @code{UI_NONE}.
38f8b050 8850
f0a0390e
RH
8851Note that the value returned by this hook should be constant. It should
8852not depend on anything except command-line switches. In particular, the
8853setting @code{UI_SJLJ} must be fixed at compiler start-up as C pre-processor
8854macros and builtin functions related to exception handling are set up
8855depending on this setting.
8856
8857The default implementation of the hook first honors the
8858@option{--enable-sjlj-exceptions} configure option, then
8859@code{DWARF2_UNWIND_INFO}, and finally defaults to @code{UI_SJLJ}.
8860@end deftypefn
38f8b050
JR
8861
8862@hook TARGET_UNWIND_TABLES_DEFAULT
8863This variable should be set to @code{true} if the target ABI requires unwinding
8864tables even when exceptions are not used.
8865@end deftypevr
8866
8867@defmac MUST_USE_SJLJ_EXCEPTIONS
8868This macro need only be defined if @code{DWARF2_UNWIND_INFO} is
8869runtime-variable. In that case, @file{except.h} cannot correctly
8870determine the corresponding definition of @code{MUST_USE_SJLJ_EXCEPTIONS},
8871so the target must provide it directly.
8872@end defmac
8873
8874@defmac DONT_USE_BUILTIN_SETJMP
8875Define this macro to 1 if the @code{setjmp}/@code{longjmp}-based scheme
8876should use the @code{setjmp}/@code{longjmp} functions from the C library
8877instead of the @code{__builtin_setjmp}/@code{__builtin_longjmp} machinery.
8878@end defmac
8879
8880@defmac DWARF_CIE_DATA_ALIGNMENT
8881This macro need only be defined if the target might save registers in the
8882function prologue at an offset to the stack pointer that is not aligned to
8883@code{UNITS_PER_WORD}. The definition should be the negative minimum
8884alignment if @code{STACK_GROWS_DOWNWARD} is defined, and the positive
8885minimum alignment otherwise. @xref{SDB and DWARF}. Only applicable if
8886the target supports DWARF 2 frame unwind information.
8887@end defmac
8888
8889@hook TARGET_TERMINATE_DW2_EH_FRAME_INFO
8890Contains the value true if the target should add a zero word onto the
8891end of a Dwarf-2 frame info section when used for exception handling.
8892Default value is false if @code{EH_FRAME_SECTION_NAME} is defined, and
8893true otherwise.
8894@end deftypevr
8895
8896@hook TARGET_DWARF_REGISTER_SPAN
8897Given a register, this hook should return a parallel of registers to
8898represent where to find the register pieces. Define this hook if the
8899register and its mode are represented in Dwarf in non-contiguous
8900locations, or if the register should be represented in more than one
8901register in Dwarf. Otherwise, this hook should return @code{NULL_RTX}.
8902If not defined, the default is to return @code{NULL_RTX}.
8903@end deftypefn
8904
8905@hook TARGET_INIT_DWARF_REG_SIZES_EXTRA
8906If some registers are represented in Dwarf-2 unwind information in
8907multiple pieces, define this hook to fill in information about the
8908sizes of those pieces in the table used by the unwinder at runtime.
8909It will be called by @code{expand_builtin_init_dwarf_reg_sizes} after
8910filling in a single size corresponding to each hard register;
8911@var{address} is the address of the table.
8912@end deftypefn
8913
8914@hook TARGET_ASM_TTYPE
8915This hook is used to output a reference from a frame unwinding table to
8916the type_info object identified by @var{sym}. It should return @code{true}
8917if the reference was output. Returning @code{false} will cause the
8918reference to be output using the normal Dwarf2 routines.
8919@end deftypefn
8920
8921@hook TARGET_ARM_EABI_UNWINDER
8922This flag should be set to @code{true} on targets that use an ARM EABI
8923based unwinding library, and @code{false} on other targets. This effects
8924the format of unwinding tables, and how the unwinder in entered after
8925running a cleanup. The default is @code{false}.
8926@end deftypevr
8927
8928@node Alignment Output
8929@subsection Assembler Commands for Alignment
8930
8931@c prevent bad page break with this line
8932This describes commands for alignment.
8933
8934@defmac JUMP_ALIGN (@var{label})
8935The alignment (log base 2) to put in front of @var{label}, which is
8936a common destination of jumps and has no fallthru incoming edge.
8937
8938This macro need not be defined if you don't want any special alignment
8939to be done at such a time. Most machine descriptions do not currently
8940define the macro.
8941
8942Unless it's necessary to inspect the @var{label} parameter, it is better
8943to set the variable @var{align_jumps} in the target's
8944@code{TARGET_OPTION_OVERRIDE}. Otherwise, you should try to honor the user's
8945selection in @var{align_jumps} in a @code{JUMP_ALIGN} implementation.
8946@end defmac
8947
8948@defmac LABEL_ALIGN_AFTER_BARRIER (@var{label})
8949The alignment (log base 2) to put in front of @var{label}, which follows
8950a @code{BARRIER}.
8951
8952This macro need not be defined if you don't want any special alignment
8953to be done at such a time. Most machine descriptions do not currently
8954define the macro.
8955@end defmac
8956
8957@defmac LABEL_ALIGN_AFTER_BARRIER_MAX_SKIP
8958The maximum number of bytes to skip when applying
8959@code{LABEL_ALIGN_AFTER_BARRIER}. This works only if
8960@code{ASM_OUTPUT_MAX_SKIP_ALIGN} is defined.
8961@end defmac
8962
8963@defmac LOOP_ALIGN (@var{label})
8964The alignment (log base 2) to put in front of @var{label}, which follows
8965a @code{NOTE_INSN_LOOP_BEG} note.
8966
8967This macro need not be defined if you don't want any special alignment
8968to be done at such a time. Most machine descriptions do not currently
8969define the macro.
8970
8971Unless it's necessary to inspect the @var{label} parameter, it is better
8972to set the variable @code{align_loops} in the target's
8973@code{TARGET_OPTION_OVERRIDE}. Otherwise, you should try to honor the user's
8974selection in @code{align_loops} in a @code{LOOP_ALIGN} implementation.
8975@end defmac
8976
8977@defmac LOOP_ALIGN_MAX_SKIP
8978The maximum number of bytes to skip when applying @code{LOOP_ALIGN}.
8979This works only if @code{ASM_OUTPUT_MAX_SKIP_ALIGN} is defined.
8980@end defmac
8981
8982@defmac LABEL_ALIGN (@var{label})
8983The alignment (log base 2) to put in front of @var{label}.
8984If @code{LABEL_ALIGN_AFTER_BARRIER} / @code{LOOP_ALIGN} specify a different alignment,
8985the maximum of the specified values is used.
8986
8987Unless it's necessary to inspect the @var{label} parameter, it is better
8988to set the variable @code{align_labels} in the target's
8989@code{TARGET_OPTION_OVERRIDE}. Otherwise, you should try to honor the user's
8990selection in @code{align_labels} in a @code{LABEL_ALIGN} implementation.
8991@end defmac
8992
8993@defmac LABEL_ALIGN_MAX_SKIP
8994The maximum number of bytes to skip when applying @code{LABEL_ALIGN}.
8995This works only if @code{ASM_OUTPUT_MAX_SKIP_ALIGN} is defined.
8996@end defmac
8997
8998@defmac ASM_OUTPUT_SKIP (@var{stream}, @var{nbytes})
8999A C statement to output to the stdio stream @var{stream} an assembler
9000instruction to advance the location counter by @var{nbytes} bytes.
9001Those bytes should be zero when loaded. @var{nbytes} will be a C
9002expression of type @code{unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT}.
9003@end defmac
9004
9005@defmac ASM_NO_SKIP_IN_TEXT
9006Define this macro if @code{ASM_OUTPUT_SKIP} should not be used in the
9007text section because it fails to put zeros in the bytes that are skipped.
9008This is true on many Unix systems, where the pseudo--op to skip bytes
9009produces no-op instructions rather than zeros when used in the text
9010section.
9011@end defmac
9012
9013@defmac ASM_OUTPUT_ALIGN (@var{stream}, @var{power})
9014A C statement to output to the stdio stream @var{stream} an assembler
9015command to advance the location counter to a multiple of 2 to the
9016@var{power} bytes. @var{power} will be a C expression of type @code{int}.
9017@end defmac
9018
9019@defmac ASM_OUTPUT_ALIGN_WITH_NOP (@var{stream}, @var{power})
9020Like @code{ASM_OUTPUT_ALIGN}, except that the ``nop'' instruction is used
9021for padding, if necessary.
9022@end defmac
9023
9024@defmac ASM_OUTPUT_MAX_SKIP_ALIGN (@var{stream}, @var{power}, @var{max_skip})
9025A C statement to output to the stdio stream @var{stream} an assembler
9026command to advance the location counter to a multiple of 2 to the
9027@var{power} bytes, but only if @var{max_skip} or fewer bytes are needed to
9028satisfy the alignment request. @var{power} and @var{max_skip} will be
9029a C expression of type @code{int}.
9030@end defmac
9031
9032@need 3000
9033@node Debugging Info
9034@section Controlling Debugging Information Format
9035
9036@c prevent bad page break with this line
9037This describes how to specify debugging information.
9038
9039@menu
9040* All Debuggers:: Macros that affect all debugging formats uniformly.
9041* DBX Options:: Macros enabling specific options in DBX format.
9042* DBX Hooks:: Hook macros for varying DBX format.
9043* File Names and DBX:: Macros controlling output of file names in DBX format.
9044* SDB and DWARF:: Macros for SDB (COFF) and DWARF formats.
9045* VMS Debug:: Macros for VMS debug format.
9046@end menu
9047
9048@node All Debuggers
9049@subsection Macros Affecting All Debugging Formats
9050
9051@c prevent bad page break with this line
9052These macros affect all debugging formats.
9053
9054@defmac DBX_REGISTER_NUMBER (@var{regno})
9055A C expression that returns the DBX register number for the compiler
9056register number @var{regno}. In the default macro provided, the value
9057of this expression will be @var{regno} itself. But sometimes there are
9058some registers that the compiler knows about and DBX does not, or vice
9059versa. In such cases, some register may need to have one number in the
9060compiler and another for DBX@.
9061
9062If two registers have consecutive numbers inside GCC, and they can be
9063used as a pair to hold a multiword value, then they @emph{must} have
9064consecutive numbers after renumbering with @code{DBX_REGISTER_NUMBER}.
9065Otherwise, debuggers will be unable to access such a pair, because they
9066expect register pairs to be consecutive in their own numbering scheme.
9067
9068If you find yourself defining @code{DBX_REGISTER_NUMBER} in way that
9069does not preserve register pairs, then what you must do instead is
9070redefine the actual register numbering scheme.
9071@end defmac
9072
9073@defmac DEBUGGER_AUTO_OFFSET (@var{x})
9074A C expression that returns the integer offset value for an automatic
9075variable having address @var{x} (an RTL expression). The default
9076computation assumes that @var{x} is based on the frame-pointer and
9077gives the offset from the frame-pointer. This is required for targets
9078that produce debugging output for DBX or COFF-style debugging output
9079for SDB and allow the frame-pointer to be eliminated when the
9080@option{-g} options is used.
9081@end defmac
9082
9083@defmac DEBUGGER_ARG_OFFSET (@var{offset}, @var{x})
9084A C expression that returns the integer offset value for an argument
9085having address @var{x} (an RTL expression). The nominal offset is
9086@var{offset}.
9087@end defmac
9088
9089@defmac PREFERRED_DEBUGGING_TYPE
9090A C expression that returns the type of debugging output GCC should
9091produce when the user specifies just @option{-g}. Define
9092this if you have arranged for GCC to support more than one format of
9093debugging output. Currently, the allowable values are @code{DBX_DEBUG},
9094@code{SDB_DEBUG}, @code{DWARF_DEBUG}, @code{DWARF2_DEBUG},
9095@code{XCOFF_DEBUG}, @code{VMS_DEBUG}, and @code{VMS_AND_DWARF2_DEBUG}.
9096
9097When the user specifies @option{-ggdb}, GCC normally also uses the
9098value of this macro to select the debugging output format, but with two
9099exceptions. If @code{DWARF2_DEBUGGING_INFO} is defined, GCC uses the
9100value @code{DWARF2_DEBUG}. Otherwise, if @code{DBX_DEBUGGING_INFO} is
9101defined, GCC uses @code{DBX_DEBUG}.
9102
9103The value of this macro only affects the default debugging output; the
9104user can always get a specific type of output by using @option{-gstabs},
9105@option{-gcoff}, @option{-gdwarf-2}, @option{-gxcoff}, or @option{-gvms}.
9106@end defmac
9107
9108@node DBX Options
9109@subsection Specific Options for DBX Output
9110
9111@c prevent bad page break with this line
9112These are specific options for DBX output.
9113
9114@defmac DBX_DEBUGGING_INFO
9115Define this macro if GCC should produce debugging output for DBX
9116in response to the @option{-g} option.
9117@end defmac
9118
9119@defmac XCOFF_DEBUGGING_INFO
9120Define this macro if GCC should produce XCOFF format debugging output
9121in response to the @option{-g} option. This is a variant of DBX format.
9122@end defmac
9123
9124@defmac DEFAULT_GDB_EXTENSIONS
9125Define this macro to control whether GCC should by default generate
9126GDB's extended version of DBX debugging information (assuming DBX-format
9127debugging information is enabled at all). If you don't define the
9128macro, the default is 1: always generate the extended information
9129if there is any occasion to.
9130@end defmac
9131
9132@defmac DEBUG_SYMS_TEXT
9133Define this macro if all @code{.stabs} commands should be output while
9134in the text section.
9135@end defmac
9136
9137@defmac ASM_STABS_OP
9138A C string constant, including spacing, naming the assembler pseudo op to
9139use instead of @code{"\t.stabs\t"} to define an ordinary debugging symbol.
9140If you don't define this macro, @code{"\t.stabs\t"} is used. This macro
9141applies only to DBX debugging information format.
9142@end defmac
9143
9144@defmac ASM_STABD_OP
9145A C string constant, including spacing, naming the assembler pseudo op to
9146use instead of @code{"\t.stabd\t"} to define a debugging symbol whose
9147value is the current location. If you don't define this macro,
9148@code{"\t.stabd\t"} is used. This macro applies only to DBX debugging
9149information format.
9150@end defmac
9151
9152@defmac ASM_STABN_OP
9153A C string constant, including spacing, naming the assembler pseudo op to
9154use instead of @code{"\t.stabn\t"} to define a debugging symbol with no
9155name. If you don't define this macro, @code{"\t.stabn\t"} is used. This
9156macro applies only to DBX debugging information format.
9157@end defmac
9158
9159@defmac DBX_NO_XREFS
9160Define this macro if DBX on your system does not support the construct
9161@samp{xs@var{tagname}}. On some systems, this construct is used to
9162describe a forward reference to a structure named @var{tagname}.
9163On other systems, this construct is not supported at all.
9164@end defmac
9165
9166@defmac DBX_CONTIN_LENGTH
9167A symbol name in DBX-format debugging information is normally
9168continued (split into two separate @code{.stabs} directives) when it
9169exceeds a certain length (by default, 80 characters). On some
9170operating systems, DBX requires this splitting; on others, splitting
9171must not be done. You can inhibit splitting by defining this macro
9172with the value zero. You can override the default splitting-length by
9173defining this macro as an expression for the length you desire.
9174@end defmac
9175
9176@defmac DBX_CONTIN_CHAR
9177Normally continuation is indicated by adding a @samp{\} character to
9178the end of a @code{.stabs} string when a continuation follows. To use
9179a different character instead, define this macro as a character
9180constant for the character you want to use. Do not define this macro
9181if backslash is correct for your system.
9182@end defmac
9183
9184@defmac DBX_STATIC_STAB_DATA_SECTION
9185Define this macro if it is necessary to go to the data section before
9186outputting the @samp{.stabs} pseudo-op for a non-global static
9187variable.
9188@end defmac
9189
9190@defmac DBX_TYPE_DECL_STABS_CODE
9191The value to use in the ``code'' field of the @code{.stabs} directive
9192for a typedef. The default is @code{N_LSYM}.
9193@end defmac
9194
9195@defmac DBX_STATIC_CONST_VAR_CODE
9196The value to use in the ``code'' field of the @code{.stabs} directive
9197for a static variable located in the text section. DBX format does not
9198provide any ``right'' way to do this. The default is @code{N_FUN}.
9199@end defmac
9200
9201@defmac DBX_REGPARM_STABS_CODE
9202The value to use in the ``code'' field of the @code{.stabs} directive
9203for a parameter passed in registers. DBX format does not provide any
9204``right'' way to do this. The default is @code{N_RSYM}.
9205@end defmac
9206
9207@defmac DBX_REGPARM_STABS_LETTER
9208The letter to use in DBX symbol data to identify a symbol as a parameter
9209passed in registers. DBX format does not customarily provide any way to
9210do this. The default is @code{'P'}.
9211@end defmac
9212
9213@defmac DBX_FUNCTION_FIRST
9214Define this macro if the DBX information for a function and its
9215arguments should precede the assembler code for the function. Normally,
9216in DBX format, the debugging information entirely follows the assembler
9217code.
9218@end defmac
9219
9220@defmac DBX_BLOCKS_FUNCTION_RELATIVE
9221Define this macro, with value 1, if the value of a symbol describing
9222the scope of a block (@code{N_LBRAC} or @code{N_RBRAC}) should be
9223relative to the start of the enclosing function. Normally, GCC uses
9224an absolute address.
9225@end defmac
9226
9227@defmac DBX_LINES_FUNCTION_RELATIVE
9228Define this macro, with value 1, if the value of a symbol indicating
9229the current line number (@code{N_SLINE}) should be relative to the
9230start of the enclosing function. Normally, GCC uses an absolute address.
9231@end defmac
9232
9233@defmac DBX_USE_BINCL
9234Define this macro if GCC should generate @code{N_BINCL} and
9235@code{N_EINCL} stabs for included header files, as on Sun systems. This
9236macro also directs GCC to output a type number as a pair of a file
9237number and a type number within the file. Normally, GCC does not
9238generate @code{N_BINCL} or @code{N_EINCL} stabs, and it outputs a single
9239number for a type number.
9240@end defmac
9241
9242@node DBX Hooks
9243@subsection Open-Ended Hooks for DBX Format
9244
9245@c prevent bad page break with this line
9246These are hooks for DBX format.
9247
9248@defmac DBX_OUTPUT_LBRAC (@var{stream}, @var{name})
9249Define this macro to say how to output to @var{stream} the debugging
9250information for the start of a scope level for variable names. The
9251argument @var{name} is the name of an assembler symbol (for use with
9252@code{assemble_name}) whose value is the address where the scope begins.
9253@end defmac
9254
9255@defmac DBX_OUTPUT_RBRAC (@var{stream}, @var{name})
9256Like @code{DBX_OUTPUT_LBRAC}, but for the end of a scope level.
9257@end defmac
9258
9259@defmac DBX_OUTPUT_NFUN (@var{stream}, @var{lscope_label}, @var{decl})
9260Define this macro if the target machine requires special handling to
9261output an @code{N_FUN} entry for the function @var{decl}.
9262@end defmac
9263
9264@defmac DBX_OUTPUT_SOURCE_LINE (@var{stream}, @var{line}, @var{counter})
9265A C statement to output DBX debugging information before code for line
9266number @var{line} of the current source file to the stdio stream
9267@var{stream}. @var{counter} is the number of time the macro was
9268invoked, including the current invocation; it is intended to generate
9269unique labels in the assembly output.
9270
9271This macro should not be defined if the default output is correct, or
9272if it can be made correct by defining @code{DBX_LINES_FUNCTION_RELATIVE}.
9273@end defmac
9274
9275@defmac NO_DBX_FUNCTION_END
9276Some stabs encapsulation formats (in particular ECOFF), cannot handle the
9277@code{.stabs "",N_FUN,,0,0,Lscope-function-1} gdb dbx extension construct.
9278On those machines, define this macro to turn this feature off without
9279disturbing the rest of the gdb extensions.
9280@end defmac
9281
9282@defmac NO_DBX_BNSYM_ENSYM
9283Some assemblers cannot handle the @code{.stabd BNSYM/ENSYM,0,0} gdb dbx
9284extension construct. On those machines, define this macro to turn this
9285feature off without disturbing the rest of the gdb extensions.
9286@end defmac
9287
9288@node File Names and DBX
9289@subsection File Names in DBX Format
9290
9291@c prevent bad page break with this line
9292This describes file names in DBX format.
9293
9294@defmac DBX_OUTPUT_MAIN_SOURCE_FILENAME (@var{stream}, @var{name})
9295A C statement to output DBX debugging information to the stdio stream
9296@var{stream}, which indicates that file @var{name} is the main source
9297file---the file specified as the input file for compilation.
9298This macro is called only once, at the beginning of compilation.
9299
9300This macro need not be defined if the standard form of output
9301for DBX debugging information is appropriate.
9302
9303It may be necessary to refer to a label equal to the beginning of the
9304text section. You can use @samp{assemble_name (stream, ltext_label_name)}
9305to do so. If you do this, you must also set the variable
9306@var{used_ltext_label_name} to @code{true}.
9307@end defmac
9308
9309@defmac NO_DBX_MAIN_SOURCE_DIRECTORY
9310Define this macro, with value 1, if GCC should not emit an indication
9311of the current directory for compilation and current source language at
9312the beginning of the file.
9313@end defmac
9314
9315@defmac NO_DBX_GCC_MARKER
9316Define this macro, with value 1, if GCC should not emit an indication
9317that this object file was compiled by GCC@. The default is to emit
9318an @code{N_OPT} stab at the beginning of every source file, with
9319@samp{gcc2_compiled.} for the string and value 0.
9320@end defmac
9321
9322@defmac DBX_OUTPUT_MAIN_SOURCE_FILE_END (@var{stream}, @var{name})
9323A C statement to output DBX debugging information at the end of
9324compilation of the main source file @var{name}. Output should be
9325written to the stdio stream @var{stream}.
9326
9327If you don't define this macro, nothing special is output at the end
9328of compilation, which is correct for most machines.
9329@end defmac
9330
9331@defmac DBX_OUTPUT_NULL_N_SO_AT_MAIN_SOURCE_FILE_END
9332Define this macro @emph{instead of} defining
9333@code{DBX_OUTPUT_MAIN_SOURCE_FILE_END}, if what needs to be output at
9334the end of compilation is an @code{N_SO} stab with an empty string,
9335whose value is the highest absolute text address in the file.
9336@end defmac
9337
9338@need 2000
9339@node SDB and DWARF
9340@subsection Macros for SDB and DWARF Output
9341
9342@c prevent bad page break with this line
9343Here are macros for SDB and DWARF output.
9344
9345@defmac SDB_DEBUGGING_INFO
9346Define this macro if GCC should produce COFF-style debugging output
9347for SDB in response to the @option{-g} option.
9348@end defmac
9349
9350@defmac DWARF2_DEBUGGING_INFO
9351Define this macro if GCC should produce dwarf version 2 format
9352debugging output in response to the @option{-g} option.
9353
9354@hook TARGET_DWARF_CALLING_CONVENTION
9355Define this to enable the dwarf attribute @code{DW_AT_calling_convention} to
9356be emitted for each function. Instead of an integer return the enum
9357value for the @code{DW_CC_} tag.
9358@end deftypefn
9359
9360To support optional call frame debugging information, you must also
9361define @code{INCOMING_RETURN_ADDR_RTX} and either set
9362@code{RTX_FRAME_RELATED_P} on the prologue insns if you use RTL for the
9363prologue, or call @code{dwarf2out_def_cfa} and @code{dwarf2out_reg_save}
9364as appropriate from @code{TARGET_ASM_FUNCTION_PROLOGUE} if you don't.
9365@end defmac
9366
9367@defmac DWARF2_FRAME_INFO
9368Define this macro to a nonzero value if GCC should always output
f0a0390e
RH
9369Dwarf 2 frame information. If @code{TARGET_EXCEPT_UNWIND_INFO}
9370(@pxref{Exception Region Output}) returns @code{UI_DWARF2}, and
9371exceptions are enabled, GCC will output this information not matter
9372how you define @code{DWARF2_FRAME_INFO}.
38f8b050
JR
9373@end defmac
9374
f0a0390e
RH
9375@hook TARGET_DEBUG_UNWIND_INFO
9376This hook defines the mechanism that will be used for describing frame
9377unwind information to the debugger. Normally the hook will return
9378@code{UI_DWARF2} if DWARF 2 debug information is enabled, and
9379return @code{UI_NONE} otherwise.
9380
9381A target may return @code{UI_DWARF2} even when DWARF 2 debug information
9382is disabled in order to always output DWARF 2 frame information.
9383
9384A target may return @code{UI_TARGET} if it has ABI specified unwind tables.
9385This will suppress generation of the normal debug frame unwind information.
9386@end deftypefn
9387
38f8b050
JR
9388@defmac DWARF2_ASM_LINE_DEBUG_INFO
9389Define this macro to be a nonzero value if the assembler can generate Dwarf 2
9390line debug info sections. This will result in much more compact line number
9391tables, and hence is desirable if it works.
9392@end defmac
9393
9730bc27
TT
9394@hook TARGET_WANT_DEBUG_PUB_SECTIONS
9395
38f8b050
JR
9396@defmac ASM_OUTPUT_DWARF_DELTA (@var{stream}, @var{size}, @var{label1}, @var{label2})
9397A C statement to issue assembly directives that create a difference
9398@var{lab1} minus @var{lab2}, using an integer of the given @var{size}.
9399@end defmac
9400
9401@defmac ASM_OUTPUT_DWARF_VMS_DELTA (@var{stream}, @var{size}, @var{label1}, @var{label2})
9402A C statement to issue assembly directives that create a difference
9403between the two given labels in system defined units, e.g. instruction
9404slots on IA64 VMS, using an integer of the given size.
9405@end defmac
9406
9407@defmac ASM_OUTPUT_DWARF_OFFSET (@var{stream}, @var{size}, @var{label}, @var{section})
9408A C statement to issue assembly directives that create a
9409section-relative reference to the given @var{label}, using an integer of the
9410given @var{size}. The label is known to be defined in the given @var{section}.
9411@end defmac
9412
9413@defmac ASM_OUTPUT_DWARF_PCREL (@var{stream}, @var{size}, @var{label})
9414A C statement to issue assembly directives that create a self-relative
9415reference to the given @var{label}, using an integer of the given @var{size}.
9416@end defmac
9417
9418@defmac ASM_OUTPUT_DWARF_TABLE_REF (@var{label})
9419A C statement to issue assembly directives that create a reference to
9420the DWARF table identifier @var{label} from the current section. This
9421is used on some systems to avoid garbage collecting a DWARF table which
9422is referenced by a function.
9423@end defmac
9424
9425@hook TARGET_ASM_OUTPUT_DWARF_DTPREL
9426If defined, this target hook is a function which outputs a DTP-relative
9427reference to the given TLS symbol of the specified size.
9428@end deftypefn
9429
9430@defmac PUT_SDB_@dots{}
9431Define these macros to override the assembler syntax for the special
9432SDB assembler directives. See @file{sdbout.c} for a list of these
9433macros and their arguments. If the standard syntax is used, you need
9434not define them yourself.
9435@end defmac
9436
9437@defmac SDB_DELIM
9438Some assemblers do not support a semicolon as a delimiter, even between
9439SDB assembler directives. In that case, define this macro to be the
9440delimiter to use (usually @samp{\n}). It is not necessary to define
9441a new set of @code{PUT_SDB_@var{op}} macros if this is the only change
9442required.
9443@end defmac
9444
9445@defmac SDB_ALLOW_UNKNOWN_REFERENCES
9446Define this macro to allow references to unknown structure,
9447union, or enumeration tags to be emitted. Standard COFF does not
9448allow handling of unknown references, MIPS ECOFF has support for
9449it.
9450@end defmac
9451
9452@defmac SDB_ALLOW_FORWARD_REFERENCES
9453Define this macro to allow references to structure, union, or
9454enumeration tags that have not yet been seen to be handled. Some
9455assemblers choke if forward tags are used, while some require it.
9456@end defmac
9457
9458@defmac SDB_OUTPUT_SOURCE_LINE (@var{stream}, @var{line})
9459A C statement to output SDB debugging information before code for line
9460number @var{line} of the current source file to the stdio stream
9461@var{stream}. The default is to emit an @code{.ln} directive.
9462@end defmac
9463
9464@need 2000
9465@node VMS Debug
9466@subsection Macros for VMS Debug Format
9467
9468@c prevent bad page break with this line
9469Here are macros for VMS debug format.
9470
9471@defmac VMS_DEBUGGING_INFO
9472Define this macro if GCC should produce debugging output for VMS
9473in response to the @option{-g} option. The default behavior for VMS
9474is to generate minimal debug info for a traceback in the absence of
9475@option{-g} unless explicitly overridden with @option{-g0}. This
fac0f722 9476behavior is controlled by @code{TARGET_OPTION_OPTIMIZATION} and
38f8b050
JR
9477@code{TARGET_OPTION_OVERRIDE}.
9478@end defmac
9479
9480@node Floating Point
9481@section Cross Compilation and Floating Point
9482@cindex cross compilation and floating point
9483@cindex floating point and cross compilation
9484
9485While all modern machines use twos-complement representation for integers,
9486there are a variety of representations for floating point numbers. This
9487means that in a cross-compiler the representation of floating point numbers
9488in the compiled program may be different from that used in the machine
9489doing the compilation.
9490
9491Because different representation systems may offer different amounts of
9492range and precision, all floating point constants must be represented in
9493the target machine's format. Therefore, the cross compiler cannot
9494safely use the host machine's floating point arithmetic; it must emulate
9495the target's arithmetic. To ensure consistency, GCC always uses
9496emulation to work with floating point values, even when the host and
9497target floating point formats are identical.
9498
9499The following macros are provided by @file{real.h} for the compiler to
9500use. All parts of the compiler which generate or optimize
9501floating-point calculations must use these macros. They may evaluate
9502their operands more than once, so operands must not have side effects.
9503
9504@defmac REAL_VALUE_TYPE
9505The C data type to be used to hold a floating point value in the target
9506machine's format. Typically this is a @code{struct} containing an
9507array of @code{HOST_WIDE_INT}, but all code should treat it as an opaque
9508quantity.
9509@end defmac
9510
9511@deftypefn Macro int REAL_VALUES_EQUAL (REAL_VALUE_TYPE @var{x}, REAL_VALUE_TYPE @var{y})
9512Compares for equality the two values, @var{x} and @var{y}. If the target
9513floating point format supports negative zeroes and/or NaNs,
9514@samp{REAL_VALUES_EQUAL (-0.0, 0.0)} is true, and
9515@samp{REAL_VALUES_EQUAL (NaN, NaN)} is false.
9516@end deftypefn
9517
9518@deftypefn Macro int REAL_VALUES_LESS (REAL_VALUE_TYPE @var{x}, REAL_VALUE_TYPE @var{y})
9519Tests whether @var{x} is less than @var{y}.
9520@end deftypefn
9521
9522@deftypefn Macro HOST_WIDE_INT REAL_VALUE_FIX (REAL_VALUE_TYPE @var{x})
9523Truncates @var{x} to a signed integer, rounding toward zero.
9524@end deftypefn
9525
9526@deftypefn Macro {unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT} REAL_VALUE_UNSIGNED_FIX (REAL_VALUE_TYPE @var{x})
9527Truncates @var{x} to an unsigned integer, rounding toward zero. If
9528@var{x} is negative, returns zero.
9529@end deftypefn
9530
9531@deftypefn Macro REAL_VALUE_TYPE REAL_VALUE_ATOF (const char *@var{string}, enum machine_mode @var{mode})
9532Converts @var{string} into a floating point number in the target machine's
9533representation for mode @var{mode}. This routine can handle both
9534decimal and hexadecimal floating point constants, using the syntax
9535defined by the C language for both.
9536@end deftypefn
9537
9538@deftypefn Macro int REAL_VALUE_NEGATIVE (REAL_VALUE_TYPE @var{x})
9539Returns 1 if @var{x} is negative (including negative zero), 0 otherwise.
9540@end deftypefn
9541
9542@deftypefn Macro int REAL_VALUE_ISINF (REAL_VALUE_TYPE @var{x})
9543Determines whether @var{x} represents infinity (positive or negative).
9544@end deftypefn
9545
9546@deftypefn Macro int REAL_VALUE_ISNAN (REAL_VALUE_TYPE @var{x})
9547Determines whether @var{x} represents a ``NaN'' (not-a-number).
9548@end deftypefn
9549
9550@deftypefn Macro void REAL_ARITHMETIC (REAL_VALUE_TYPE @var{output}, enum tree_code @var{code}, REAL_VALUE_TYPE @var{x}, REAL_VALUE_TYPE @var{y})
9551Calculates an arithmetic operation on the two floating point values
9552@var{x} and @var{y}, storing the result in @var{output} (which must be a
9553variable).
9554
9555The operation to be performed is specified by @var{code}. Only the
9556following codes are supported: @code{PLUS_EXPR}, @code{MINUS_EXPR},
9557@code{MULT_EXPR}, @code{RDIV_EXPR}, @code{MAX_EXPR}, @code{MIN_EXPR}.
9558
9559If @code{REAL_ARITHMETIC} is asked to evaluate division by zero and the
9560target's floating point format cannot represent infinity, it will call
9561@code{abort}. Callers should check for this situation first, using
9562@code{MODE_HAS_INFINITIES}. @xref{Storage Layout}.
9563@end deftypefn
9564
9565@deftypefn Macro REAL_VALUE_TYPE REAL_VALUE_NEGATE (REAL_VALUE_TYPE @var{x})
9566Returns the negative of the floating point value @var{x}.
9567@end deftypefn
9568
9569@deftypefn Macro REAL_VALUE_TYPE REAL_VALUE_ABS (REAL_VALUE_TYPE @var{x})
9570Returns the absolute value of @var{x}.
9571@end deftypefn
9572
9573@deftypefn Macro REAL_VALUE_TYPE REAL_VALUE_TRUNCATE (REAL_VALUE_TYPE @var{mode}, enum machine_mode @var{x})
9574Truncates the floating point value @var{x} to fit in @var{mode}. The
9575return value is still a full-size @code{REAL_VALUE_TYPE}, but it has an
9576appropriate bit pattern to be output as a floating constant whose
9577precision accords with mode @var{mode}.
9578@end deftypefn
9579
9580@deftypefn Macro void REAL_VALUE_TO_INT (HOST_WIDE_INT @var{low}, HOST_WIDE_INT @var{high}, REAL_VALUE_TYPE @var{x})
9581Converts a floating point value @var{x} into a double-precision integer
9582which is then stored into @var{low} and @var{high}. If the value is not
9583integral, it is truncated.
9584@end deftypefn
9585
9586@deftypefn Macro void REAL_VALUE_FROM_INT (REAL_VALUE_TYPE @var{x}, HOST_WIDE_INT @var{low}, HOST_WIDE_INT @var{high}, enum machine_mode @var{mode})
9587Converts a double-precision integer found in @var{low} and @var{high},
9588into a floating point value which is then stored into @var{x}. The
9589value is truncated to fit in mode @var{mode}.
9590@end deftypefn
9591
9592@node Mode Switching
9593@section Mode Switching Instructions
9594@cindex mode switching
9595The following macros control mode switching optimizations:
9596
9597@defmac OPTIMIZE_MODE_SWITCHING (@var{entity})
9598Define this macro if the port needs extra instructions inserted for mode
9599switching in an optimizing compilation.
9600
9601For an example, the SH4 can perform both single and double precision
9602floating point operations, but to perform a single precision operation,
9603the FPSCR PR bit has to be cleared, while for a double precision
9604operation, this bit has to be set. Changing the PR bit requires a general
9605purpose register as a scratch register, hence these FPSCR sets have to
9606be inserted before reload, i.e.@: you can't put this into instruction emitting
9607or @code{TARGET_MACHINE_DEPENDENT_REORG}.
9608
9609You can have multiple entities that are mode-switched, and select at run time
9610which entities actually need it. @code{OPTIMIZE_MODE_SWITCHING} should
9611return nonzero for any @var{entity} that needs mode-switching.
9612If you define this macro, you also have to define
9613@code{NUM_MODES_FOR_MODE_SWITCHING}, @code{MODE_NEEDED},
9614@code{MODE_PRIORITY_TO_MODE} and @code{EMIT_MODE_SET}.
9615@code{MODE_AFTER}, @code{MODE_ENTRY}, and @code{MODE_EXIT}
9616are optional.
9617@end defmac
9618
9619@defmac NUM_MODES_FOR_MODE_SWITCHING
9620If you define @code{OPTIMIZE_MODE_SWITCHING}, you have to define this as
9621initializer for an array of integers. Each initializer element
9622N refers to an entity that needs mode switching, and specifies the number
9623of different modes that might need to be set for this entity.
9624The position of the initializer in the initializer---starting counting at
9625zero---determines the integer that is used to refer to the mode-switched
9626entity in question.
9627In macros that take mode arguments / yield a mode result, modes are
9628represented as numbers 0 @dots{} N @minus{} 1. N is used to specify that no mode
9629switch is needed / supplied.
9630@end defmac
9631
9632@defmac MODE_NEEDED (@var{entity}, @var{insn})
9633@var{entity} is an integer specifying a mode-switched entity. If
9634@code{OPTIMIZE_MODE_SWITCHING} is defined, you must define this macro to
9635return an integer value not larger than the corresponding element in
9636@code{NUM_MODES_FOR_MODE_SWITCHING}, to denote the mode that @var{entity} must
9637be switched into prior to the execution of @var{insn}.
9638@end defmac
9639
9640@defmac MODE_AFTER (@var{mode}, @var{insn})
9641If this macro is defined, it is evaluated for every @var{insn} during
9642mode switching. It determines the mode that an insn results in (if
9643different from the incoming mode).
9644@end defmac
9645
9646@defmac MODE_ENTRY (@var{entity})
9647If this macro is defined, it is evaluated for every @var{entity} that needs
9648mode switching. It should evaluate to an integer, which is a mode that
9649@var{entity} is assumed to be switched to at function entry. If @code{MODE_ENTRY}
9650is defined then @code{MODE_EXIT} must be defined.
9651@end defmac
9652
9653@defmac MODE_EXIT (@var{entity})
9654If this macro is defined, it is evaluated for every @var{entity} that needs
9655mode switching. It should evaluate to an integer, which is a mode that
9656@var{entity} is assumed to be switched to at function exit. If @code{MODE_EXIT}
9657is defined then @code{MODE_ENTRY} must be defined.
9658@end defmac
9659
9660@defmac MODE_PRIORITY_TO_MODE (@var{entity}, @var{n})
9661This macro specifies the order in which modes for @var{entity} are processed.
96620 is the highest priority, @code{NUM_MODES_FOR_MODE_SWITCHING[@var{entity}] - 1} the
9663lowest. The value of the macro should be an integer designating a mode
9664for @var{entity}. For any fixed @var{entity}, @code{mode_priority_to_mode}
9665(@var{entity}, @var{n}) shall be a bijection in 0 @dots{}
9666@code{num_modes_for_mode_switching[@var{entity}] - 1}.
9667@end defmac
9668
9669@defmac EMIT_MODE_SET (@var{entity}, @var{mode}, @var{hard_regs_live})
9670Generate one or more insns to set @var{entity} to @var{mode}.
9671@var{hard_reg_live} is the set of hard registers live at the point where
9672the insn(s) are to be inserted.
9673@end defmac
9674
9675@node Target Attributes
9676@section Defining target-specific uses of @code{__attribute__}
9677@cindex target attributes
9678@cindex machine attributes
9679@cindex attributes, target-specific
9680
9681Target-specific attributes may be defined for functions, data and types.
9682These are described using the following target hooks; they also need to
9683be documented in @file{extend.texi}.
9684
9685@hook TARGET_ATTRIBUTE_TABLE
9686If defined, this target hook points to an array of @samp{struct
9687attribute_spec} (defined in @file{tree.h}) specifying the machine
9688specific attributes for this target and some of the restrictions on the
9689entities to which these attributes are applied and the arguments they
9690take.
9691@end deftypevr
9692
9693@hook TARGET_ATTRIBUTE_TAKES_IDENTIFIER_P
9694If defined, this target hook is a function which returns true if the
9695machine-specific attribute named @var{name} expects an identifier
9696given as its first argument to be passed on as a plain identifier, not
9697subjected to name lookup. If this is not defined, the default is
9698false for all machine-specific attributes.
9699@end deftypefn
9700
9701@hook TARGET_COMP_TYPE_ATTRIBUTES
9702If defined, this target hook is a function which returns zero if the attributes on
9703@var{type1} and @var{type2} are incompatible, one if they are compatible,
9704and two if they are nearly compatible (which causes a warning to be
9705generated). If this is not defined, machine-specific attributes are
9706supposed always to be compatible.
9707@end deftypefn
9708
9709@hook TARGET_SET_DEFAULT_TYPE_ATTRIBUTES
9710If defined, this target hook is a function which assigns default attributes to
9711the newly defined @var{type}.
9712@end deftypefn
9713
9714@hook TARGET_MERGE_TYPE_ATTRIBUTES
9715Define this target hook if the merging of type attributes needs special
9716handling. If defined, the result is a list of the combined
9717@code{TYPE_ATTRIBUTES} of @var{type1} and @var{type2}. It is assumed
9718that @code{comptypes} has already been called and returned 1. This
9719function may call @code{merge_attributes} to handle machine-independent
9720merging.
9721@end deftypefn
9722
9723@hook TARGET_MERGE_DECL_ATTRIBUTES
9724Define this target hook if the merging of decl attributes needs special
9725handling. If defined, the result is a list of the combined
9726@code{DECL_ATTRIBUTES} of @var{olddecl} and @var{newdecl}.
9727@var{newdecl} is a duplicate declaration of @var{olddecl}. Examples of
9728when this is needed are when one attribute overrides another, or when an
9729attribute is nullified by a subsequent definition. This function may
9730call @code{merge_attributes} to handle machine-independent merging.
9731
9732@findex TARGET_DLLIMPORT_DECL_ATTRIBUTES
9733If the only target-specific handling you require is @samp{dllimport}
9734for Microsoft Windows targets, you should define the macro
9735@code{TARGET_DLLIMPORT_DECL_ATTRIBUTES} to @code{1}. The compiler
9736will then define a function called
9737@code{merge_dllimport_decl_attributes} which can then be defined as
9738the expansion of @code{TARGET_MERGE_DECL_ATTRIBUTES}. You can also
9739add @code{handle_dll_attribute} in the attribute table for your port
9740to perform initial processing of the @samp{dllimport} and
9741@samp{dllexport} attributes. This is done in @file{i386/cygwin.h} and
9742@file{i386/i386.c}, for example.
9743@end deftypefn
9744
9745@hook TARGET_VALID_DLLIMPORT_ATTRIBUTE_P
9746
9747@defmac TARGET_DECLSPEC
9748Define this macro to a nonzero value if you want to treat
9749@code{__declspec(X)} as equivalent to @code{__attribute((X))}. By
9750default, this behavior is enabled only for targets that define
9751@code{TARGET_DLLIMPORT_DECL_ATTRIBUTES}. The current implementation
9752of @code{__declspec} is via a built-in macro, but you should not rely
9753on this implementation detail.
9754@end defmac
9755
9756@hook TARGET_INSERT_ATTRIBUTES
9757Define this target hook if you want to be able to add attributes to a decl
9758when it is being created. This is normally useful for back ends which
9759wish to implement a pragma by using the attributes which correspond to
9760the pragma's effect. The @var{node} argument is the decl which is being
9761created. The @var{attr_ptr} argument is a pointer to the attribute list
9762for this decl. The list itself should not be modified, since it may be
9763shared with other decls, but attributes may be chained on the head of
9764the list and @code{*@var{attr_ptr}} modified to point to the new
9765attributes, or a copy of the list may be made if further changes are
9766needed.
9767@end deftypefn
9768
9769@hook TARGET_FUNCTION_ATTRIBUTE_INLINABLE_P
9770@cindex inlining
9771This target hook returns @code{true} if it is ok to inline @var{fndecl}
9772into the current function, despite its having target-specific
9773attributes, @code{false} otherwise. By default, if a function has a
9774target specific attribute attached to it, it will not be inlined.
9775@end deftypefn
9776
9777@hook TARGET_OPTION_VALID_ATTRIBUTE_P
9778This hook is called to parse the @code{attribute(option("..."))}, and
9779it allows the function to set different target machine compile time
9780options for the current function that might be different than the
9781options specified on the command line. The hook should return
9782@code{true} if the options are valid.
9783
9784The hook should set the @var{DECL_FUNCTION_SPECIFIC_TARGET} field in
9785the function declaration to hold a pointer to a target specific
9786@var{struct cl_target_option} structure.
9787@end deftypefn
9788
9789@hook TARGET_OPTION_SAVE
9790This hook is called to save any additional target specific information
9791in the @var{struct cl_target_option} structure for function specific
9792options.
9793@xref{Option file format}.
9794@end deftypefn
9795
9796@hook TARGET_OPTION_RESTORE
9797This hook is called to restore any additional target specific
9798information in the @var{struct cl_target_option} structure for
9799function specific options.
9800@end deftypefn
9801
9802@hook TARGET_OPTION_PRINT
9803This hook is called to print any additional target specific
9804information in the @var{struct cl_target_option} structure for
9805function specific options.
9806@end deftypefn
9807
56cb42ea 9808@hook TARGET_OPTION_PRAGMA_PARSE
38f8b050
JR
9809This target hook parses the options for @code{#pragma GCC option} to
9810set the machine specific options for functions that occur later in the
9811input stream. The options should be the same as handled by the
56cb42ea 9812@code{TARGET_OPTION_VALID_ATTRIBUTE_P} hook.
38f8b050
JR
9813@end deftypefn
9814
9815@hook TARGET_OPTION_OVERRIDE
9816Sometimes certain combinations of command options do not make sense on
9817a particular target machine. You can override the hook
9818@code{TARGET_OPTION_OVERRIDE} to take account of this. This hooks is called
9819once just after all the command options have been parsed.
9820
9821Don't use this hook to turn on various extra optimizations for
fac0f722 9822@option{-O}. That is what @code{TARGET_OPTION_OPTIMIZATION} is for.
38f8b050
JR
9823
9824If you need to do something whenever the optimization level is
9825changed via the optimize attribute or pragma, see
9826@code{TARGET_OVERRIDE_OPTIONS_AFTER_CHANGE}
9827@end deftypefn
9828
9829@hook TARGET_CAN_INLINE_P
9830This target hook returns @code{false} if the @var{caller} function
9831cannot inline @var{callee}, based on target specific information. By
9832default, inlining is not allowed if the callee function has function
9833specific target options and the caller does not use the same options.
9834@end deftypefn
9835
9836@node Emulated TLS
9837@section Emulating TLS
9838@cindex Emulated TLS
9839
9840For targets whose psABI does not provide Thread Local Storage via
9841specific relocations and instruction sequences, an emulation layer is
9842used. A set of target hooks allows this emulation layer to be
9843configured for the requirements of a particular target. For instance
9844the psABI may in fact specify TLS support in terms of an emulation
9845layer.
9846
9847The emulation layer works by creating a control object for every TLS
9848object. To access the TLS object, a lookup function is provided
9849which, when given the address of the control object, will return the
9850address of the current thread's instance of the TLS object.
9851
9852@hook TARGET_EMUTLS_GET_ADDRESS
9853Contains the name of the helper function that uses a TLS control
9854object to locate a TLS instance. The default causes libgcc's
9855emulated TLS helper function to be used.
9856@end deftypevr
9857
9858@hook TARGET_EMUTLS_REGISTER_COMMON
9859Contains the name of the helper function that should be used at
9860program startup to register TLS objects that are implicitly
9861initialized to zero. If this is @code{NULL}, all TLS objects will
9862have explicit initializers. The default causes libgcc's emulated TLS
9863registration function to be used.
9864@end deftypevr
9865
9866@hook TARGET_EMUTLS_VAR_SECTION
9867Contains the name of the section in which TLS control variables should
9868be placed. The default of @code{NULL} allows these to be placed in
9869any section.
9870@end deftypevr
9871
9872@hook TARGET_EMUTLS_TMPL_SECTION
9873Contains the name of the section in which TLS initializers should be
9874placed. The default of @code{NULL} allows these to be placed in any
9875section.
9876@end deftypevr
9877
9878@hook TARGET_EMUTLS_VAR_PREFIX
9879Contains the prefix to be prepended to TLS control variable names.
9880The default of @code{NULL} uses a target-specific prefix.
9881@end deftypevr
9882
9883@hook TARGET_EMUTLS_TMPL_PREFIX
9884Contains the prefix to be prepended to TLS initializer objects. The
9885default of @code{NULL} uses a target-specific prefix.
9886@end deftypevr
9887
9888@hook TARGET_EMUTLS_VAR_FIELDS
9889Specifies a function that generates the FIELD_DECLs for a TLS control
9890object type. @var{type} is the RECORD_TYPE the fields are for and
9891@var{name} should be filled with the structure tag, if the default of
9892@code{__emutls_object} is unsuitable. The default creates a type suitable
9893for libgcc's emulated TLS function.
9894@end deftypefn
9895
9896@hook TARGET_EMUTLS_VAR_INIT
9897Specifies a function that generates the CONSTRUCTOR to initialize a
9898TLS control object. @var{var} is the TLS control object, @var{decl}
9899is the TLS object and @var{tmpl_addr} is the address of the
9900initializer. The default initializes libgcc's emulated TLS control object.
9901@end deftypefn
9902
9903@hook TARGET_EMUTLS_VAR_ALIGN_FIXED
9904Specifies whether the alignment of TLS control variable objects is
9905fixed and should not be increased as some backends may do to optimize
9906single objects. The default is false.
9907@end deftypevr
9908
9909@hook TARGET_EMUTLS_DEBUG_FORM_TLS_ADDRESS
9910Specifies whether a DWARF @code{DW_OP_form_tls_address} location descriptor
9911may be used to describe emulated TLS control objects.
9912@end deftypevr
9913
9914@node MIPS Coprocessors
9915@section Defining coprocessor specifics for MIPS targets.
9916@cindex MIPS coprocessor-definition macros
9917
9918The MIPS specification allows MIPS implementations to have as many as 4
9919coprocessors, each with as many as 32 private registers. GCC supports
9920accessing these registers and transferring values between the registers
9921and memory using asm-ized variables. For example:
9922
9923@smallexample
9924 register unsigned int cp0count asm ("c0r1");
9925 unsigned int d;
9926
9927 d = cp0count + 3;
9928@end smallexample
9929
9930(``c0r1'' is the default name of register 1 in coprocessor 0; alternate
9931names may be added as described below, or the default names may be
9932overridden entirely in @code{SUBTARGET_CONDITIONAL_REGISTER_USAGE}.)
9933
9934Coprocessor registers are assumed to be epilogue-used; sets to them will
9935be preserved even if it does not appear that the register is used again
9936later in the function.
9937
9938Another note: according to the MIPS spec, coprocessor 1 (if present) is
9939the FPU@. One accesses COP1 registers through standard mips
9940floating-point support; they are not included in this mechanism.
9941
9942There is one macro used in defining the MIPS coprocessor interface which
9943you may want to override in subtargets; it is described below.
9944
9945@defmac ALL_COP_ADDITIONAL_REGISTER_NAMES
9946A comma-separated list (with leading comma) of pairs describing the
9947alternate names of coprocessor registers. The format of each entry should be
9948@smallexample
9949@{ @var{alternatename}, @var{register_number}@}
9950@end smallexample
9951Default: empty.
9952@end defmac
9953
9954@node PCH Target
9955@section Parameters for Precompiled Header Validity Checking
9956@cindex parameters, precompiled headers
9957
9958@hook TARGET_GET_PCH_VALIDITY
9959This hook returns a pointer to the data needed by
9960@code{TARGET_PCH_VALID_P} and sets
9961@samp{*@var{sz}} to the size of the data in bytes.
9962@end deftypefn
9963
9964@hook TARGET_PCH_VALID_P
9965This hook checks whether the options used to create a PCH file are
9966compatible with the current settings. It returns @code{NULL}
9967if so and a suitable error message if not. Error messages will
9968be presented to the user and must be localized using @samp{_(@var{msg})}.
9969
9970@var{data} is the data that was returned by @code{TARGET_GET_PCH_VALIDITY}
9971when the PCH file was created and @var{sz} is the size of that data in bytes.
9972It's safe to assume that the data was created by the same version of the
9973compiler, so no format checking is needed.
9974
9975The default definition of @code{default_pch_valid_p} should be
9976suitable for most targets.
9977@end deftypefn
9978
9979@hook TARGET_CHECK_PCH_TARGET_FLAGS
9980If this hook is nonnull, the default implementation of
9981@code{TARGET_PCH_VALID_P} will use it to check for compatible values
9982of @code{target_flags}. @var{pch_flags} specifies the value that
9983@code{target_flags} had when the PCH file was created. The return
9984value is the same as for @code{TARGET_PCH_VALID_P}.
9985@end deftypefn
9986
9987@node C++ ABI
9988@section C++ ABI parameters
9989@cindex parameters, c++ abi
9990
9991@hook TARGET_CXX_GUARD_TYPE
9992Define this hook to override the integer type used for guard variables.
9993These are used to implement one-time construction of static objects. The
9994default is long_long_integer_type_node.
9995@end deftypefn
9996
9997@hook TARGET_CXX_GUARD_MASK_BIT
9998This hook determines how guard variables are used. It should return
9999@code{false} (the default) if the first byte should be used. A return value of
10000@code{true} indicates that only the least significant bit should be used.
10001@end deftypefn
10002
10003@hook TARGET_CXX_GET_COOKIE_SIZE
10004This hook returns the size of the cookie to use when allocating an array
10005whose elements have the indicated @var{type}. Assumes that it is already
10006known that a cookie is needed. The default is
10007@code{max(sizeof (size_t), alignof(type))}, as defined in section 2.7 of the
10008IA64/Generic C++ ABI@.
10009@end deftypefn
10010
10011@hook TARGET_CXX_COOKIE_HAS_SIZE
10012This hook should return @code{true} if the element size should be stored in
10013array cookies. The default is to return @code{false}.
10014@end deftypefn
10015
10016@hook TARGET_CXX_IMPORT_EXPORT_CLASS
10017If defined by a backend this hook allows the decision made to export
10018class @var{type} to be overruled. Upon entry @var{import_export}
10019will contain 1 if the class is going to be exported, @minus{}1 if it is going
10020to be imported and 0 otherwise. This function should return the
10021modified value and perform any other actions necessary to support the
10022backend's targeted operating system.
10023@end deftypefn
10024
10025@hook TARGET_CXX_CDTOR_RETURNS_THIS
10026This hook should return @code{true} if constructors and destructors return
10027the address of the object created/destroyed. The default is to return
10028@code{false}.
10029@end deftypefn
10030
10031@hook TARGET_CXX_KEY_METHOD_MAY_BE_INLINE
10032This hook returns true if the key method for a class (i.e., the method
10033which, if defined in the current translation unit, causes the virtual
10034table to be emitted) may be an inline function. Under the standard
10035Itanium C++ ABI the key method may be an inline function so long as
10036the function is not declared inline in the class definition. Under
10037some variants of the ABI, an inline function can never be the key
10038method. The default is to return @code{true}.
10039@end deftypefn
10040
10041@hook TARGET_CXX_DETERMINE_CLASS_DATA_VISIBILITY
10042
10043@hook TARGET_CXX_CLASS_DATA_ALWAYS_COMDAT
10044This hook returns true (the default) if virtual tables and other
10045similar implicit class data objects are always COMDAT if they have
10046external linkage. If this hook returns false, then class data for
10047classes whose virtual table will be emitted in only one translation
10048unit will not be COMDAT.
10049@end deftypefn
10050
10051@hook TARGET_CXX_LIBRARY_RTTI_COMDAT
10052This hook returns true (the default) if the RTTI information for
10053the basic types which is defined in the C++ runtime should always
10054be COMDAT, false if it should not be COMDAT.
10055@end deftypefn
10056
10057@hook TARGET_CXX_USE_AEABI_ATEXIT
10058This hook returns true if @code{__aeabi_atexit} (as defined by the ARM EABI)
10059should be used to register static destructors when @option{-fuse-cxa-atexit}
10060is in effect. The default is to return false to use @code{__cxa_atexit}.
10061@end deftypefn
10062
10063@hook TARGET_CXX_USE_ATEXIT_FOR_CXA_ATEXIT
10064This hook returns true if the target @code{atexit} function can be used
10065in the same manner as @code{__cxa_atexit} to register C++ static
10066destructors. This requires that @code{atexit}-registered functions in
10067shared libraries are run in the correct order when the libraries are
10068unloaded. The default is to return false.
10069@end deftypefn
10070
10071@hook TARGET_CXX_ADJUST_CLASS_AT_DEFINITION
10072
10073@node Named Address Spaces
10074@section Adding support for named address spaces
10075@cindex named address spaces
10076
10077The draft technical report of the ISO/IEC JTC1 S22 WG14 N1275
10078standards committee, @cite{Programming Languages - C - Extensions to
10079support embedded processors}, specifies a syntax for embedded
10080processors to specify alternate address spaces. You can configure a
10081GCC port to support section 5.1 of the draft report to add support for
10082address spaces other than the default address space. These address
10083spaces are new keywords that are similar to the @code{volatile} and
10084@code{const} type attributes.
10085
10086Pointers to named address spaces can have a different size than
10087pointers to the generic address space.
10088
10089For example, the SPU port uses the @code{__ea} address space to refer
10090to memory in the host processor, rather than memory local to the SPU
10091processor. Access to memory in the @code{__ea} address space involves
10092issuing DMA operations to move data between the host processor and the
10093local processor memory address space. Pointers in the @code{__ea}
10094address space are either 32 bits or 64 bits based on the
10095@option{-mea32} or @option{-mea64} switches (native SPU pointers are
10096always 32 bits).
10097
10098Internally, address spaces are represented as a small integer in the
10099range 0 to 15 with address space 0 being reserved for the generic
10100address space.
10101
10102To register a named address space qualifier keyword with the C front end,
10103the target may call the @code{c_register_addr_space} routine. For example,
10104the SPU port uses the following to declare @code{__ea} as the keyword for
10105named address space #1:
10106@smallexample
10107#define ADDR_SPACE_EA 1
10108c_register_addr_space ("__ea", ADDR_SPACE_EA);
10109@end smallexample
10110
10111@hook TARGET_ADDR_SPACE_POINTER_MODE
10112Define this to return the machine mode to use for pointers to
10113@var{address_space} if the target supports named address spaces.
10114The default version of this hook returns @code{ptr_mode} for the
10115generic address space only.
10116@end deftypefn
10117
10118@hook TARGET_ADDR_SPACE_ADDRESS_MODE
10119Define this to return the machine mode to use for addresses in
10120@var{address_space} if the target supports named address spaces.
10121The default version of this hook returns @code{Pmode} for the
10122generic address space only.
10123@end deftypefn
10124
10125@hook TARGET_ADDR_SPACE_VALID_POINTER_MODE
10126Define this to return nonzero if the port can handle pointers
10127with machine mode @var{mode} to address space @var{as}. This target
10128hook is the same as the @code{TARGET_VALID_POINTER_MODE} target hook,
10129except that it includes explicit named address space support. The default
10130version of this hook returns true for the modes returned by either the
10131@code{TARGET_ADDR_SPACE_POINTER_MODE} or @code{TARGET_ADDR_SPACE_ADDRESS_MODE}
10132target hooks for the given address space.
10133@end deftypefn
10134
10135@hook TARGET_ADDR_SPACE_LEGITIMATE_ADDRESS_P
10136Define this to return true if @var{exp} is a valid address for mode
10137@var{mode} in the named address space @var{as}. The @var{strict}
10138parameter says whether strict addressing is in effect after reload has
10139finished. This target hook is the same as the
10140@code{TARGET_LEGITIMATE_ADDRESS_P} target hook, except that it includes
10141explicit named address space support.
10142@end deftypefn
10143
10144@hook TARGET_ADDR_SPACE_LEGITIMIZE_ADDRESS
10145Define this to modify an invalid address @var{x} to be a valid address
10146with mode @var{mode} in the named address space @var{as}. This target
10147hook is the same as the @code{TARGET_LEGITIMIZE_ADDRESS} target hook,
10148except that it includes explicit named address space support.
10149@end deftypefn
10150
10151@hook TARGET_ADDR_SPACE_SUBSET_P
10152Define this to return whether the @var{subset} named address space is
10153contained within the @var{superset} named address space. Pointers to
10154a named address space that is a subset of another named address space
10155will be converted automatically without a cast if used together in
10156arithmetic operations. Pointers to a superset address space can be
10157converted to pointers to a subset address space via explicit casts.
10158@end deftypefn
10159
10160@hook TARGET_ADDR_SPACE_CONVERT
10161Define this to convert the pointer expression represented by the RTL
10162@var{op} with type @var{from_type} that points to a named address
10163space to a new pointer expression with type @var{to_type} that points
10164to a different named address space. When this hook it called, it is
10165guaranteed that one of the two address spaces is a subset of the other,
10166as determined by the @code{TARGET_ADDR_SPACE_SUBSET_P} target hook.
10167@end deftypefn
10168
10169@node Misc
10170@section Miscellaneous Parameters
10171@cindex parameters, miscellaneous
10172
10173@c prevent bad page break with this line
10174Here are several miscellaneous parameters.
10175
10176@defmac HAS_LONG_COND_BRANCH
10177Define this boolean macro to indicate whether or not your architecture
10178has conditional branches that can span all of memory. It is used in
10179conjunction with an optimization that partitions hot and cold basic
10180blocks into separate sections of the executable. If this macro is
10181set to false, gcc will convert any conditional branches that attempt
10182to cross between sections into unconditional branches or indirect jumps.
10183@end defmac
10184
10185@defmac HAS_LONG_UNCOND_BRANCH
10186Define this boolean macro to indicate whether or not your architecture
10187has unconditional branches that can span all of memory. It is used in
10188conjunction with an optimization that partitions hot and cold basic
10189blocks into separate sections of the executable. If this macro is
10190set to false, gcc will convert any unconditional branches that attempt
10191to cross between sections into indirect jumps.
10192@end defmac
10193
10194@defmac CASE_VECTOR_MODE
10195An alias for a machine mode name. This is the machine mode that
10196elements of a jump-table should have.
10197@end defmac
10198
10199@defmac CASE_VECTOR_SHORTEN_MODE (@var{min_offset}, @var{max_offset}, @var{body})
10200Optional: return the preferred mode for an @code{addr_diff_vec}
10201when the minimum and maximum offset are known. If you define this,
10202it enables extra code in branch shortening to deal with @code{addr_diff_vec}.
10203To make this work, you also have to define @code{INSN_ALIGN} and
10204make the alignment for @code{addr_diff_vec} explicit.
10205The @var{body} argument is provided so that the offset_unsigned and scale
10206flags can be updated.
10207@end defmac
10208
10209@defmac CASE_VECTOR_PC_RELATIVE
10210Define this macro to be a C expression to indicate when jump-tables
10211should contain relative addresses. You need not define this macro if
10212jump-tables never contain relative addresses, or jump-tables should
10213contain relative addresses only when @option{-fPIC} or @option{-fPIC}
10214is in effect.
10215@end defmac
10216
10217@hook TARGET_CASE_VALUES_THRESHOLD
10218This function return the smallest number of different values for which it
10219is best to use a jump-table instead of a tree of conditional branches.
10220The default is four for machines with a @code{casesi} instruction and
10221five otherwise. This is best for most machines.
10222@end deftypefn
10223
10224@defmac CASE_USE_BIT_TESTS
10225Define this macro to be a C expression to indicate whether C switch
10226statements may be implemented by a sequence of bit tests. This is
10227advantageous on processors that can efficiently implement left shift
10228of 1 by the number of bits held in a register, but inappropriate on
10229targets that would require a loop. By default, this macro returns
10230@code{true} if the target defines an @code{ashlsi3} pattern, and
10231@code{false} otherwise.
10232@end defmac
10233
10234@defmac WORD_REGISTER_OPERATIONS
10235Define this macro if operations between registers with integral mode
10236smaller than a word are always performed on the entire register.
10237Most RISC machines have this property and most CISC machines do not.
10238@end defmac
10239
10240@defmac LOAD_EXTEND_OP (@var{mem_mode})
10241Define this macro to be a C expression indicating when insns that read
10242memory in @var{mem_mode}, an integral mode narrower than a word, set the
10243bits outside of @var{mem_mode} to be either the sign-extension or the
10244zero-extension of the data read. Return @code{SIGN_EXTEND} for values
10245of @var{mem_mode} for which the
10246insn sign-extends, @code{ZERO_EXTEND} for which it zero-extends, and
10247@code{UNKNOWN} for other modes.
10248
10249This macro is not called with @var{mem_mode} non-integral or with a width
10250greater than or equal to @code{BITS_PER_WORD}, so you may return any
10251value in this case. Do not define this macro if it would always return
10252@code{UNKNOWN}. On machines where this macro is defined, you will normally
10253define it as the constant @code{SIGN_EXTEND} or @code{ZERO_EXTEND}.
10254
10255You may return a non-@code{UNKNOWN} value even if for some hard registers
10256the sign extension is not performed, if for the @code{REGNO_REG_CLASS}
10257of these hard registers @code{CANNOT_CHANGE_MODE_CLASS} returns nonzero
10258when the @var{from} mode is @var{mem_mode} and the @var{to} mode is any
10259integral mode larger than this but not larger than @code{word_mode}.
10260
10261You must return @code{UNKNOWN} if for some hard registers that allow this
10262mode, @code{CANNOT_CHANGE_MODE_CLASS} says that they cannot change to
10263@code{word_mode}, but that they can change to another integral mode that
10264is larger then @var{mem_mode} but still smaller than @code{word_mode}.
10265@end defmac
10266
10267@defmac SHORT_IMMEDIATES_SIGN_EXTEND
10268Define this macro if loading short immediate values into registers sign
10269extends.
10270@end defmac
10271
10272@defmac FIXUNS_TRUNC_LIKE_FIX_TRUNC
10273Define this macro if the same instructions that convert a floating
10274point number to a signed fixed point number also convert validly to an
10275unsigned one.
10276@end defmac
10277
10278@hook TARGET_MIN_DIVISIONS_FOR_RECIP_MUL
10279When @option{-ffast-math} is in effect, GCC tries to optimize
10280divisions by the same divisor, by turning them into multiplications by
10281the reciprocal. This target hook specifies the minimum number of divisions
10282that should be there for GCC to perform the optimization for a variable
10283of mode @var{mode}. The default implementation returns 3 if the machine
10284has an instruction for the division, and 2 if it does not.
10285@end deftypefn
10286
10287@defmac MOVE_MAX
10288The maximum number of bytes that a single instruction can move quickly
10289between memory and registers or between two memory locations.
10290@end defmac
10291
10292@defmac MAX_MOVE_MAX
10293The maximum number of bytes that a single instruction can move quickly
10294between memory and registers or between two memory locations. If this
10295is undefined, the default is @code{MOVE_MAX}. Otherwise, it is the
10296constant value that is the largest value that @code{MOVE_MAX} can have
10297at run-time.
10298@end defmac
10299
10300@defmac SHIFT_COUNT_TRUNCATED
10301A C expression that is nonzero if on this machine the number of bits
10302actually used for the count of a shift operation is equal to the number
10303of bits needed to represent the size of the object being shifted. When
10304this macro is nonzero, the compiler will assume that it is safe to omit
10305a sign-extend, zero-extend, and certain bitwise `and' instructions that
10306truncates the count of a shift operation. On machines that have
10307instructions that act on bit-fields at variable positions, which may
10308include `bit test' instructions, a nonzero @code{SHIFT_COUNT_TRUNCATED}
10309also enables deletion of truncations of the values that serve as
10310arguments to bit-field instructions.
10311
10312If both types of instructions truncate the count (for shifts) and
10313position (for bit-field operations), or if no variable-position bit-field
10314instructions exist, you should define this macro.
10315
10316However, on some machines, such as the 80386 and the 680x0, truncation
10317only applies to shift operations and not the (real or pretended)
10318bit-field operations. Define @code{SHIFT_COUNT_TRUNCATED} to be zero on
10319such machines. Instead, add patterns to the @file{md} file that include
10320the implied truncation of the shift instructions.
10321
10322You need not define this macro if it would always have the value of zero.
10323@end defmac
10324
10325@anchor{TARGET_SHIFT_TRUNCATION_MASK}
10326@hook TARGET_SHIFT_TRUNCATION_MASK
10327This function describes how the standard shift patterns for @var{mode}
10328deal with shifts by negative amounts or by more than the width of the mode.
10329@xref{shift patterns}.
10330
10331On many machines, the shift patterns will apply a mask @var{m} to the
10332shift count, meaning that a fixed-width shift of @var{x} by @var{y} is
10333equivalent to an arbitrary-width shift of @var{x} by @var{y & m}. If
10334this is true for mode @var{mode}, the function should return @var{m},
10335otherwise it should return 0. A return value of 0 indicates that no
10336particular behavior is guaranteed.
10337
10338Note that, unlike @code{SHIFT_COUNT_TRUNCATED}, this function does
10339@emph{not} apply to general shift rtxes; it applies only to instructions
10340that are generated by the named shift patterns.
10341
10342The default implementation of this function returns
10343@code{GET_MODE_BITSIZE (@var{mode}) - 1} if @code{SHIFT_COUNT_TRUNCATED}
10344and 0 otherwise. This definition is always safe, but if
10345@code{SHIFT_COUNT_TRUNCATED} is false, and some shift patterns
10346nevertheless truncate the shift count, you may get better code
10347by overriding it.
10348@end deftypefn
10349
10350@defmac TRULY_NOOP_TRUNCATION (@var{outprec}, @var{inprec})
10351A C expression which is nonzero if on this machine it is safe to
10352``convert'' an integer of @var{inprec} bits to one of @var{outprec}
10353bits (where @var{outprec} is smaller than @var{inprec}) by merely
10354operating on it as if it had only @var{outprec} bits.
10355
10356On many machines, this expression can be 1.
10357
10358@c rearranged this, removed the phrase "it is reported that". this was
10359@c to fix an overfull hbox. --mew 10feb93
10360When @code{TRULY_NOOP_TRUNCATION} returns 1 for a pair of sizes for
10361modes for which @code{MODES_TIEABLE_P} is 0, suboptimal code can result.
10362If this is the case, making @code{TRULY_NOOP_TRUNCATION} return 0 in
10363such cases may improve things.
10364@end defmac
10365
10366@hook TARGET_MODE_REP_EXTENDED
10367The representation of an integral mode can be such that the values
10368are always extended to a wider integral mode. Return
10369@code{SIGN_EXTEND} if values of @var{mode} are represented in
10370sign-extended form to @var{rep_mode}. Return @code{UNKNOWN}
10371otherwise. (Currently, none of the targets use zero-extended
10372representation this way so unlike @code{LOAD_EXTEND_OP},
10373@code{TARGET_MODE_REP_EXTENDED} is expected to return either
10374@code{SIGN_EXTEND} or @code{UNKNOWN}. Also no target extends
10375@var{mode} to @var{rep_mode} so that @var{rep_mode} is not the next
10376widest integral mode and currently we take advantage of this fact.)
10377
10378Similarly to @code{LOAD_EXTEND_OP} you may return a non-@code{UNKNOWN}
10379value even if the extension is not performed on certain hard registers
10380as long as for the @code{REGNO_REG_CLASS} of these hard registers
10381@code{CANNOT_CHANGE_MODE_CLASS} returns nonzero.
10382
10383Note that @code{TARGET_MODE_REP_EXTENDED} and @code{LOAD_EXTEND_OP}
10384describe two related properties. If you define
10385@code{TARGET_MODE_REP_EXTENDED (mode, word_mode)} you probably also want
10386to define @code{LOAD_EXTEND_OP (mode)} to return the same type of
10387extension.
10388
10389In order to enforce the representation of @code{mode},
10390@code{TRULY_NOOP_TRUNCATION} should return false when truncating to
10391@code{mode}.
10392@end deftypefn
10393
10394@defmac STORE_FLAG_VALUE
10395A C expression describing the value returned by a comparison operator
10396with an integral mode and stored by a store-flag instruction
10397(@samp{cstore@var{mode}4}) when the condition is true. This description must
10398apply to @emph{all} the @samp{cstore@var{mode}4} patterns and all the
10399comparison operators whose results have a @code{MODE_INT} mode.
10400
10401A value of 1 or @minus{}1 means that the instruction implementing the
10402comparison operator returns exactly 1 or @minus{}1 when the comparison is true
10403and 0 when the comparison is false. Otherwise, the value indicates
10404which bits of the result are guaranteed to be 1 when the comparison is
10405true. This value is interpreted in the mode of the comparison
10406operation, which is given by the mode of the first operand in the
10407@samp{cstore@var{mode}4} pattern. Either the low bit or the sign bit of
10408@code{STORE_FLAG_VALUE} be on. Presently, only those bits are used by
10409the compiler.
10410
10411If @code{STORE_FLAG_VALUE} is neither 1 or @minus{}1, the compiler will
10412generate code that depends only on the specified bits. It can also
10413replace comparison operators with equivalent operations if they cause
10414the required bits to be set, even if the remaining bits are undefined.
10415For example, on a machine whose comparison operators return an
10416@code{SImode} value and where @code{STORE_FLAG_VALUE} is defined as
10417@samp{0x80000000}, saying that just the sign bit is relevant, the
10418expression
10419
10420@smallexample
10421(ne:SI (and:SI @var{x} (const_int @var{power-of-2})) (const_int 0))
10422@end smallexample
10423
10424@noindent
10425can be converted to
10426
10427@smallexample
10428(ashift:SI @var{x} (const_int @var{n}))
10429@end smallexample
10430
10431@noindent
10432where @var{n} is the appropriate shift count to move the bit being
10433tested into the sign bit.
10434
10435There is no way to describe a machine that always sets the low-order bit
10436for a true value, but does not guarantee the value of any other bits,
10437but we do not know of any machine that has such an instruction. If you
10438are trying to port GCC to such a machine, include an instruction to
10439perform a logical-and of the result with 1 in the pattern for the
10440comparison operators and let us know at @email{gcc@@gcc.gnu.org}.
10441
10442Often, a machine will have multiple instructions that obtain a value
10443from a comparison (or the condition codes). Here are rules to guide the
10444choice of value for @code{STORE_FLAG_VALUE}, and hence the instructions
10445to be used:
10446
10447@itemize @bullet
10448@item
10449Use the shortest sequence that yields a valid definition for
10450@code{STORE_FLAG_VALUE}. It is more efficient for the compiler to
10451``normalize'' the value (convert it to, e.g., 1 or 0) than for the
10452comparison operators to do so because there may be opportunities to
10453combine the normalization with other operations.
10454
10455@item
10456For equal-length sequences, use a value of 1 or @minus{}1, with @minus{}1 being
10457slightly preferred on machines with expensive jumps and 1 preferred on
10458other machines.
10459
10460@item
10461As a second choice, choose a value of @samp{0x80000001} if instructions
10462exist that set both the sign and low-order bits but do not define the
10463others.
10464
10465@item
10466Otherwise, use a value of @samp{0x80000000}.
10467@end itemize
10468
10469Many machines can produce both the value chosen for
10470@code{STORE_FLAG_VALUE} and its negation in the same number of
10471instructions. On those machines, you should also define a pattern for
10472those cases, e.g., one matching
10473
10474@smallexample
10475(set @var{A} (neg:@var{m} (ne:@var{m} @var{B} @var{C})))
10476@end smallexample
10477
10478Some machines can also perform @code{and} or @code{plus} operations on
10479condition code values with less instructions than the corresponding
10480@samp{cstore@var{mode}4} insn followed by @code{and} or @code{plus}. On those
10481machines, define the appropriate patterns. Use the names @code{incscc}
10482and @code{decscc}, respectively, for the patterns which perform
10483@code{plus} or @code{minus} operations on condition code values. See
10484@file{rs6000.md} for some examples. The GNU Superoptizer can be used to
10485find such instruction sequences on other machines.
10486
10487If this macro is not defined, the default value, 1, is used. You need
10488not define @code{STORE_FLAG_VALUE} if the machine has no store-flag
10489instructions, or if the value generated by these instructions is 1.
10490@end defmac
10491
10492@defmac FLOAT_STORE_FLAG_VALUE (@var{mode})
10493A C expression that gives a nonzero @code{REAL_VALUE_TYPE} value that is
10494returned when comparison operators with floating-point results are true.
10495Define this macro on machines that have comparison operations that return
10496floating-point values. If there are no such operations, do not define
10497this macro.
10498@end defmac
10499
10500@defmac VECTOR_STORE_FLAG_VALUE (@var{mode})
10501A C expression that gives a rtx representing the nonzero true element
10502for vector comparisons. The returned rtx should be valid for the inner
10503mode of @var{mode} which is guaranteed to be a vector mode. Define
10504this macro on machines that have vector comparison operations that
10505return a vector result. If there are no such operations, do not define
10506this macro. Typically, this macro is defined as @code{const1_rtx} or
10507@code{constm1_rtx}. This macro may return @code{NULL_RTX} to prevent
10508the compiler optimizing such vector comparison operations for the
10509given mode.
10510@end defmac
10511
10512@defmac CLZ_DEFINED_VALUE_AT_ZERO (@var{mode}, @var{value})
10513@defmacx CTZ_DEFINED_VALUE_AT_ZERO (@var{mode}, @var{value})
10514A C expression that indicates whether the architecture defines a value
10515for @code{clz} or @code{ctz} with a zero operand.
10516A result of @code{0} indicates the value is undefined.
10517If the value is defined for only the RTL expression, the macro should
10518evaluate to @code{1}; if the value applies also to the corresponding optab
10519entry (which is normally the case if it expands directly into
10520the corresponding RTL), then the macro should evaluate to @code{2}.
10521In the cases where the value is defined, @var{value} should be set to
10522this value.
10523
10524If this macro is not defined, the value of @code{clz} or
10525@code{ctz} at zero is assumed to be undefined.
10526
10527This macro must be defined if the target's expansion for @code{ffs}
10528relies on a particular value to get correct results. Otherwise it
10529is not necessary, though it may be used to optimize some corner cases, and
10530to provide a default expansion for the @code{ffs} optab.
10531
10532Note that regardless of this macro the ``definedness'' of @code{clz}
10533and @code{ctz} at zero do @emph{not} extend to the builtin functions
10534visible to the user. Thus one may be free to adjust the value at will
10535to match the target expansion of these operations without fear of
10536breaking the API@.
10537@end defmac
10538
10539@defmac Pmode
10540An alias for the machine mode for pointers. On most machines, define
10541this to be the integer mode corresponding to the width of a hardware
10542pointer; @code{SImode} on 32-bit machine or @code{DImode} on 64-bit machines.
10543On some machines you must define this to be one of the partial integer
10544modes, such as @code{PSImode}.
10545
10546The width of @code{Pmode} must be at least as large as the value of
10547@code{POINTER_SIZE}. If it is not equal, you must define the macro
10548@code{POINTERS_EXTEND_UNSIGNED} to specify how pointers are extended
10549to @code{Pmode}.
10550@end defmac
10551
10552@defmac FUNCTION_MODE
10553An alias for the machine mode used for memory references to functions
10554being called, in @code{call} RTL expressions. On most CISC machines,
10555where an instruction can begin at any byte address, this should be
10556@code{QImode}. On most RISC machines, where all instructions have fixed
10557size and alignment, this should be a mode with the same size and alignment
10558as the machine instruction words - typically @code{SImode} or @code{HImode}.
10559@end defmac
10560
10561@defmac STDC_0_IN_SYSTEM_HEADERS
10562In normal operation, the preprocessor expands @code{__STDC__} to the
10563constant 1, to signify that GCC conforms to ISO Standard C@. On some
10564hosts, like Solaris, the system compiler uses a different convention,
10565where @code{__STDC__} is normally 0, but is 1 if the user specifies
10566strict conformance to the C Standard.
10567
10568Defining @code{STDC_0_IN_SYSTEM_HEADERS} makes GNU CPP follows the host
10569convention when processing system header files, but when processing user
10570files @code{__STDC__} will always expand to 1.
10571@end defmac
10572
10573@defmac NO_IMPLICIT_EXTERN_C
10574Define this macro if the system header files support C++ as well as C@.
10575This macro inhibits the usual method of using system header files in
10576C++, which is to pretend that the file's contents are enclosed in
10577@samp{extern "C" @{@dots{}@}}.
10578@end defmac
10579
10580@findex #pragma
10581@findex pragma
10582@defmac REGISTER_TARGET_PRAGMAS ()
10583Define this macro if you want to implement any target-specific pragmas.
10584If defined, it is a C expression which makes a series of calls to
10585@code{c_register_pragma} or @code{c_register_pragma_with_expansion}
10586for each pragma. The macro may also do any
10587setup required for the pragmas.
10588
10589The primary reason to define this macro is to provide compatibility with
10590other compilers for the same target. In general, we discourage
10591definition of target-specific pragmas for GCC@.
10592
10593If the pragma can be implemented by attributes then you should consider
10594defining the target hook @samp{TARGET_INSERT_ATTRIBUTES} as well.
10595
10596Preprocessor macros that appear on pragma lines are not expanded. All
10597@samp{#pragma} directives that do not match any registered pragma are
10598silently ignored, unless the user specifies @option{-Wunknown-pragmas}.
10599@end defmac
10600
10601@deftypefun void c_register_pragma (const char *@var{space}, const char *@var{name}, void (*@var{callback}) (struct cpp_reader *))
10602@deftypefunx void c_register_pragma_with_expansion (const char *@var{space}, const char *@var{name}, void (*@var{callback}) (struct cpp_reader *))
10603
10604Each call to @code{c_register_pragma} or
10605@code{c_register_pragma_with_expansion} establishes one pragma. The
10606@var{callback} routine will be called when the preprocessor encounters a
10607pragma of the form
10608
10609@smallexample
10610#pragma [@var{space}] @var{name} @dots{}
10611@end smallexample
10612
10613@var{space} is the case-sensitive namespace of the pragma, or
10614@code{NULL} to put the pragma in the global namespace. The callback
10615routine receives @var{pfile} as its first argument, which can be passed
10616on to cpplib's functions if necessary. You can lex tokens after the
10617@var{name} by calling @code{pragma_lex}. Tokens that are not read by the
10618callback will be silently ignored. The end of the line is indicated by
10619a token of type @code{CPP_EOF}. Macro expansion occurs on the
10620arguments of pragmas registered with
10621@code{c_register_pragma_with_expansion} but not on the arguments of
10622pragmas registered with @code{c_register_pragma}.
10623
10624Note that the use of @code{pragma_lex} is specific to the C and C++
10625compilers. It will not work in the Java or Fortran compilers, or any
10626other language compilers for that matter. Thus if @code{pragma_lex} is going
10627to be called from target-specific code, it must only be done so when
10628building the C and C++ compilers. This can be done by defining the
10629variables @code{c_target_objs} and @code{cxx_target_objs} in the
10630target entry in the @file{config.gcc} file. These variables should name
10631the target-specific, language-specific object file which contains the
10632code that uses @code{pragma_lex}. Note it will also be necessary to add a
10633rule to the makefile fragment pointed to by @code{tmake_file} that shows
10634how to build this object file.
10635@end deftypefun
10636
10637@findex #pragma
10638@findex pragma
10639@defmac HANDLE_SYSV_PRAGMA
10640Define this macro (to a value of 1) if you want the System V style
10641pragmas @samp{#pragma pack(<n>)} and @samp{#pragma weak <name>
10642[=<value>]} to be supported by gcc.
10643
10644The pack pragma specifies the maximum alignment (in bytes) of fields
10645within a structure, in much the same way as the @samp{__aligned__} and
10646@samp{__packed__} @code{__attribute__}s do. A pack value of zero resets
10647the behavior to the default.
10648
10649A subtlety for Microsoft Visual C/C++ style bit-field packing
10650(e.g.@: -mms-bitfields) for targets that support it:
10651When a bit-field is inserted into a packed record, the whole size
10652of the underlying type is used by one or more same-size adjacent
10653bit-fields (that is, if its long:3, 32 bits is used in the record,
10654and any additional adjacent long bit-fields are packed into the same
10655chunk of 32 bits. However, if the size changes, a new field of that
10656size is allocated).
10657
10658If both MS bit-fields and @samp{__attribute__((packed))} are used,
10659the latter will take precedence. If @samp{__attribute__((packed))} is
10660used on a single field when MS bit-fields are in use, it will take
10661precedence for that field, but the alignment of the rest of the structure
10662may affect its placement.
10663
10664The weak pragma only works if @code{SUPPORTS_WEAK} and
10665@code{ASM_WEAKEN_LABEL} are defined. If enabled it allows the creation
10666of specifically named weak labels, optionally with a value.
10667@end defmac
10668
10669@findex #pragma
10670@findex pragma
10671@defmac HANDLE_PRAGMA_PACK_PUSH_POP
10672Define this macro (to a value of 1) if you want to support the Win32
10673style pragmas @samp{#pragma pack(push[,@var{n}])} and @samp{#pragma
10674pack(pop)}. The @samp{pack(push,[@var{n}])} pragma specifies the maximum
10675alignment (in bytes) of fields within a structure, in much the same way as
10676the @samp{__aligned__} and @samp{__packed__} @code{__attribute__}s do. A
10677pack value of zero resets the behavior to the default. Successive
10678invocations of this pragma cause the previous values to be stacked, so
10679that invocations of @samp{#pragma pack(pop)} will return to the previous
10680value.
10681@end defmac
10682
10683@defmac HANDLE_PRAGMA_PACK_WITH_EXPANSION
10684Define this macro, as well as
10685@code{HANDLE_SYSV_PRAGMA}, if macros should be expanded in the
10686arguments of @samp{#pragma pack}.
10687@end defmac
10688
10689@hook TARGET_HANDLE_PRAGMA_EXTERN_PREFIX
10690
10691@defmac TARGET_DEFAULT_PACK_STRUCT
10692If your target requires a structure packing default other than 0 (meaning
10693the machine default), define this macro to the necessary value (in bytes).
10694This must be a value that would also be valid to use with
10695@samp{#pragma pack()} (that is, a small power of two).
10696@end defmac
10697
10698@defmac DOLLARS_IN_IDENTIFIERS
10699Define this macro to control use of the character @samp{$} in
10700identifier names for the C family of languages. 0 means @samp{$} is
10701not allowed by default; 1 means it is allowed. 1 is the default;
10702there is no need to define this macro in that case.
10703@end defmac
10704
10705@defmac NO_DOLLAR_IN_LABEL
10706Define this macro if the assembler does not accept the character
10707@samp{$} in label names. By default constructors and destructors in
10708G++ have @samp{$} in the identifiers. If this macro is defined,
10709@samp{.} is used instead.
10710@end defmac
10711
10712@defmac NO_DOT_IN_LABEL
10713Define this macro if the assembler does not accept the character
10714@samp{.} in label names. By default constructors and destructors in G++
10715have names that use @samp{.}. If this macro is defined, these names
10716are rewritten to avoid @samp{.}.
10717@end defmac
10718
10719@defmac INSN_SETS_ARE_DELAYED (@var{insn})
10720Define this macro as a C expression that is nonzero if it is safe for the
10721delay slot scheduler to place instructions in the delay slot of @var{insn},
10722even if they appear to use a resource set or clobbered in @var{insn}.
10723@var{insn} is always a @code{jump_insn} or an @code{insn}; GCC knows that
10724every @code{call_insn} has this behavior. On machines where some @code{insn}
10725or @code{jump_insn} is really a function call and hence has this behavior,
10726you should define this macro.
10727
10728You need not define this macro if it would always return zero.
10729@end defmac
10730
10731@defmac INSN_REFERENCES_ARE_DELAYED (@var{insn})
10732Define this macro as a C expression that is nonzero if it is safe for the
10733delay slot scheduler to place instructions in the delay slot of @var{insn},
10734even if they appear to set or clobber a resource referenced in @var{insn}.
10735@var{insn} is always a @code{jump_insn} or an @code{insn}. On machines where
10736some @code{insn} or @code{jump_insn} is really a function call and its operands
10737are registers whose use is actually in the subroutine it calls, you should
10738define this macro. Doing so allows the delay slot scheduler to move
10739instructions which copy arguments into the argument registers into the delay
10740slot of @var{insn}.
10741
10742You need not define this macro if it would always return zero.
10743@end defmac
10744
10745@defmac MULTIPLE_SYMBOL_SPACES
10746Define this macro as a C expression that is nonzero if, in some cases,
10747global symbols from one translation unit may not be bound to undefined
10748symbols in another translation unit without user intervention. For
10749instance, under Microsoft Windows symbols must be explicitly imported
10750from shared libraries (DLLs).
10751
10752You need not define this macro if it would always evaluate to zero.
10753@end defmac
10754
10755@hook TARGET_MD_ASM_CLOBBERS
10756This target hook should add to @var{clobbers} @code{STRING_CST} trees for
10757any hard regs the port wishes to automatically clobber for an asm.
10758It should return the result of the last @code{tree_cons} used to add a
10759clobber. The @var{outputs}, @var{inputs} and @var{clobber} lists are the
10760corresponding parameters to the asm and may be inspected to avoid
10761clobbering a register that is an input or output of the asm. You can use
10762@code{tree_overlaps_hard_reg_set}, declared in @file{tree.h}, to test
10763for overlap with regards to asm-declared registers.
10764@end deftypefn
10765
10766@defmac MATH_LIBRARY
10767Define this macro as a C string constant for the linker argument to link
d9d16a19
JM
10768in the system math library, minus the initial @samp{"-l"}, or
10769@samp{""} if the target does not have a
38f8b050
JR
10770separate math library.
10771
d9d16a19 10772You need only define this macro if the default of @samp{"m"} is wrong.
38f8b050
JR
10773@end defmac
10774
10775@defmac LIBRARY_PATH_ENV
10776Define this macro as a C string constant for the environment variable that
10777specifies where the linker should look for libraries.
10778
10779You need only define this macro if the default of @samp{"LIBRARY_PATH"}
10780is wrong.
10781@end defmac
10782
10783@defmac TARGET_POSIX_IO
10784Define this macro if the target supports the following POSIX@ file
10785functions, access, mkdir and file locking with fcntl / F_SETLKW@.
10786Defining @code{TARGET_POSIX_IO} will enable the test coverage code
10787to use file locking when exiting a program, which avoids race conditions
10788if the program has forked. It will also create directories at run-time
10789for cross-profiling.
10790@end defmac
10791
10792@defmac MAX_CONDITIONAL_EXECUTE
10793
10794A C expression for the maximum number of instructions to execute via
10795conditional execution instructions instead of a branch. A value of
10796@code{BRANCH_COST}+1 is the default if the machine does not use cc0, and
107971 if it does use cc0.
10798@end defmac
10799
10800@defmac IFCVT_MODIFY_TESTS (@var{ce_info}, @var{true_expr}, @var{false_expr})
10801Used if the target needs to perform machine-dependent modifications on the
10802conditionals used for turning basic blocks into conditionally executed code.
10803@var{ce_info} points to a data structure, @code{struct ce_if_block}, which
10804contains information about the currently processed blocks. @var{true_expr}
10805and @var{false_expr} are the tests that are used for converting the
10806then-block and the else-block, respectively. Set either @var{true_expr} or
10807@var{false_expr} to a null pointer if the tests cannot be converted.
10808@end defmac
10809
10810@defmac IFCVT_MODIFY_MULTIPLE_TESTS (@var{ce_info}, @var{bb}, @var{true_expr}, @var{false_expr})
10811Like @code{IFCVT_MODIFY_TESTS}, but used when converting more complicated
10812if-statements into conditions combined by @code{and} and @code{or} operations.
10813@var{bb} contains the basic block that contains the test that is currently
10814being processed and about to be turned into a condition.
10815@end defmac
10816
10817@defmac IFCVT_MODIFY_INSN (@var{ce_info}, @var{pattern}, @var{insn})
10818A C expression to modify the @var{PATTERN} of an @var{INSN} that is to
10819be converted to conditional execution format. @var{ce_info} points to
10820a data structure, @code{struct ce_if_block}, which contains information
10821about the currently processed blocks.
10822@end defmac
10823
10824@defmac IFCVT_MODIFY_FINAL (@var{ce_info})
10825A C expression to perform any final machine dependent modifications in
10826converting code to conditional execution. The involved basic blocks
10827can be found in the @code{struct ce_if_block} structure that is pointed
10828to by @var{ce_info}.
10829@end defmac
10830
10831@defmac IFCVT_MODIFY_CANCEL (@var{ce_info})
10832A C expression to cancel any machine dependent modifications in
10833converting code to conditional execution. The involved basic blocks
10834can be found in the @code{struct ce_if_block} structure that is pointed
10835to by @var{ce_info}.
10836@end defmac
10837
10838@defmac IFCVT_INIT_EXTRA_FIELDS (@var{ce_info})
10839A C expression to initialize any extra fields in a @code{struct ce_if_block}
10840structure, which are defined by the @code{IFCVT_EXTRA_FIELDS} macro.
10841@end defmac
10842
10843@defmac IFCVT_EXTRA_FIELDS
10844If defined, it should expand to a set of field declarations that will be
10845added to the @code{struct ce_if_block} structure. These should be initialized
10846by the @code{IFCVT_INIT_EXTRA_FIELDS} macro.
10847@end defmac
10848
10849@hook TARGET_MACHINE_DEPENDENT_REORG
10850If non-null, this hook performs a target-specific pass over the
10851instruction stream. The compiler will run it at all optimization levels,
10852just before the point at which it normally does delayed-branch scheduling.
10853
10854The exact purpose of the hook varies from target to target. Some use
10855it to do transformations that are necessary for correctness, such as
10856laying out in-function constant pools or avoiding hardware hazards.
10857Others use it as an opportunity to do some machine-dependent optimizations.
10858
10859You need not implement the hook if it has nothing to do. The default
10860definition is null.
10861@end deftypefn
10862
10863@hook TARGET_INIT_BUILTINS
10864Define this hook if you have any machine-specific built-in functions
10865that need to be defined. It should be a function that performs the
10866necessary setup.
10867
10868Machine specific built-in functions can be useful to expand special machine
10869instructions that would otherwise not normally be generated because
10870they have no equivalent in the source language (for example, SIMD vector
10871instructions or prefetch instructions).
10872
10873To create a built-in function, call the function
10874@code{lang_hooks.builtin_function}
10875which is defined by the language front end. You can use any type nodes set
10876up by @code{build_common_tree_nodes} and @code{build_common_tree_nodes_2};
10877only language front ends that use those two functions will call
10878@samp{TARGET_INIT_BUILTINS}.
10879@end deftypefn
10880
10881@hook TARGET_BUILTIN_DECL
10882Define this hook if you have any machine-specific built-in functions
10883that need to be defined. It should be a function that returns the
10884builtin function declaration for the builtin function code @var{code}.
10885If there is no such builtin and it cannot be initialized at this time
10886if @var{initialize_p} is true the function should return @code{NULL_TREE}.
10887If @var{code} is out of range the function should return
10888@code{error_mark_node}.
10889@end deftypefn
10890
10891@hook TARGET_EXPAND_BUILTIN
10892
10893Expand a call to a machine specific built-in function that was set up by
10894@samp{TARGET_INIT_BUILTINS}. @var{exp} is the expression for the
10895function call; the result should go to @var{target} if that is
10896convenient, and have mode @var{mode} if that is convenient.
10897@var{subtarget} may be used as the target for computing one of
10898@var{exp}'s operands. @var{ignore} is nonzero if the value is to be
10899ignored. This function should return the result of the call to the
10900built-in function.
10901@end deftypefn
10902
d66f5459 10903@hook TARGET_RESOLVE_OVERLOADED_BUILTIN
38f8b050
JR
10904Select a replacement for a machine specific built-in function that
10905was set up by @samp{TARGET_INIT_BUILTINS}. This is done
10906@emph{before} regular type checking, and so allows the target to
10907implement a crude form of function overloading. @var{fndecl} is the
10908declaration of the built-in function. @var{arglist} is the list of
10909arguments passed to the built-in function. The result is a
10910complete expression that implements the operation, usually
10911another @code{CALL_EXPR}.
10912@var{arglist} really has type @samp{VEC(tree,gc)*}
10913@end deftypefn
10914
08914aaa 10915@hook TARGET_FOLD_BUILTIN
38f8b050
JR
10916Fold a call to a machine specific built-in function that was set up by
10917@samp{TARGET_INIT_BUILTINS}. @var{fndecl} is the declaration of the
10918built-in function. @var{n_args} is the number of arguments passed to
10919the function; the arguments themselves are pointed to by @var{argp}.
10920The result is another tree containing a simplified expression for the
10921call's result. If @var{ignore} is true the value will be ignored.
10922@end deftypefn
10923
10924@hook TARGET_INVALID_WITHIN_DOLOOP
10925
10926Take an instruction in @var{insn} and return NULL if it is valid within a
10927low-overhead loop, otherwise return a string explaining why doloop
10928could not be applied.
10929
10930Many targets use special registers for low-overhead looping. For any
10931instruction that clobbers these this function should return a string indicating
10932the reason why the doloop could not be applied.
10933By default, the RTL loop optimizer does not use a present doloop pattern for
10934loops containing function calls or branch on table instructions.
10935@end deftypefn
10936
10937@defmac MD_CAN_REDIRECT_BRANCH (@var{branch1}, @var{branch2})
10938
10939Take a branch insn in @var{branch1} and another in @var{branch2}.
10940Return true if redirecting @var{branch1} to the destination of
10941@var{branch2} is possible.
10942
10943On some targets, branches may have a limited range. Optimizing the
10944filling of delay slots can result in branches being redirected, and this
10945may in turn cause a branch offset to overflow.
10946@end defmac
10947
10948@hook TARGET_COMMUTATIVE_P
10949This target hook returns @code{true} if @var{x} is considered to be commutative.
10950Usually, this is just COMMUTATIVE_P (@var{x}), but the HP PA doesn't consider
10951PLUS to be commutative inside a MEM@. @var{outer_code} is the rtx code
10952of the enclosing rtl, if known, otherwise it is UNKNOWN.
10953@end deftypefn
10954
10955@hook TARGET_ALLOCATE_INITIAL_VALUE
10956
10957When the initial value of a hard register has been copied in a pseudo
10958register, it is often not necessary to actually allocate another register
10959to this pseudo register, because the original hard register or a stack slot
10960it has been saved into can be used. @code{TARGET_ALLOCATE_INITIAL_VALUE}
10961is called at the start of register allocation once for each hard register
10962that had its initial value copied by using
10963@code{get_func_hard_reg_initial_val} or @code{get_hard_reg_initial_val}.
10964Possible values are @code{NULL_RTX}, if you don't want
10965to do any special allocation, a @code{REG} rtx---that would typically be
10966the hard register itself, if it is known not to be clobbered---or a
10967@code{MEM}.
10968If you are returning a @code{MEM}, this is only a hint for the allocator;
10969it might decide to use another register anyways.
10970You may use @code{current_function_leaf_function} in the hook, functions
10971that use @code{REG_N_SETS}, to determine if the hard
10972register in question will not be clobbered.
10973The default value of this hook is @code{NULL}, which disables any special
10974allocation.
10975@end deftypefn
10976
10977@hook TARGET_UNSPEC_MAY_TRAP_P
10978This target hook returns nonzero if @var{x}, an @code{unspec} or
10979@code{unspec_volatile} operation, might cause a trap. Targets can use
10980this hook to enhance precision of analysis for @code{unspec} and
10981@code{unspec_volatile} operations. You may call @code{may_trap_p_1}
10982to analyze inner elements of @var{x} in which case @var{flags} should be
10983passed along.
10984@end deftypefn
10985
10986@hook TARGET_SET_CURRENT_FUNCTION
10987The compiler invokes this hook whenever it changes its current function
10988context (@code{cfun}). You can define this function if
10989the back end needs to perform any initialization or reset actions on a
10990per-function basis. For example, it may be used to implement function
10991attributes that affect register usage or code generation patterns.
10992The argument @var{decl} is the declaration for the new function context,
10993and may be null to indicate that the compiler has left a function context
10994and is returning to processing at the top level.
10995The default hook function does nothing.
10996
10997GCC sets @code{cfun} to a dummy function context during initialization of
10998some parts of the back end. The hook function is not invoked in this
10999situation; you need not worry about the hook being invoked recursively,
11000or when the back end is in a partially-initialized state.
11001@code{cfun} might be @code{NULL} to indicate processing at top level,
11002outside of any function scope.
11003@end deftypefn
11004
11005@defmac TARGET_OBJECT_SUFFIX
11006Define this macro to be a C string representing the suffix for object
11007files on your target machine. If you do not define this macro, GCC will
11008use @samp{.o} as the suffix for object files.
11009@end defmac
11010
11011@defmac TARGET_EXECUTABLE_SUFFIX
11012Define this macro to be a C string representing the suffix to be
11013automatically added to executable files on your target machine. If you
11014do not define this macro, GCC will use the null string as the suffix for
11015executable files.
11016@end defmac
11017
11018@defmac COLLECT_EXPORT_LIST
11019If defined, @code{collect2} will scan the individual object files
11020specified on its command line and create an export list for the linker.
11021Define this macro for systems like AIX, where the linker discards
11022object files that are not referenced from @code{main} and uses export
11023lists.
11024@end defmac
11025
11026@defmac MODIFY_JNI_METHOD_CALL (@var{mdecl})
11027Define this macro to a C expression representing a variant of the
11028method call @var{mdecl}, if Java Native Interface (JNI) methods
11029must be invoked differently from other methods on your target.
11030For example, on 32-bit Microsoft Windows, JNI methods must be invoked using
11031the @code{stdcall} calling convention and this macro is then
11032defined as this expression:
11033
11034@smallexample
11035build_type_attribute_variant (@var{mdecl},
11036 build_tree_list
11037 (get_identifier ("stdcall"),
11038 NULL))
11039@end smallexample
11040@end defmac
11041
11042@hook TARGET_CANNOT_MODIFY_JUMPS_P
11043This target hook returns @code{true} past the point in which new jump
11044instructions could be created. On machines that require a register for
11045every jump such as the SHmedia ISA of SH5, this point would typically be
11046reload, so this target hook should be defined to a function such as:
11047
11048@smallexample
11049static bool
11050cannot_modify_jumps_past_reload_p ()
11051@{
11052 return (reload_completed || reload_in_progress);
11053@}
11054@end smallexample
11055@end deftypefn
11056
11057@hook TARGET_BRANCH_TARGET_REGISTER_CLASS
11058This target hook returns a register class for which branch target register
11059optimizations should be applied. All registers in this class should be
11060usable interchangeably. After reload, registers in this class will be
11061re-allocated and loads will be hoisted out of loops and be subjected
11062to inter-block scheduling.
11063@end deftypefn
11064
11065@hook TARGET_BRANCH_TARGET_REGISTER_CALLEE_SAVED
11066Branch target register optimization will by default exclude callee-saved
11067registers
11068that are not already live during the current function; if this target hook
11069returns true, they will be included. The target code must than make sure
11070that all target registers in the class returned by
11071@samp{TARGET_BRANCH_TARGET_REGISTER_CLASS} that might need saving are
11072saved. @var{after_prologue_epilogue_gen} indicates if prologues and
11073epilogues have already been generated. Note, even if you only return
11074true when @var{after_prologue_epilogue_gen} is false, you still are likely
11075to have to make special provisions in @code{INITIAL_ELIMINATION_OFFSET}
11076to reserve space for caller-saved target registers.
11077@end deftypefn
11078
11079@hook TARGET_HAVE_CONDITIONAL_EXECUTION
11080This target hook returns true if the target supports conditional execution.
11081This target hook is required only when the target has several different
11082modes and they have different conditional execution capability, such as ARM.
11083@end deftypefn
11084
11085@hook TARGET_LOOP_UNROLL_ADJUST
11086This target hook returns a new value for the number of times @var{loop}
11087should be unrolled. The parameter @var{nunroll} is the number of times
11088the loop is to be unrolled. The parameter @var{loop} is a pointer to
11089the loop, which is going to be checked for unrolling. This target hook
11090is required only when the target has special constraints like maximum
11091number of memory accesses.
11092@end deftypefn
11093
11094@defmac POWI_MAX_MULTS
11095If defined, this macro is interpreted as a signed integer C expression
11096that specifies the maximum number of floating point multiplications
11097that should be emitted when expanding exponentiation by an integer
11098constant inline. When this value is defined, exponentiation requiring
11099more than this number of multiplications is implemented by calling the
11100system library's @code{pow}, @code{powf} or @code{powl} routines.
11101The default value places no upper bound on the multiplication count.
11102@end defmac
11103
11104@deftypefn Macro void TARGET_EXTRA_INCLUDES (const char *@var{sysroot}, const char *@var{iprefix}, int @var{stdinc})
11105This target hook should register any extra include files for the
11106target. The parameter @var{stdinc} indicates if normal include files
11107are present. The parameter @var{sysroot} is the system root directory.
11108The parameter @var{iprefix} is the prefix for the gcc directory.
11109@end deftypefn
11110
11111@deftypefn Macro void TARGET_EXTRA_PRE_INCLUDES (const char *@var{sysroot}, const char *@var{iprefix}, int @var{stdinc})
11112This target hook should register any extra include files for the
11113target before any standard headers. The parameter @var{stdinc}
11114indicates if normal include files are present. The parameter
11115@var{sysroot} is the system root directory. The parameter
11116@var{iprefix} is the prefix for the gcc directory.
11117@end deftypefn
11118
11119@deftypefn Macro void TARGET_OPTF (char *@var{path})
11120This target hook should register special include paths for the target.
11121The parameter @var{path} is the include to register. On Darwin
11122systems, this is used for Framework includes, which have semantics
11123that are different from @option{-I}.
11124@end deftypefn
11125
11126@defmac bool TARGET_USE_LOCAL_THUNK_ALIAS_P (tree @var{fndecl})
11127This target macro returns @code{true} if it is safe to use a local alias
11128for a virtual function @var{fndecl} when constructing thunks,
11129@code{false} otherwise. By default, the macro returns @code{true} for all
11130functions, if a target supports aliases (i.e.@: defines
11131@code{ASM_OUTPUT_DEF}), @code{false} otherwise,
11132@end defmac
11133
11134@defmac TARGET_FORMAT_TYPES
11135If defined, this macro is the name of a global variable containing
11136target-specific format checking information for the @option{-Wformat}
11137option. The default is to have no target-specific format checks.
11138@end defmac
11139
11140@defmac TARGET_N_FORMAT_TYPES
11141If defined, this macro is the number of entries in
11142@code{TARGET_FORMAT_TYPES}.
11143@end defmac
11144
11145@defmac TARGET_OVERRIDES_FORMAT_ATTRIBUTES
11146If defined, this macro is the name of a global variable containing
11147target-specific format overrides for the @option{-Wformat} option. The
11148default is to have no target-specific format overrides. If defined,
11149@code{TARGET_FORMAT_TYPES} must be defined, too.
11150@end defmac
11151
11152@defmac TARGET_OVERRIDES_FORMAT_ATTRIBUTES_COUNT
11153If defined, this macro specifies the number of entries in
11154@code{TARGET_OVERRIDES_FORMAT_ATTRIBUTES}.
11155@end defmac
11156
11157@defmac TARGET_OVERRIDES_FORMAT_INIT
11158If defined, this macro specifies the optional initialization
11159routine for target specific customizations of the system printf
11160and scanf formatter settings.
11161@end defmac
11162
11163@hook TARGET_RELAXED_ORDERING
11164If set to @code{true}, means that the target's memory model does not
11165guarantee that loads which do not depend on one another will access
11166main memory in the order of the instruction stream; if ordering is
11167important, an explicit memory barrier must be used. This is true of
11168many recent processors which implement a policy of ``relaxed,''
11169``weak,'' or ``release'' memory consistency, such as Alpha, PowerPC,
11170and ia64. The default is @code{false}.
11171@end deftypevr
11172
11173@hook TARGET_INVALID_ARG_FOR_UNPROTOTYPED_FN
11174If defined, this macro returns the diagnostic message when it is
11175illegal to pass argument @var{val} to function @var{funcdecl}
11176with prototype @var{typelist}.
11177@end deftypefn
11178
11179@hook TARGET_INVALID_CONVERSION
11180If defined, this macro returns the diagnostic message when it is
11181invalid to convert from @var{fromtype} to @var{totype}, or @code{NULL}
11182if validity should be determined by the front end.
11183@end deftypefn
11184
11185@hook TARGET_INVALID_UNARY_OP
11186If defined, this macro returns the diagnostic message when it is
11187invalid to apply operation @var{op} (where unary plus is denoted by
11188@code{CONVERT_EXPR}) to an operand of type @var{type}, or @code{NULL}
11189if validity should be determined by the front end.
11190@end deftypefn
11191
11192@hook TARGET_INVALID_BINARY_OP
11193If defined, this macro returns the diagnostic message when it is
11194invalid to apply operation @var{op} to operands of types @var{type1}
11195and @var{type2}, or @code{NULL} if validity should be determined by
11196the front end.
11197@end deftypefn
11198
11199@hook TARGET_INVALID_PARAMETER_TYPE
11200If defined, this macro returns the diagnostic message when it is
11201invalid for functions to include parameters of type @var{type},
11202or @code{NULL} if validity should be determined by
11203the front end. This is currently used only by the C and C++ front ends.
11204@end deftypefn
11205
11206@hook TARGET_INVALID_RETURN_TYPE
11207If defined, this macro returns the diagnostic message when it is
11208invalid for functions to have return type @var{type},
11209or @code{NULL} if validity should be determined by
11210the front end. This is currently used only by the C and C++ front ends.
11211@end deftypefn
11212
11213@hook TARGET_PROMOTED_TYPE
11214If defined, this target hook returns the type to which values of
11215@var{type} should be promoted when they appear in expressions,
11216analogous to the integer promotions, or @code{NULL_TREE} to use the
11217front end's normal promotion rules. This hook is useful when there are
11218target-specific types with special promotion rules.
11219This is currently used only by the C and C++ front ends.
11220@end deftypefn
11221
11222@hook TARGET_CONVERT_TO_TYPE
11223If defined, this hook returns the result of converting @var{expr} to
11224@var{type}. It should return the converted expression,
11225or @code{NULL_TREE} to apply the front end's normal conversion rules.
11226This hook is useful when there are target-specific types with special
11227conversion rules.
11228This is currently used only by the C and C++ front ends.
11229@end deftypefn
11230
11231@defmac TARGET_USE_JCR_SECTION
11232This macro determines whether to use the JCR section to register Java
11233classes. By default, TARGET_USE_JCR_SECTION is defined to 1 if both
11234SUPPORTS_WEAK and TARGET_HAVE_NAMED_SECTIONS are true, else 0.
11235@end defmac
11236
11237@defmac OBJC_JBLEN
11238This macro determines the size of the objective C jump buffer for the
11239NeXT runtime. By default, OBJC_JBLEN is defined to an innocuous value.
11240@end defmac
11241
11242@defmac LIBGCC2_UNWIND_ATTRIBUTE
11243Define this macro if any target-specific attributes need to be attached
11244to the functions in @file{libgcc} that provide low-level support for
11245call stack unwinding. It is used in declarations in @file{unwind-generic.h}
11246and the associated definitions of those functions.
11247@end defmac
11248
11249@hook TARGET_UPDATE_STACK_BOUNDARY
11250Define this macro to update the current function stack boundary if
11251necessary.
11252@end deftypefn
11253
11254@hook TARGET_GET_DRAP_RTX
11255This hook should return an rtx for Dynamic Realign Argument Pointer (DRAP) if a
11256different argument pointer register is needed to access the function's
11257argument list due to stack realignment. Return @code{NULL} if no DRAP
11258is needed.
11259@end deftypefn
11260
11261@hook TARGET_ALLOCATE_STACK_SLOTS_FOR_ARGS
11262When optimization is disabled, this hook indicates whether or not
11263arguments should be allocated to stack slots. Normally, GCC allocates
11264stacks slots for arguments when not optimizing in order to make
11265debugging easier. However, when a function is declared with
11266@code{__attribute__((naked))}, there is no stack frame, and the compiler
11267cannot safely move arguments from the registers in which they are passed
11268to the stack. Therefore, this hook should return true in general, but
11269false for naked functions. The default implementation always returns true.
11270@end deftypefn
11271
11272@hook TARGET_CONST_ANCHOR
11273On some architectures it can take multiple instructions to synthesize
11274a constant. If there is another constant already in a register that
11275is close enough in value then it is preferable that the new constant
11276is computed from this register using immediate addition or
11277subtraction. We accomplish this through CSE. Besides the value of
11278the constant we also add a lower and an upper constant anchor to the
11279available expressions. These are then queried when encountering new
11280constants. The anchors are computed by rounding the constant up and
11281down to a multiple of the value of @code{TARGET_CONST_ANCHOR}.
11282@code{TARGET_CONST_ANCHOR} should be the maximum positive value
11283accepted by immediate-add plus one. We currently assume that the
11284value of @code{TARGET_CONST_ANCHOR} is a power of 2. For example, on
11285MIPS, where add-immediate takes a 16-bit signed value,
11286@code{TARGET_CONST_ANCHOR} is set to @samp{0x8000}. The default value
11287is zero, which disables this optimization. @end deftypevr